PR middle-end/20297
[official-gcc.git] / gcc / dwarf2out.c
blobccfb5df699fb17f8241e926774f36bab75121bab
1 /* Output Dwarf2 format symbol table information from GCC.
2 Copyright (C) 1992, 1993, 1995, 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002,
3 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4 Contributed by Gary Funck (gary@intrepid.com).
5 Derived from DWARF 1 implementation of Ron Guilmette (rfg@monkeys.com).
6 Extensively modified by Jason Merrill (jason@cygnus.com).
8 This file is part of GCC.
10 GCC is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
11 the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free
12 Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option) any later
13 version.
15 GCC is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but WITHOUT ANY
16 WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of MERCHANTABILITY or
17 FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU General Public License
18 for more details.
20 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
21 along with GCC; see the file COPYING. If not, write to the Free
22 Software Foundation, 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA
23 02110-1301, USA. */
25 /* TODO: Emit .debug_line header even when there are no functions, since
26 the file numbers are used by .debug_info. Alternately, leave
27 out locations for types and decls.
28 Avoid talking about ctors and op= for PODs.
29 Factor out common prologue sequences into multiple CIEs. */
31 /* The first part of this file deals with the DWARF 2 frame unwind
32 information, which is also used by the GCC efficient exception handling
33 mechanism. The second part, controlled only by an #ifdef
34 DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO, deals with the other DWARF 2 debugging
35 information. */
37 #include "config.h"
38 #include "system.h"
39 #include "coretypes.h"
40 #include "tm.h"
41 #include "tree.h"
42 #include "version.h"
43 #include "flags.h"
44 #include "real.h"
45 #include "rtl.h"
46 #include "hard-reg-set.h"
47 #include "regs.h"
48 #include "insn-config.h"
49 #include "reload.h"
50 #include "function.h"
51 #include "output.h"
52 #include "expr.h"
53 #include "libfuncs.h"
54 #include "except.h"
55 #include "dwarf2.h"
56 #include "dwarf2out.h"
57 #include "dwarf2asm.h"
58 #include "toplev.h"
59 #include "varray.h"
60 #include "ggc.h"
61 #include "md5.h"
62 #include "tm_p.h"
63 #include "diagnostic.h"
64 #include "debug.h"
65 #include "target.h"
66 #include "langhooks.h"
67 #include "hashtab.h"
68 #include "cgraph.h"
69 #include "input.h"
71 #ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
72 static void dwarf2out_source_line (unsigned int, const char *);
73 #endif
75 /* DWARF2 Abbreviation Glossary:
76 CFA = Canonical Frame Address
77 a fixed address on the stack which identifies a call frame.
78 We define it to be the value of SP just before the call insn.
79 The CFA register and offset, which may change during the course
80 of the function, are used to calculate its value at runtime.
81 CFI = Call Frame Instruction
82 an instruction for the DWARF2 abstract machine
83 CIE = Common Information Entry
84 information describing information common to one or more FDEs
85 DIE = Debugging Information Entry
86 FDE = Frame Description Entry
87 information describing the stack call frame, in particular,
88 how to restore registers
90 DW_CFA_... = DWARF2 CFA call frame instruction
91 DW_TAG_... = DWARF2 DIE tag */
93 #ifndef DWARF2_FRAME_INFO
94 # ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
95 # define DWARF2_FRAME_INFO \
96 (write_symbols == DWARF2_DEBUG || write_symbols == VMS_AND_DWARF2_DEBUG)
97 # else
98 # define DWARF2_FRAME_INFO 0
99 # endif
100 #endif
102 /* Map register numbers held in the call frame info that gcc has
103 collected using DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM to those that should be output in
104 .debug_frame and .eh_frame. */
105 #ifndef DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT
106 #define DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT(REGNO, FOR_EH) (REGNO)
107 #endif
109 /* Decide whether we want to emit frame unwind information for the current
110 translation unit. */
113 dwarf2out_do_frame (void)
115 /* We want to emit correct CFA location expressions or lists, so we
116 have to return true if we're going to output debug info, even if
117 we're not going to output frame or unwind info. */
118 return (write_symbols == DWARF2_DEBUG
119 || write_symbols == VMS_AND_DWARF2_DEBUG
120 || DWARF2_FRAME_INFO
121 #ifdef DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO
122 || (DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO
123 && (flag_unwind_tables
124 || (flag_exceptions && ! USING_SJLJ_EXCEPTIONS)))
125 #endif
129 /* The size of the target's pointer type. */
130 #ifndef PTR_SIZE
131 #define PTR_SIZE (POINTER_SIZE / BITS_PER_UNIT)
132 #endif
134 /* Array of RTXes referenced by the debugging information, which therefore
135 must be kept around forever. */
136 static GTY(()) VEC(rtx,gc) *used_rtx_array;
138 /* A pointer to the base of a list of incomplete types which might be
139 completed at some later time. incomplete_types_list needs to be a
140 VEC(tree,gc) because we want to tell the garbage collector about
141 it. */
142 static GTY(()) VEC(tree,gc) *incomplete_types;
144 /* A pointer to the base of a table of references to declaration
145 scopes. This table is a display which tracks the nesting
146 of declaration scopes at the current scope and containing
147 scopes. This table is used to find the proper place to
148 define type declaration DIE's. */
149 static GTY(()) VEC(tree,gc) *decl_scope_table;
151 /* Pointers to various DWARF2 sections. */
152 static GTY(()) section *debug_info_section;
153 static GTY(()) section *debug_abbrev_section;
154 static GTY(()) section *debug_aranges_section;
155 static GTY(()) section *debug_macinfo_section;
156 static GTY(()) section *debug_line_section;
157 static GTY(()) section *debug_loc_section;
158 static GTY(()) section *debug_pubnames_section;
159 static GTY(()) section *debug_str_section;
160 static GTY(()) section *debug_ranges_section;
161 static GTY(()) section *debug_frame_section;
163 /* How to start an assembler comment. */
164 #ifndef ASM_COMMENT_START
165 #define ASM_COMMENT_START ";#"
166 #endif
168 typedef struct dw_cfi_struct *dw_cfi_ref;
169 typedef struct dw_fde_struct *dw_fde_ref;
170 typedef union dw_cfi_oprnd_struct *dw_cfi_oprnd_ref;
172 /* Call frames are described using a sequence of Call Frame
173 Information instructions. The register number, offset
174 and address fields are provided as possible operands;
175 their use is selected by the opcode field. */
177 enum dw_cfi_oprnd_type {
178 dw_cfi_oprnd_unused,
179 dw_cfi_oprnd_reg_num,
180 dw_cfi_oprnd_offset,
181 dw_cfi_oprnd_addr,
182 dw_cfi_oprnd_loc
185 typedef union dw_cfi_oprnd_struct GTY(())
187 unsigned int GTY ((tag ("dw_cfi_oprnd_reg_num"))) dw_cfi_reg_num;
188 HOST_WIDE_INT GTY ((tag ("dw_cfi_oprnd_offset"))) dw_cfi_offset;
189 const char * GTY ((tag ("dw_cfi_oprnd_addr"))) dw_cfi_addr;
190 struct dw_loc_descr_struct * GTY ((tag ("dw_cfi_oprnd_loc"))) dw_cfi_loc;
192 dw_cfi_oprnd;
194 typedef struct dw_cfi_struct GTY(())
196 dw_cfi_ref dw_cfi_next;
197 enum dwarf_call_frame_info dw_cfi_opc;
198 dw_cfi_oprnd GTY ((desc ("dw_cfi_oprnd1_desc (%1.dw_cfi_opc)")))
199 dw_cfi_oprnd1;
200 dw_cfi_oprnd GTY ((desc ("dw_cfi_oprnd2_desc (%1.dw_cfi_opc)")))
201 dw_cfi_oprnd2;
203 dw_cfi_node;
205 /* This is how we define the location of the CFA. We use to handle it
206 as REG + OFFSET all the time, but now it can be more complex.
207 It can now be either REG + CFA_OFFSET or *(REG + BASE_OFFSET) + CFA_OFFSET.
208 Instead of passing around REG and OFFSET, we pass a copy
209 of this structure. */
210 typedef struct cfa_loc GTY(())
212 HOST_WIDE_INT offset;
213 HOST_WIDE_INT base_offset;
214 unsigned int reg;
215 int indirect; /* 1 if CFA is accessed via a dereference. */
216 } dw_cfa_location;
218 /* All call frame descriptions (FDE's) in the GCC generated DWARF
219 refer to a single Common Information Entry (CIE), defined at
220 the beginning of the .debug_frame section. This use of a single
221 CIE obviates the need to keep track of multiple CIE's
222 in the DWARF generation routines below. */
224 typedef struct dw_fde_struct GTY(())
226 tree decl;
227 const char *dw_fde_begin;
228 const char *dw_fde_current_label;
229 const char *dw_fde_end;
230 const char *dw_fde_hot_section_label;
231 const char *dw_fde_hot_section_end_label;
232 const char *dw_fde_unlikely_section_label;
233 const char *dw_fde_unlikely_section_end_label;
234 bool dw_fde_switched_sections;
235 dw_cfi_ref dw_fde_cfi;
236 unsigned funcdef_number;
237 unsigned all_throwers_are_sibcalls : 1;
238 unsigned nothrow : 1;
239 unsigned uses_eh_lsda : 1;
241 dw_fde_node;
243 /* Maximum size (in bytes) of an artificially generated label. */
244 #define MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES 30
246 /* The size of addresses as they appear in the Dwarf 2 data.
247 Some architectures use word addresses to refer to code locations,
248 but Dwarf 2 info always uses byte addresses. On such machines,
249 Dwarf 2 addresses need to be larger than the architecture's
250 pointers. */
251 #ifndef DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
252 #define DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE (POINTER_SIZE / BITS_PER_UNIT)
253 #endif
255 /* The size in bytes of a DWARF field indicating an offset or length
256 relative to a debug info section, specified to be 4 bytes in the
257 DWARF-2 specification. The SGI/MIPS ABI defines it to be the same
258 as PTR_SIZE. */
260 #ifndef DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE
261 #define DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE 4
262 #endif
264 /* According to the (draft) DWARF 3 specification, the initial length
265 should either be 4 or 12 bytes. When it's 12 bytes, the first 4
266 bytes are 0xffffffff, followed by the length stored in the next 8
267 bytes.
269 However, the SGI/MIPS ABI uses an initial length which is equal to
270 DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE. It is defined (elsewhere) accordingly. */
272 #ifndef DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE
273 #define DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4 ? 4 : 12)
274 #endif
276 #define DWARF_VERSION 2
278 /* Round SIZE up to the nearest BOUNDARY. */
279 #define DWARF_ROUND(SIZE,BOUNDARY) \
280 ((((SIZE) + (BOUNDARY) - 1) / (BOUNDARY)) * (BOUNDARY))
282 /* Offsets recorded in opcodes are a multiple of this alignment factor. */
283 #ifndef DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT
284 #ifdef STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
285 #define DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT (-((int) UNITS_PER_WORD))
286 #else
287 #define DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT ((int) UNITS_PER_WORD)
288 #endif
289 #endif
291 /* A pointer to the base of a table that contains frame description
292 information for each routine. */
293 static GTY((length ("fde_table_allocated"))) dw_fde_ref fde_table;
295 /* Number of elements currently allocated for fde_table. */
296 static GTY(()) unsigned fde_table_allocated;
298 /* Number of elements in fde_table currently in use. */
299 static GTY(()) unsigned fde_table_in_use;
301 /* Size (in elements) of increments by which we may expand the
302 fde_table. */
303 #define FDE_TABLE_INCREMENT 256
305 /* A list of call frame insns for the CIE. */
306 static GTY(()) dw_cfi_ref cie_cfi_head;
308 #if defined (DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO) || defined (DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO)
309 /* Some DWARF extensions (e.g., MIPS/SGI) implement a subprogram
310 attribute that accelerates the lookup of the FDE associated
311 with the subprogram. This variable holds the table index of the FDE
312 associated with the current function (body) definition. */
313 static unsigned current_funcdef_fde;
314 #endif
316 struct indirect_string_node GTY(())
318 const char *str;
319 unsigned int refcount;
320 unsigned int form;
321 char *label;
324 static GTY ((param_is (struct indirect_string_node))) htab_t debug_str_hash;
326 static GTY(()) int dw2_string_counter;
327 static GTY(()) unsigned long dwarf2out_cfi_label_num;
329 #if defined (DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO) || defined (DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO)
331 /* Forward declarations for functions defined in this file. */
333 static char *stripattributes (const char *);
334 static const char *dwarf_cfi_name (unsigned);
335 static dw_cfi_ref new_cfi (void);
336 static void add_cfi (dw_cfi_ref *, dw_cfi_ref);
337 static void add_fde_cfi (const char *, dw_cfi_ref);
338 static void lookup_cfa_1 (dw_cfi_ref, dw_cfa_location *);
339 static void lookup_cfa (dw_cfa_location *);
340 static void reg_save (const char *, unsigned, unsigned, HOST_WIDE_INT);
341 static void initial_return_save (rtx);
342 static HOST_WIDE_INT stack_adjust_offset (rtx);
343 static void output_cfi (dw_cfi_ref, dw_fde_ref, int);
344 static void output_call_frame_info (int);
345 static void dwarf2out_stack_adjust (rtx, bool);
346 static void flush_queued_reg_saves (void);
347 static bool clobbers_queued_reg_save (rtx);
348 static void dwarf2out_frame_debug_expr (rtx, const char *);
350 /* Support for complex CFA locations. */
351 static void output_cfa_loc (dw_cfi_ref);
352 static void get_cfa_from_loc_descr (dw_cfa_location *,
353 struct dw_loc_descr_struct *);
354 static struct dw_loc_descr_struct *build_cfa_loc
355 (dw_cfa_location *, HOST_WIDE_INT);
356 static void def_cfa_1 (const char *, dw_cfa_location *);
358 /* How to start an assembler comment. */
359 #ifndef ASM_COMMENT_START
360 #define ASM_COMMENT_START ";#"
361 #endif
363 /* Data and reference forms for relocatable data. */
364 #define DW_FORM_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 8 ? DW_FORM_data8 : DW_FORM_data4)
365 #define DW_FORM_ref (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 8 ? DW_FORM_ref8 : DW_FORM_ref4)
367 #ifndef DEBUG_FRAME_SECTION
368 #define DEBUG_FRAME_SECTION ".debug_frame"
369 #endif
371 #ifndef FUNC_BEGIN_LABEL
372 #define FUNC_BEGIN_LABEL "LFB"
373 #endif
375 #ifndef FUNC_END_LABEL
376 #define FUNC_END_LABEL "LFE"
377 #endif
379 #ifndef FRAME_BEGIN_LABEL
380 #define FRAME_BEGIN_LABEL "Lframe"
381 #endif
382 #define CIE_AFTER_SIZE_LABEL "LSCIE"
383 #define CIE_END_LABEL "LECIE"
384 #define FDE_LABEL "LSFDE"
385 #define FDE_AFTER_SIZE_LABEL "LASFDE"
386 #define FDE_END_LABEL "LEFDE"
387 #define LINE_NUMBER_BEGIN_LABEL "LSLT"
388 #define LINE_NUMBER_END_LABEL "LELT"
389 #define LN_PROLOG_AS_LABEL "LASLTP"
390 #define LN_PROLOG_END_LABEL "LELTP"
391 #define DIE_LABEL_PREFIX "DW"
393 /* The DWARF 2 CFA column which tracks the return address. Normally this
394 is the column for PC, or the first column after all of the hard
395 registers. */
396 #ifndef DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN
397 #ifdef PC_REGNUM
398 #define DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (PC_REGNUM)
399 #else
400 #define DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS
401 #endif
402 #endif
404 /* The mapping from gcc register number to DWARF 2 CFA column number. By
405 default, we just provide columns for all registers. */
406 #ifndef DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM
407 #define DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM(REG) DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (REG)
408 #endif
410 /* Hook used by __throw. */
413 expand_builtin_dwarf_sp_column (void)
415 unsigned int dwarf_regnum = DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (STACK_POINTER_REGNUM);
416 return GEN_INT (DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (dwarf_regnum, 1));
419 /* Return a pointer to a copy of the section string name S with all
420 attributes stripped off, and an asterisk prepended (for assemble_name). */
422 static inline char *
423 stripattributes (const char *s)
425 char *stripped = XNEWVEC (char, strlen (s) + 2);
426 char *p = stripped;
428 *p++ = '*';
430 while (*s && *s != ',')
431 *p++ = *s++;
433 *p = '\0';
434 return stripped;
437 /* Generate code to initialize the register size table. */
439 void
440 expand_builtin_init_dwarf_reg_sizes (tree address)
442 unsigned int i;
443 enum machine_mode mode = TYPE_MODE (char_type_node);
444 rtx addr = expand_normal (address);
445 rtx mem = gen_rtx_MEM (BLKmode, addr);
446 bool wrote_return_column = false;
448 for (i = 0; i < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i++)
450 int rnum = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (i), 1);
452 if (rnum < DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS)
454 HOST_WIDE_INT offset = rnum * GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
455 enum machine_mode save_mode = reg_raw_mode[i];
456 HOST_WIDE_INT size;
458 if (HARD_REGNO_CALL_PART_CLOBBERED (i, save_mode))
459 save_mode = choose_hard_reg_mode (i, 1, true);
460 if (DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (i) == DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN)
462 if (save_mode == VOIDmode)
463 continue;
464 wrote_return_column = true;
466 size = GET_MODE_SIZE (save_mode);
467 if (offset < 0)
468 continue;
470 emit_move_insn (adjust_address (mem, mode, offset),
471 gen_int_mode (size, mode));
475 #ifdef DWARF_ALT_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN
476 gcc_assert (wrote_return_column);
477 i = DWARF_ALT_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN;
478 wrote_return_column = false;
479 #else
480 i = DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN;
481 #endif
483 if (! wrote_return_column)
485 enum machine_mode save_mode = Pmode;
486 HOST_WIDE_INT offset = i * GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
487 HOST_WIDE_INT size = GET_MODE_SIZE (save_mode);
488 emit_move_insn (adjust_address (mem, mode, offset), GEN_INT (size));
492 /* Convert a DWARF call frame info. operation to its string name */
494 static const char *
495 dwarf_cfi_name (unsigned int cfi_opc)
497 switch (cfi_opc)
499 case DW_CFA_advance_loc:
500 return "DW_CFA_advance_loc";
501 case DW_CFA_offset:
502 return "DW_CFA_offset";
503 case DW_CFA_restore:
504 return "DW_CFA_restore";
505 case DW_CFA_nop:
506 return "DW_CFA_nop";
507 case DW_CFA_set_loc:
508 return "DW_CFA_set_loc";
509 case DW_CFA_advance_loc1:
510 return "DW_CFA_advance_loc1";
511 case DW_CFA_advance_loc2:
512 return "DW_CFA_advance_loc2";
513 case DW_CFA_advance_loc4:
514 return "DW_CFA_advance_loc4";
515 case DW_CFA_offset_extended:
516 return "DW_CFA_offset_extended";
517 case DW_CFA_restore_extended:
518 return "DW_CFA_restore_extended";
519 case DW_CFA_undefined:
520 return "DW_CFA_undefined";
521 case DW_CFA_same_value:
522 return "DW_CFA_same_value";
523 case DW_CFA_register:
524 return "DW_CFA_register";
525 case DW_CFA_remember_state:
526 return "DW_CFA_remember_state";
527 case DW_CFA_restore_state:
528 return "DW_CFA_restore_state";
529 case DW_CFA_def_cfa:
530 return "DW_CFA_def_cfa";
531 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_register:
532 return "DW_CFA_def_cfa_register";
533 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset:
534 return "DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset";
536 /* DWARF 3 */
537 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression:
538 return "DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression";
539 case DW_CFA_expression:
540 return "DW_CFA_expression";
541 case DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf:
542 return "DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf";
543 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf:
544 return "DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf";
545 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset_sf:
546 return "DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset_sf";
548 /* SGI/MIPS specific */
549 case DW_CFA_MIPS_advance_loc8:
550 return "DW_CFA_MIPS_advance_loc8";
552 /* GNU extensions */
553 case DW_CFA_GNU_window_save:
554 return "DW_CFA_GNU_window_save";
555 case DW_CFA_GNU_args_size:
556 return "DW_CFA_GNU_args_size";
557 case DW_CFA_GNU_negative_offset_extended:
558 return "DW_CFA_GNU_negative_offset_extended";
560 default:
561 return "DW_CFA_<unknown>";
565 /* Return a pointer to a newly allocated Call Frame Instruction. */
567 static inline dw_cfi_ref
568 new_cfi (void)
570 dw_cfi_ref cfi = ggc_alloc (sizeof (dw_cfi_node));
572 cfi->dw_cfi_next = NULL;
573 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num = 0;
574 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_reg_num = 0;
576 return cfi;
579 /* Add a Call Frame Instruction to list of instructions. */
581 static inline void
582 add_cfi (dw_cfi_ref *list_head, dw_cfi_ref cfi)
584 dw_cfi_ref *p;
586 /* Find the end of the chain. */
587 for (p = list_head; (*p) != NULL; p = &(*p)->dw_cfi_next)
590 *p = cfi;
593 /* Generate a new label for the CFI info to refer to. */
595 char *
596 dwarf2out_cfi_label (void)
598 static char label[20];
600 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, "LCFI", dwarf2out_cfi_label_num++);
601 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, label);
602 return label;
605 /* Add CFI to the current fde at the PC value indicated by LABEL if specified,
606 or to the CIE if LABEL is NULL. */
608 static void
609 add_fde_cfi (const char *label, dw_cfi_ref cfi)
611 if (label)
613 dw_fde_ref fde = &fde_table[fde_table_in_use - 1];
615 if (*label == 0)
616 label = dwarf2out_cfi_label ();
618 if (fde->dw_fde_current_label == NULL
619 || strcmp (label, fde->dw_fde_current_label) != 0)
621 dw_cfi_ref xcfi;
623 fde->dw_fde_current_label = label = xstrdup (label);
625 /* Set the location counter to the new label. */
626 xcfi = new_cfi ();
627 xcfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_advance_loc4;
628 xcfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr = label;
629 add_cfi (&fde->dw_fde_cfi, xcfi);
632 add_cfi (&fde->dw_fde_cfi, cfi);
635 else
636 add_cfi (&cie_cfi_head, cfi);
639 /* Subroutine of lookup_cfa. */
641 static void
642 lookup_cfa_1 (dw_cfi_ref cfi, dw_cfa_location *loc)
644 switch (cfi->dw_cfi_opc)
646 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset:
647 loc->offset = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_offset;
648 break;
649 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset_sf:
650 loc->offset
651 = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_offset * DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT;
652 break;
653 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_register:
654 loc->reg = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num;
655 break;
656 case DW_CFA_def_cfa:
657 loc->reg = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num;
658 loc->offset = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_offset;
659 break;
660 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf:
661 loc->reg = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num;
662 loc->offset
663 = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_offset * DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT;
664 break;
665 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression:
666 get_cfa_from_loc_descr (loc, cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_loc);
667 break;
668 default:
669 break;
673 /* Find the previous value for the CFA. */
675 static void
676 lookup_cfa (dw_cfa_location *loc)
678 dw_cfi_ref cfi;
680 loc->reg = INVALID_REGNUM;
681 loc->offset = 0;
682 loc->indirect = 0;
683 loc->base_offset = 0;
685 for (cfi = cie_cfi_head; cfi; cfi = cfi->dw_cfi_next)
686 lookup_cfa_1 (cfi, loc);
688 if (fde_table_in_use)
690 dw_fde_ref fde = &fde_table[fde_table_in_use - 1];
691 for (cfi = fde->dw_fde_cfi; cfi; cfi = cfi->dw_cfi_next)
692 lookup_cfa_1 (cfi, loc);
696 /* The current rule for calculating the DWARF2 canonical frame address. */
697 static dw_cfa_location cfa;
699 /* The register used for saving registers to the stack, and its offset
700 from the CFA. */
701 static dw_cfa_location cfa_store;
703 /* The running total of the size of arguments pushed onto the stack. */
704 static HOST_WIDE_INT args_size;
706 /* The last args_size we actually output. */
707 static HOST_WIDE_INT old_args_size;
709 /* Entry point to update the canonical frame address (CFA).
710 LABEL is passed to add_fde_cfi. The value of CFA is now to be
711 calculated from REG+OFFSET. */
713 void
714 dwarf2out_def_cfa (const char *label, unsigned int reg, HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
716 dw_cfa_location loc;
717 loc.indirect = 0;
718 loc.base_offset = 0;
719 loc.reg = reg;
720 loc.offset = offset;
721 def_cfa_1 (label, &loc);
724 /* Determine if two dw_cfa_location structures define the same data. */
726 static bool
727 cfa_equal_p (const dw_cfa_location *loc1, const dw_cfa_location *loc2)
729 return (loc1->reg == loc2->reg
730 && loc1->offset == loc2->offset
731 && loc1->indirect == loc2->indirect
732 && (loc1->indirect == 0
733 || loc1->base_offset == loc2->base_offset));
736 /* This routine does the actual work. The CFA is now calculated from
737 the dw_cfa_location structure. */
739 static void
740 def_cfa_1 (const char *label, dw_cfa_location *loc_p)
742 dw_cfi_ref cfi;
743 dw_cfa_location old_cfa, loc;
745 cfa = *loc_p;
746 loc = *loc_p;
748 if (cfa_store.reg == loc.reg && loc.indirect == 0)
749 cfa_store.offset = loc.offset;
751 loc.reg = DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (loc.reg);
752 lookup_cfa (&old_cfa);
754 /* If nothing changed, no need to issue any call frame instructions. */
755 if (cfa_equal_p (&loc, &old_cfa))
756 return;
758 cfi = new_cfi ();
760 if (loc.reg == old_cfa.reg && !loc.indirect)
762 /* Construct a "DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset <offset>" instruction, indicating
763 the CFA register did not change but the offset did. */
764 if (loc.offset < 0)
766 HOST_WIDE_INT f_offset = loc.offset / DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT;
767 gcc_assert (f_offset * DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT == loc.offset);
769 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset_sf;
770 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_offset = f_offset;
772 else
774 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset;
775 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_offset = loc.offset;
779 #ifndef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO /* SGI dbx thinks this means no offset. */
780 else if (loc.offset == old_cfa.offset
781 && old_cfa.reg != INVALID_REGNUM
782 && !loc.indirect)
784 /* Construct a "DW_CFA_def_cfa_register <register>" instruction,
785 indicating the CFA register has changed to <register> but the
786 offset has not changed. */
787 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_def_cfa_register;
788 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num = loc.reg;
790 #endif
792 else if (loc.indirect == 0)
794 /* Construct a "DW_CFA_def_cfa <register> <offset>" instruction,
795 indicating the CFA register has changed to <register> with
796 the specified offset. */
797 if (loc.offset < 0)
799 HOST_WIDE_INT f_offset = loc.offset / DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT;
800 gcc_assert (f_offset * DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT == loc.offset);
802 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf;
803 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num = loc.reg;
804 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_offset = f_offset;
806 else
808 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_def_cfa;
809 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num = loc.reg;
810 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_offset = loc.offset;
813 else
815 /* Construct a DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression instruction to
816 calculate the CFA using a full location expression since no
817 register-offset pair is available. */
818 struct dw_loc_descr_struct *loc_list;
820 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression;
821 loc_list = build_cfa_loc (&loc, 0);
822 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_loc = loc_list;
825 add_fde_cfi (label, cfi);
828 /* Add the CFI for saving a register. REG is the CFA column number.
829 LABEL is passed to add_fde_cfi.
830 If SREG is -1, the register is saved at OFFSET from the CFA;
831 otherwise it is saved in SREG. */
833 static void
834 reg_save (const char *label, unsigned int reg, unsigned int sreg, HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
836 dw_cfi_ref cfi = new_cfi ();
838 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num = reg;
840 if (sreg == INVALID_REGNUM)
842 if (reg & ~0x3f)
843 /* The register number won't fit in 6 bits, so we have to use
844 the long form. */
845 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_offset_extended;
846 else
847 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_offset;
849 #ifdef ENABLE_CHECKING
851 /* If we get an offset that is not a multiple of
852 DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT, there is either a bug in the
853 definition of DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT, or a bug in the machine
854 description. */
855 HOST_WIDE_INT check_offset = offset / DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT;
857 gcc_assert (check_offset * DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT == offset);
859 #endif
860 offset /= DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT;
861 if (offset < 0)
862 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf;
864 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_offset = offset;
866 else if (sreg == reg)
867 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_same_value;
868 else
870 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_register;
871 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_reg_num = sreg;
874 add_fde_cfi (label, cfi);
877 /* Add the CFI for saving a register window. LABEL is passed to reg_save.
878 This CFI tells the unwinder that it needs to restore the window registers
879 from the previous frame's window save area.
881 ??? Perhaps we should note in the CIE where windows are saved (instead of
882 assuming 0(cfa)) and what registers are in the window. */
884 void
885 dwarf2out_window_save (const char *label)
887 dw_cfi_ref cfi = new_cfi ();
889 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_GNU_window_save;
890 add_fde_cfi (label, cfi);
893 /* Add a CFI to update the running total of the size of arguments
894 pushed onto the stack. */
896 void
897 dwarf2out_args_size (const char *label, HOST_WIDE_INT size)
899 dw_cfi_ref cfi;
901 if (size == old_args_size)
902 return;
904 old_args_size = size;
906 cfi = new_cfi ();
907 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_GNU_args_size;
908 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_offset = size;
909 add_fde_cfi (label, cfi);
912 /* Entry point for saving a register to the stack. REG is the GCC register
913 number. LABEL and OFFSET are passed to reg_save. */
915 void
916 dwarf2out_reg_save (const char *label, unsigned int reg, HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
918 reg_save (label, DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (reg), INVALID_REGNUM, offset);
921 /* Entry point for saving the return address in the stack.
922 LABEL and OFFSET are passed to reg_save. */
924 void
925 dwarf2out_return_save (const char *label, HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
927 reg_save (label, DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN, INVALID_REGNUM, offset);
930 /* Entry point for saving the return address in a register.
931 LABEL and SREG are passed to reg_save. */
933 void
934 dwarf2out_return_reg (const char *label, unsigned int sreg)
936 reg_save (label, DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN, DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (sreg), 0);
939 /* Record the initial position of the return address. RTL is
940 INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX. */
942 static void
943 initial_return_save (rtx rtl)
945 unsigned int reg = INVALID_REGNUM;
946 HOST_WIDE_INT offset = 0;
948 switch (GET_CODE (rtl))
950 case REG:
951 /* RA is in a register. */
952 reg = DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO (rtl));
953 break;
955 case MEM:
956 /* RA is on the stack. */
957 rtl = XEXP (rtl, 0);
958 switch (GET_CODE (rtl))
960 case REG:
961 gcc_assert (REGNO (rtl) == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM);
962 offset = 0;
963 break;
965 case PLUS:
966 gcc_assert (REGNO (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM);
967 offset = INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1));
968 break;
970 case MINUS:
971 gcc_assert (REGNO (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM);
972 offset = -INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1));
973 break;
975 default:
976 gcc_unreachable ();
979 break;
981 case PLUS:
982 /* The return address is at some offset from any value we can
983 actually load. For instance, on the SPARC it is in %i7+8. Just
984 ignore the offset for now; it doesn't matter for unwinding frames. */
985 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (XEXP (rtl, 1)) == CONST_INT);
986 initial_return_save (XEXP (rtl, 0));
987 return;
989 default:
990 gcc_unreachable ();
993 if (reg != DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN)
994 reg_save (NULL, DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN, reg, offset - cfa.offset);
997 /* Given a SET, calculate the amount of stack adjustment it
998 contains. */
1000 static HOST_WIDE_INT
1001 stack_adjust_offset (rtx pattern)
1003 rtx src = SET_SRC (pattern);
1004 rtx dest = SET_DEST (pattern);
1005 HOST_WIDE_INT offset = 0;
1006 enum rtx_code code;
1008 if (dest == stack_pointer_rtx)
1010 /* (set (reg sp) (plus (reg sp) (const_int))) */
1011 code = GET_CODE (src);
1012 if (! (code == PLUS || code == MINUS)
1013 || XEXP (src, 0) != stack_pointer_rtx
1014 || GET_CODE (XEXP (src, 1)) != CONST_INT)
1015 return 0;
1017 offset = INTVAL (XEXP (src, 1));
1018 if (code == PLUS)
1019 offset = -offset;
1021 else if (MEM_P (dest))
1023 /* (set (mem (pre_dec (reg sp))) (foo)) */
1024 src = XEXP (dest, 0);
1025 code = GET_CODE (src);
1027 switch (code)
1029 case PRE_MODIFY:
1030 case POST_MODIFY:
1031 if (XEXP (src, 0) == stack_pointer_rtx)
1033 rtx val = XEXP (XEXP (src, 1), 1);
1034 /* We handle only adjustments by constant amount. */
1035 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (XEXP (src, 1)) == PLUS
1036 && GET_CODE (val) == CONST_INT);
1037 offset = -INTVAL (val);
1038 break;
1040 return 0;
1042 case PRE_DEC:
1043 case POST_DEC:
1044 if (XEXP (src, 0) == stack_pointer_rtx)
1046 offset = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (dest));
1047 break;
1049 return 0;
1051 case PRE_INC:
1052 case POST_INC:
1053 if (XEXP (src, 0) == stack_pointer_rtx)
1055 offset = -GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (dest));
1056 break;
1058 return 0;
1060 default:
1061 return 0;
1064 else
1065 return 0;
1067 return offset;
1070 /* Check INSN to see if it looks like a push or a stack adjustment, and
1071 make a note of it if it does. EH uses this information to find out how
1072 much extra space it needs to pop off the stack. */
1074 static void
1075 dwarf2out_stack_adjust (rtx insn, bool after_p ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1077 HOST_WIDE_INT offset;
1078 const char *label;
1079 int i;
1081 /* Don't handle epilogues at all. Certainly it would be wrong to do so
1082 with this function. Proper support would require all frame-related
1083 insns to be marked, and to be able to handle saving state around
1084 epilogues textually in the middle of the function. */
1085 if (prologue_epilogue_contains (insn) || sibcall_epilogue_contains (insn))
1086 return;
1088 if (BARRIER_P (insn))
1090 /* When we see a BARRIER, we know to reset args_size to 0. Usually
1091 the compiler will have already emitted a stack adjustment, but
1092 doesn't bother for calls to noreturn functions. */
1093 #ifdef STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
1094 offset = -args_size;
1095 #else
1096 offset = args_size;
1097 #endif
1099 else if (GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == SET)
1100 offset = stack_adjust_offset (PATTERN (insn));
1101 else if (GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == PARALLEL
1102 || GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == SEQUENCE)
1104 /* There may be stack adjustments inside compound insns. Search
1105 for them. */
1106 for (offset = 0, i = XVECLEN (PATTERN (insn), 0) - 1; i >= 0; i--)
1107 if (GET_CODE (XVECEXP (PATTERN (insn), 0, i)) == SET)
1108 offset += stack_adjust_offset (XVECEXP (PATTERN (insn), 0, i));
1110 else if (GET_CODE (insn) == CALL_INSN)
1111 offset = 0;
1112 else
1113 return;
1115 /* We handle this separately because we want stack adjustments in a
1116 CALL_INSN to be handled. */;
1117 if (GET_CODE (insn) == CALL_INSN)
1119 /* If only calls can throw, adjust args_size only at call sites. */
1120 if (!flag_asynchronous_unwind_tables)
1121 dwarf2out_args_size ("", args_size);
1124 if (offset == 0)
1125 return;
1127 if (cfa.reg == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM)
1128 cfa.offset += offset;
1130 #ifndef STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
1131 offset = -offset;
1132 #endif
1134 args_size += offset;
1135 if (args_size < 0)
1136 args_size = 0;
1138 /* If only calls can throw and we have a frame pointer, we'll save
1139 up adjustments until we see the CALL_INSN. We used to return
1140 early and derive args_size from NARGS in the CALL_INSN itself,
1141 but that doesn't compute the right value if we have nested call
1142 expansions, e.g., stack adjustments for a call have already been
1143 emitted, and then we issue another call to compute an argument
1144 for the enclosing call (i.e., bar (foo ())). */
1145 if (!flag_asynchronous_unwind_tables && cfa.reg != STACK_POINTER_REGNUM)
1146 return;
1148 label = dwarf2out_cfi_label ();
1149 def_cfa_1 (label, &cfa);
1150 if (flag_asynchronous_unwind_tables)
1151 dwarf2out_args_size (label, args_size);
1154 #endif
1156 /* We delay emitting a register save until either (a) we reach the end
1157 of the prologue or (b) the register is clobbered. This clusters
1158 register saves so that there are fewer pc advances. */
1160 struct queued_reg_save GTY(())
1162 struct queued_reg_save *next;
1163 rtx reg;
1164 HOST_WIDE_INT cfa_offset;
1165 rtx saved_reg;
1168 static GTY(()) struct queued_reg_save *queued_reg_saves;
1170 /* The caller's ORIG_REG is saved in SAVED_IN_REG. */
1171 struct reg_saved_in_data GTY(()) {
1172 rtx orig_reg;
1173 rtx saved_in_reg;
1176 /* A list of registers saved in other registers.
1177 The list intentionally has a small maximum capacity of 4; if your
1178 port needs more than that, you might consider implementing a
1179 more efficient data structure. */
1180 static GTY(()) struct reg_saved_in_data regs_saved_in_regs[4];
1181 static GTY(()) size_t num_regs_saved_in_regs;
1183 #if defined (DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO) || defined (DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO)
1184 static const char *last_reg_save_label;
1186 /* Add an entry to QUEUED_REG_SAVES saying that REG is now saved at
1187 SREG, or if SREG is NULL then it is saved at OFFSET to the CFA. */
1189 static void
1190 queue_reg_save (const char *label, rtx reg, rtx sreg, HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
1192 struct queued_reg_save *q;
1194 /* Duplicates waste space, but it's also necessary to remove them
1195 for correctness, since the queue gets output in reverse
1196 order. */
1197 for (q = queued_reg_saves; q != NULL; q = q->next)
1198 if (REGNO (q->reg) == REGNO (reg))
1199 break;
1201 if (q == NULL)
1203 q = ggc_alloc (sizeof (*q));
1204 q->next = queued_reg_saves;
1205 queued_reg_saves = q;
1208 q->reg = reg;
1209 q->cfa_offset = offset;
1210 q->saved_reg = sreg;
1212 last_reg_save_label = label;
1215 /* Output all the entries in QUEUED_REG_SAVES. */
1217 static void
1218 flush_queued_reg_saves (void)
1220 struct queued_reg_save *q;
1222 for (q = queued_reg_saves; q; q = q->next)
1224 size_t i;
1225 unsigned int reg, sreg;
1227 for (i = 0; i < num_regs_saved_in_regs; i++)
1228 if (REGNO (regs_saved_in_regs[i].orig_reg) == REGNO (q->reg))
1229 break;
1230 if (q->saved_reg && i == num_regs_saved_in_regs)
1232 gcc_assert (i != ARRAY_SIZE (regs_saved_in_regs));
1233 num_regs_saved_in_regs++;
1235 if (i != num_regs_saved_in_regs)
1237 regs_saved_in_regs[i].orig_reg = q->reg;
1238 regs_saved_in_regs[i].saved_in_reg = q->saved_reg;
1241 reg = DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO (q->reg));
1242 if (q->saved_reg)
1243 sreg = DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO (q->saved_reg));
1244 else
1245 sreg = INVALID_REGNUM;
1246 reg_save (last_reg_save_label, reg, sreg, q->cfa_offset);
1249 queued_reg_saves = NULL;
1250 last_reg_save_label = NULL;
1253 /* Does INSN clobber any register which QUEUED_REG_SAVES lists a saved
1254 location for? Or, does it clobber a register which we've previously
1255 said that some other register is saved in, and for which we now
1256 have a new location for? */
1258 static bool
1259 clobbers_queued_reg_save (rtx insn)
1261 struct queued_reg_save *q;
1263 for (q = queued_reg_saves; q; q = q->next)
1265 size_t i;
1266 if (modified_in_p (q->reg, insn))
1267 return true;
1268 for (i = 0; i < num_regs_saved_in_regs; i++)
1269 if (REGNO (q->reg) == REGNO (regs_saved_in_regs[i].orig_reg)
1270 && modified_in_p (regs_saved_in_regs[i].saved_in_reg, insn))
1271 return true;
1274 return false;
1277 /* Entry point for saving the first register into the second. */
1279 void
1280 dwarf2out_reg_save_reg (const char *label, rtx reg, rtx sreg)
1282 size_t i;
1283 unsigned int regno, sregno;
1285 for (i = 0; i < num_regs_saved_in_regs; i++)
1286 if (REGNO (regs_saved_in_regs[i].orig_reg) == REGNO (reg))
1287 break;
1288 if (i == num_regs_saved_in_regs)
1290 gcc_assert (i != ARRAY_SIZE (regs_saved_in_regs));
1291 num_regs_saved_in_regs++;
1293 regs_saved_in_regs[i].orig_reg = reg;
1294 regs_saved_in_regs[i].saved_in_reg = sreg;
1296 regno = DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO (reg));
1297 sregno = DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO (sreg));
1298 reg_save (label, regno, sregno, 0);
1301 /* What register, if any, is currently saved in REG? */
1303 static rtx
1304 reg_saved_in (rtx reg)
1306 unsigned int regn = REGNO (reg);
1307 size_t i;
1308 struct queued_reg_save *q;
1310 for (q = queued_reg_saves; q; q = q->next)
1311 if (q->saved_reg && regn == REGNO (q->saved_reg))
1312 return q->reg;
1314 for (i = 0; i < num_regs_saved_in_regs; i++)
1315 if (regs_saved_in_regs[i].saved_in_reg
1316 && regn == REGNO (regs_saved_in_regs[i].saved_in_reg))
1317 return regs_saved_in_regs[i].orig_reg;
1319 return NULL_RTX;
1323 /* A temporary register holding an integral value used in adjusting SP
1324 or setting up the store_reg. The "offset" field holds the integer
1325 value, not an offset. */
1326 static dw_cfa_location cfa_temp;
1328 /* Record call frame debugging information for an expression EXPR,
1329 which either sets SP or FP (adjusting how we calculate the frame
1330 address) or saves a register to the stack or another register.
1331 LABEL indicates the address of EXPR.
1333 This function encodes a state machine mapping rtxes to actions on
1334 cfa, cfa_store, and cfa_temp.reg. We describe these rules so
1335 users need not read the source code.
1337 The High-Level Picture
1339 Changes in the register we use to calculate the CFA: Currently we
1340 assume that if you copy the CFA register into another register, we
1341 should take the other one as the new CFA register; this seems to
1342 work pretty well. If it's wrong for some target, it's simple
1343 enough not to set RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P on the insn in question.
1345 Changes in the register we use for saving registers to the stack:
1346 This is usually SP, but not always. Again, we deduce that if you
1347 copy SP into another register (and SP is not the CFA register),
1348 then the new register is the one we will be using for register
1349 saves. This also seems to work.
1351 Register saves: There's not much guesswork about this one; if
1352 RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P is set on an insn which modifies memory, it's a
1353 register save, and the register used to calculate the destination
1354 had better be the one we think we're using for this purpose.
1355 It's also assumed that a copy from a call-saved register to another
1356 register is saving that register if RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P is set on
1357 that instruction. If the copy is from a call-saved register to
1358 the *same* register, that means that the register is now the same
1359 value as in the caller.
1361 Except: If the register being saved is the CFA register, and the
1362 offset is nonzero, we are saving the CFA, so we assume we have to
1363 use DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression. If the offset is 0, we assume that
1364 the intent is to save the value of SP from the previous frame.
1366 In addition, if a register has previously been saved to a different
1367 register,
1369 Invariants / Summaries of Rules
1371 cfa current rule for calculating the CFA. It usually
1372 consists of a register and an offset.
1373 cfa_store register used by prologue code to save things to the stack
1374 cfa_store.offset is the offset from the value of
1375 cfa_store.reg to the actual CFA
1376 cfa_temp register holding an integral value. cfa_temp.offset
1377 stores the value, which will be used to adjust the
1378 stack pointer. cfa_temp is also used like cfa_store,
1379 to track stores to the stack via fp or a temp reg.
1381 Rules 1- 4: Setting a register's value to cfa.reg or an expression
1382 with cfa.reg as the first operand changes the cfa.reg and its
1383 cfa.offset. Rule 1 and 4 also set cfa_temp.reg and
1384 cfa_temp.offset.
1386 Rules 6- 9: Set a non-cfa.reg register value to a constant or an
1387 expression yielding a constant. This sets cfa_temp.reg
1388 and cfa_temp.offset.
1390 Rule 5: Create a new register cfa_store used to save items to the
1391 stack.
1393 Rules 10-14: Save a register to the stack. Define offset as the
1394 difference of the original location and cfa_store's
1395 location (or cfa_temp's location if cfa_temp is used).
1397 The Rules
1399 "{a,b}" indicates a choice of a xor b.
1400 "<reg>:cfa.reg" indicates that <reg> must equal cfa.reg.
1402 Rule 1:
1403 (set <reg1> <reg2>:cfa.reg)
1404 effects: cfa.reg = <reg1>
1405 cfa.offset unchanged
1406 cfa_temp.reg = <reg1>
1407 cfa_temp.offset = cfa.offset
1409 Rule 2:
1410 (set sp ({minus,plus,losum} {sp,fp}:cfa.reg
1411 {<const_int>,<reg>:cfa_temp.reg}))
1412 effects: cfa.reg = sp if fp used
1413 cfa.offset += {+/- <const_int>, cfa_temp.offset} if cfa.reg==sp
1414 cfa_store.offset += {+/- <const_int>, cfa_temp.offset}
1415 if cfa_store.reg==sp
1417 Rule 3:
1418 (set fp ({minus,plus,losum} <reg>:cfa.reg <const_int>))
1419 effects: cfa.reg = fp
1420 cfa_offset += +/- <const_int>
1422 Rule 4:
1423 (set <reg1> ({plus,losum} <reg2>:cfa.reg <const_int>))
1424 constraints: <reg1> != fp
1425 <reg1> != sp
1426 effects: cfa.reg = <reg1>
1427 cfa_temp.reg = <reg1>
1428 cfa_temp.offset = cfa.offset
1430 Rule 5:
1431 (set <reg1> (plus <reg2>:cfa_temp.reg sp:cfa.reg))
1432 constraints: <reg1> != fp
1433 <reg1> != sp
1434 effects: cfa_store.reg = <reg1>
1435 cfa_store.offset = cfa.offset - cfa_temp.offset
1437 Rule 6:
1438 (set <reg> <const_int>)
1439 effects: cfa_temp.reg = <reg>
1440 cfa_temp.offset = <const_int>
1442 Rule 7:
1443 (set <reg1>:cfa_temp.reg (ior <reg2>:cfa_temp.reg <const_int>))
1444 effects: cfa_temp.reg = <reg1>
1445 cfa_temp.offset |= <const_int>
1447 Rule 8:
1448 (set <reg> (high <exp>))
1449 effects: none
1451 Rule 9:
1452 (set <reg> (lo_sum <exp> <const_int>))
1453 effects: cfa_temp.reg = <reg>
1454 cfa_temp.offset = <const_int>
1456 Rule 10:
1457 (set (mem (pre_modify sp:cfa_store (???? <reg1> <const_int>))) <reg2>)
1458 effects: cfa_store.offset -= <const_int>
1459 cfa.offset = cfa_store.offset if cfa.reg == sp
1460 cfa.reg = sp
1461 cfa.base_offset = -cfa_store.offset
1463 Rule 11:
1464 (set (mem ({pre_inc,pre_dec} sp:cfa_store.reg)) <reg>)
1465 effects: cfa_store.offset += -/+ mode_size(mem)
1466 cfa.offset = cfa_store.offset if cfa.reg == sp
1467 cfa.reg = sp
1468 cfa.base_offset = -cfa_store.offset
1470 Rule 12:
1471 (set (mem ({minus,plus,losum} <reg1>:{cfa_store,cfa_temp} <const_int>))
1473 <reg2>)
1474 effects: cfa.reg = <reg1>
1475 cfa.base_offset = -/+ <const_int> - {cfa_store,cfa_temp}.offset
1477 Rule 13:
1478 (set (mem <reg1>:{cfa_store,cfa_temp}) <reg2>)
1479 effects: cfa.reg = <reg1>
1480 cfa.base_offset = -{cfa_store,cfa_temp}.offset
1482 Rule 14:
1483 (set (mem (postinc <reg1>:cfa_temp <const_int>)) <reg2>)
1484 effects: cfa.reg = <reg1>
1485 cfa.base_offset = -cfa_temp.offset
1486 cfa_temp.offset -= mode_size(mem)
1488   Rule 15:
1489   (set <reg> {unspec, unspec_volatile})
1490   effects: target-dependent */
1492 static void
1493 dwarf2out_frame_debug_expr (rtx expr, const char *label)
1495 rtx src, dest;
1496 HOST_WIDE_INT offset;
1498 /* If RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P is set on a PARALLEL, process each member of
1499 the PARALLEL independently. The first element is always processed if
1500 it is a SET. This is for backward compatibility. Other elements
1501 are processed only if they are SETs and the RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P
1502 flag is set in them. */
1503 if (GET_CODE (expr) == PARALLEL || GET_CODE (expr) == SEQUENCE)
1505 int par_index;
1506 int limit = XVECLEN (expr, 0);
1508 for (par_index = 0; par_index < limit; par_index++)
1509 if (GET_CODE (XVECEXP (expr, 0, par_index)) == SET
1510 && (RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P (XVECEXP (expr, 0, par_index))
1511 || par_index == 0))
1512 dwarf2out_frame_debug_expr (XVECEXP (expr, 0, par_index), label);
1514 return;
1517 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (expr) == SET);
1519 src = SET_SRC (expr);
1520 dest = SET_DEST (expr);
1522 if (REG_P (src))
1524 rtx rsi = reg_saved_in (src);
1525 if (rsi)
1526 src = rsi;
1529 switch (GET_CODE (dest))
1531 case REG:
1532 switch (GET_CODE (src))
1534 /* Setting FP from SP. */
1535 case REG:
1536 if (cfa.reg == (unsigned) REGNO (src))
1538 /* Rule 1 */
1539 /* Update the CFA rule wrt SP or FP. Make sure src is
1540 relative to the current CFA register.
1542 We used to require that dest be either SP or FP, but the
1543 ARM copies SP to a temporary register, and from there to
1544 FP. So we just rely on the backends to only set
1545 RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P on appropriate insns. */
1546 cfa.reg = REGNO (dest);
1547 cfa_temp.reg = cfa.reg;
1548 cfa_temp.offset = cfa.offset;
1550 else
1552 /* Saving a register in a register. */
1553 gcc_assert (!fixed_regs [REGNO (dest)]
1554 /* For the SPARC and its register window. */
1555 || (DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO (src))
1556 == DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN));
1557 queue_reg_save (label, src, dest, 0);
1559 break;
1561 case PLUS:
1562 case MINUS:
1563 case LO_SUM:
1564 if (dest == stack_pointer_rtx)
1566 /* Rule 2 */
1567 /* Adjusting SP. */
1568 switch (GET_CODE (XEXP (src, 1)))
1570 case CONST_INT:
1571 offset = INTVAL (XEXP (src, 1));
1572 break;
1573 case REG:
1574 gcc_assert ((unsigned) REGNO (XEXP (src, 1))
1575 == cfa_temp.reg);
1576 offset = cfa_temp.offset;
1577 break;
1578 default:
1579 gcc_unreachable ();
1582 if (XEXP (src, 0) == hard_frame_pointer_rtx)
1584 /* Restoring SP from FP in the epilogue. */
1585 gcc_assert (cfa.reg == (unsigned) HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM);
1586 cfa.reg = STACK_POINTER_REGNUM;
1588 else if (GET_CODE (src) == LO_SUM)
1589 /* Assume we've set the source reg of the LO_SUM from sp. */
1591 else
1592 gcc_assert (XEXP (src, 0) == stack_pointer_rtx);
1594 if (GET_CODE (src) != MINUS)
1595 offset = -offset;
1596 if (cfa.reg == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM)
1597 cfa.offset += offset;
1598 if (cfa_store.reg == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM)
1599 cfa_store.offset += offset;
1601 else if (dest == hard_frame_pointer_rtx)
1603 /* Rule 3 */
1604 /* Either setting the FP from an offset of the SP,
1605 or adjusting the FP */
1606 gcc_assert (frame_pointer_needed);
1608 gcc_assert (REG_P (XEXP (src, 0))
1609 && (unsigned) REGNO (XEXP (src, 0)) == cfa.reg
1610 && GET_CODE (XEXP (src, 1)) == CONST_INT);
1611 offset = INTVAL (XEXP (src, 1));
1612 if (GET_CODE (src) != MINUS)
1613 offset = -offset;
1614 cfa.offset += offset;
1615 cfa.reg = HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM;
1617 else
1619 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (src) != MINUS);
1621 /* Rule 4 */
1622 if (REG_P (XEXP (src, 0))
1623 && REGNO (XEXP (src, 0)) == cfa.reg
1624 && GET_CODE (XEXP (src, 1)) == CONST_INT)
1626 /* Setting a temporary CFA register that will be copied
1627 into the FP later on. */
1628 offset = - INTVAL (XEXP (src, 1));
1629 cfa.offset += offset;
1630 cfa.reg = REGNO (dest);
1631 /* Or used to save regs to the stack. */
1632 cfa_temp.reg = cfa.reg;
1633 cfa_temp.offset = cfa.offset;
1636 /* Rule 5 */
1637 else if (REG_P (XEXP (src, 0))
1638 && REGNO (XEXP (src, 0)) == cfa_temp.reg
1639 && XEXP (src, 1) == stack_pointer_rtx)
1641 /* Setting a scratch register that we will use instead
1642 of SP for saving registers to the stack. */
1643 gcc_assert (cfa.reg == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM);
1644 cfa_store.reg = REGNO (dest);
1645 cfa_store.offset = cfa.offset - cfa_temp.offset;
1648 /* Rule 9 */
1649 else if (GET_CODE (src) == LO_SUM
1650 && GET_CODE (XEXP (src, 1)) == CONST_INT)
1652 cfa_temp.reg = REGNO (dest);
1653 cfa_temp.offset = INTVAL (XEXP (src, 1));
1655 else
1656 gcc_unreachable ();
1658 break;
1660 /* Rule 6 */
1661 case CONST_INT:
1662 cfa_temp.reg = REGNO (dest);
1663 cfa_temp.offset = INTVAL (src);
1664 break;
1666 /* Rule 7 */
1667 case IOR:
1668 gcc_assert (REG_P (XEXP (src, 0))
1669 && (unsigned) REGNO (XEXP (src, 0)) == cfa_temp.reg
1670 && GET_CODE (XEXP (src, 1)) == CONST_INT);
1672 if ((unsigned) REGNO (dest) != cfa_temp.reg)
1673 cfa_temp.reg = REGNO (dest);
1674 cfa_temp.offset |= INTVAL (XEXP (src, 1));
1675 break;
1677 /* Skip over HIGH, assuming it will be followed by a LO_SUM,
1678 which will fill in all of the bits. */
1679 /* Rule 8 */
1680 case HIGH:
1681 break;
1683 /* Rule 15 */
1684 case UNSPEC:
1685 case UNSPEC_VOLATILE:
1686 gcc_assert (targetm.dwarf_handle_frame_unspec);
1687 targetm.dwarf_handle_frame_unspec (label, expr, XINT (src, 1));
1688 return;
1690 default:
1691 gcc_unreachable ();
1694 def_cfa_1 (label, &cfa);
1695 break;
1697 case MEM:
1698 gcc_assert (REG_P (src));
1700 /* Saving a register to the stack. Make sure dest is relative to the
1701 CFA register. */
1702 switch (GET_CODE (XEXP (dest, 0)))
1704 /* Rule 10 */
1705 /* With a push. */
1706 case PRE_MODIFY:
1707 /* We can't handle variable size modifications. */
1708 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (XEXP (dest, 0), 1), 1))
1709 == CONST_INT);
1710 offset = -INTVAL (XEXP (XEXP (XEXP (dest, 0), 1), 1));
1712 gcc_assert (REGNO (XEXP (XEXP (dest, 0), 0)) == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
1713 && cfa_store.reg == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM);
1715 cfa_store.offset += offset;
1716 if (cfa.reg == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM)
1717 cfa.offset = cfa_store.offset;
1719 offset = -cfa_store.offset;
1720 break;
1722 /* Rule 11 */
1723 case PRE_INC:
1724 case PRE_DEC:
1725 offset = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (dest));
1726 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (dest, 0)) == PRE_INC)
1727 offset = -offset;
1729 gcc_assert (REGNO (XEXP (XEXP (dest, 0), 0)) == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
1730 && cfa_store.reg == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM);
1732 cfa_store.offset += offset;
1733 if (cfa.reg == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM)
1734 cfa.offset = cfa_store.offset;
1736 offset = -cfa_store.offset;
1737 break;
1739 /* Rule 12 */
1740 /* With an offset. */
1741 case PLUS:
1742 case MINUS:
1743 case LO_SUM:
1745 int regno;
1747 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (dest, 0), 1)) == CONST_INT
1748 && REG_P (XEXP (XEXP (dest, 0), 0)));
1749 offset = INTVAL (XEXP (XEXP (dest, 0), 1));
1750 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (dest, 0)) == MINUS)
1751 offset = -offset;
1753 regno = REGNO (XEXP (XEXP (dest, 0), 0));
1755 if (cfa_store.reg == (unsigned) regno)
1756 offset -= cfa_store.offset;
1757 else
1759 gcc_assert (cfa_temp.reg == (unsigned) regno);
1760 offset -= cfa_temp.offset;
1763 break;
1765 /* Rule 13 */
1766 /* Without an offset. */
1767 case REG:
1769 int regno = REGNO (XEXP (dest, 0));
1771 if (cfa_store.reg == (unsigned) regno)
1772 offset = -cfa_store.offset;
1773 else
1775 gcc_assert (cfa_temp.reg == (unsigned) regno);
1776 offset = -cfa_temp.offset;
1779 break;
1781 /* Rule 14 */
1782 case POST_INC:
1783 gcc_assert (cfa_temp.reg
1784 == (unsigned) REGNO (XEXP (XEXP (dest, 0), 0)));
1785 offset = -cfa_temp.offset;
1786 cfa_temp.offset -= GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (dest));
1787 break;
1789 default:
1790 gcc_unreachable ();
1793 if (REGNO (src) != STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
1794 && REGNO (src) != HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
1795 && (unsigned) REGNO (src) == cfa.reg)
1797 /* We're storing the current CFA reg into the stack. */
1799 if (cfa.offset == 0)
1801 /* If the source register is exactly the CFA, assume
1802 we're saving SP like any other register; this happens
1803 on the ARM. */
1804 def_cfa_1 (label, &cfa);
1805 queue_reg_save (label, stack_pointer_rtx, NULL_RTX, offset);
1806 break;
1808 else
1810 /* Otherwise, we'll need to look in the stack to
1811 calculate the CFA. */
1812 rtx x = XEXP (dest, 0);
1814 if (!REG_P (x))
1815 x = XEXP (x, 0);
1816 gcc_assert (REG_P (x));
1818 cfa.reg = REGNO (x);
1819 cfa.base_offset = offset;
1820 cfa.indirect = 1;
1821 def_cfa_1 (label, &cfa);
1822 break;
1826 def_cfa_1 (label, &cfa);
1827 queue_reg_save (label, src, NULL_RTX, offset);
1828 break;
1830 default:
1831 gcc_unreachable ();
1835 /* Record call frame debugging information for INSN, which either
1836 sets SP or FP (adjusting how we calculate the frame address) or saves a
1837 register to the stack. If INSN is NULL_RTX, initialize our state.
1839 If AFTER_P is false, we're being called before the insn is emitted,
1840 otherwise after. Call instructions get invoked twice. */
1842 void
1843 dwarf2out_frame_debug (rtx insn, bool after_p)
1845 const char *label;
1846 rtx src;
1848 if (insn == NULL_RTX)
1850 size_t i;
1852 /* Flush any queued register saves. */
1853 flush_queued_reg_saves ();
1855 /* Set up state for generating call frame debug info. */
1856 lookup_cfa (&cfa);
1857 gcc_assert (cfa.reg
1858 == (unsigned long)DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (STACK_POINTER_REGNUM));
1860 cfa.reg = STACK_POINTER_REGNUM;
1861 cfa_store = cfa;
1862 cfa_temp.reg = -1;
1863 cfa_temp.offset = 0;
1865 for (i = 0; i < num_regs_saved_in_regs; i++)
1867 regs_saved_in_regs[i].orig_reg = NULL_RTX;
1868 regs_saved_in_regs[i].saved_in_reg = NULL_RTX;
1870 num_regs_saved_in_regs = 0;
1871 return;
1874 if (!NONJUMP_INSN_P (insn) || clobbers_queued_reg_save (insn))
1875 flush_queued_reg_saves ();
1877 if (! RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P (insn))
1879 if (!ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS)
1880 dwarf2out_stack_adjust (insn, after_p);
1881 return;
1884 label = dwarf2out_cfi_label ();
1885 src = find_reg_note (insn, REG_FRAME_RELATED_EXPR, NULL_RTX);
1886 if (src)
1887 insn = XEXP (src, 0);
1888 else
1889 insn = PATTERN (insn);
1891 dwarf2out_frame_debug_expr (insn, label);
1894 #endif
1896 /* Describe for the GTY machinery what parts of dw_cfi_oprnd1 are used. */
1897 static enum dw_cfi_oprnd_type dw_cfi_oprnd1_desc
1898 (enum dwarf_call_frame_info cfi);
1900 static enum dw_cfi_oprnd_type
1901 dw_cfi_oprnd1_desc (enum dwarf_call_frame_info cfi)
1903 switch (cfi)
1905 case DW_CFA_nop:
1906 case DW_CFA_GNU_window_save:
1907 return dw_cfi_oprnd_unused;
1909 case DW_CFA_set_loc:
1910 case DW_CFA_advance_loc1:
1911 case DW_CFA_advance_loc2:
1912 case DW_CFA_advance_loc4:
1913 case DW_CFA_MIPS_advance_loc8:
1914 return dw_cfi_oprnd_addr;
1916 case DW_CFA_offset:
1917 case DW_CFA_offset_extended:
1918 case DW_CFA_def_cfa:
1919 case DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf:
1920 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf:
1921 case DW_CFA_restore_extended:
1922 case DW_CFA_undefined:
1923 case DW_CFA_same_value:
1924 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_register:
1925 case DW_CFA_register:
1926 return dw_cfi_oprnd_reg_num;
1928 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset:
1929 case DW_CFA_GNU_args_size:
1930 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset_sf:
1931 return dw_cfi_oprnd_offset;
1933 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression:
1934 case DW_CFA_expression:
1935 return dw_cfi_oprnd_loc;
1937 default:
1938 gcc_unreachable ();
1942 /* Describe for the GTY machinery what parts of dw_cfi_oprnd2 are used. */
1943 static enum dw_cfi_oprnd_type dw_cfi_oprnd2_desc
1944 (enum dwarf_call_frame_info cfi);
1946 static enum dw_cfi_oprnd_type
1947 dw_cfi_oprnd2_desc (enum dwarf_call_frame_info cfi)
1949 switch (cfi)
1951 case DW_CFA_def_cfa:
1952 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf:
1953 case DW_CFA_offset:
1954 case DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf:
1955 case DW_CFA_offset_extended:
1956 return dw_cfi_oprnd_offset;
1958 case DW_CFA_register:
1959 return dw_cfi_oprnd_reg_num;
1961 default:
1962 return dw_cfi_oprnd_unused;
1966 #if defined (DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO) || defined (DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO)
1968 /* Switch to eh_frame_section. If we don't have an eh_frame_section,
1969 switch to the data section instead, and write out a synthetic label
1970 for collect2. */
1972 static void
1973 switch_to_eh_frame_section (void)
1975 tree label;
1977 #ifdef EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME
1978 if (eh_frame_section == 0)
1980 int flags;
1982 if (EH_TABLES_CAN_BE_READ_ONLY)
1984 int fde_encoding;
1985 int per_encoding;
1986 int lsda_encoding;
1988 fde_encoding = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/1,
1989 /*global=*/0);
1990 per_encoding = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/2,
1991 /*global=*/1);
1992 lsda_encoding = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/0,
1993 /*global=*/0);
1994 flags = ((! flag_pic
1995 || ((fde_encoding & 0x70) != DW_EH_PE_absptr
1996 && (fde_encoding & 0x70) != DW_EH_PE_aligned
1997 && (per_encoding & 0x70) != DW_EH_PE_absptr
1998 && (per_encoding & 0x70) != DW_EH_PE_aligned
1999 && (lsda_encoding & 0x70) != DW_EH_PE_absptr
2000 && (lsda_encoding & 0x70) != DW_EH_PE_aligned))
2001 ? 0 : SECTION_WRITE);
2003 else
2004 flags = SECTION_WRITE;
2005 eh_frame_section = get_section (EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME, flags, NULL);
2007 #endif
2009 if (eh_frame_section)
2010 switch_to_section (eh_frame_section);
2011 else
2013 /* We have no special eh_frame section. Put the information in
2014 the data section and emit special labels to guide collect2. */
2015 switch_to_section (data_section);
2016 label = get_file_function_name ('F');
2017 ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (asm_out_file, floor_log2 (PTR_SIZE));
2018 targetm.asm_out.globalize_label (asm_out_file,
2019 IDENTIFIER_POINTER (label));
2020 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, IDENTIFIER_POINTER (label));
2024 /* Output a Call Frame Information opcode and its operand(s). */
2026 static void
2027 output_cfi (dw_cfi_ref cfi, dw_fde_ref fde, int for_eh)
2029 unsigned long r;
2030 if (cfi->dw_cfi_opc == DW_CFA_advance_loc)
2031 dw2_asm_output_data (1, (cfi->dw_cfi_opc
2032 | (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_offset & 0x3f)),
2033 "DW_CFA_advance_loc " HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_HEX,
2034 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_offset);
2035 else if (cfi->dw_cfi_opc == DW_CFA_offset)
2037 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num, for_eh);
2038 dw2_asm_output_data (1, (cfi->dw_cfi_opc | (r & 0x3f)),
2039 "DW_CFA_offset, column 0x%lx", r);
2040 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_offset, NULL);
2042 else if (cfi->dw_cfi_opc == DW_CFA_restore)
2044 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num, for_eh);
2045 dw2_asm_output_data (1, (cfi->dw_cfi_opc | (r & 0x3f)),
2046 "DW_CFA_restore, column 0x%lx", r);
2048 else
2050 dw2_asm_output_data (1, cfi->dw_cfi_opc,
2051 "%s", dwarf_cfi_name (cfi->dw_cfi_opc));
2053 switch (cfi->dw_cfi_opc)
2055 case DW_CFA_set_loc:
2056 if (for_eh)
2057 dw2_asm_output_encoded_addr_rtx (
2058 ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/1, /*global=*/0),
2059 gen_rtx_SYMBOL_REF (Pmode, cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr),
2060 false, NULL);
2061 else
2062 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
2063 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr, NULL);
2064 break;
2066 case DW_CFA_advance_loc1:
2067 dw2_asm_output_delta (1, cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr,
2068 fde->dw_fde_current_label, NULL);
2069 fde->dw_fde_current_label = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr;
2070 break;
2072 case DW_CFA_advance_loc2:
2073 dw2_asm_output_delta (2, cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr,
2074 fde->dw_fde_current_label, NULL);
2075 fde->dw_fde_current_label = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr;
2076 break;
2078 case DW_CFA_advance_loc4:
2079 dw2_asm_output_delta (4, cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr,
2080 fde->dw_fde_current_label, NULL);
2081 fde->dw_fde_current_label = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr;
2082 break;
2084 case DW_CFA_MIPS_advance_loc8:
2085 dw2_asm_output_delta (8, cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr,
2086 fde->dw_fde_current_label, NULL);
2087 fde->dw_fde_current_label = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr;
2088 break;
2090 case DW_CFA_offset_extended:
2091 case DW_CFA_def_cfa:
2092 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num, for_eh);
2093 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (r, NULL);
2094 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_offset, NULL);
2095 break;
2097 case DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf:
2098 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf:
2099 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num, for_eh);
2100 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (r, NULL);
2101 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_offset, NULL);
2102 break;
2104 case DW_CFA_restore_extended:
2105 case DW_CFA_undefined:
2106 case DW_CFA_same_value:
2107 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_register:
2108 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num, for_eh);
2109 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (r, NULL);
2110 break;
2112 case DW_CFA_register:
2113 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num, for_eh);
2114 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (r, NULL);
2115 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_reg_num, for_eh);
2116 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (r, NULL);
2117 break;
2119 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset:
2120 case DW_CFA_GNU_args_size:
2121 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_offset, NULL);
2122 break;
2124 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset_sf:
2125 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_offset, NULL);
2126 break;
2128 case DW_CFA_GNU_window_save:
2129 break;
2131 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression:
2132 case DW_CFA_expression:
2133 output_cfa_loc (cfi);
2134 break;
2136 case DW_CFA_GNU_negative_offset_extended:
2137 /* Obsoleted by DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf. */
2138 gcc_unreachable ();
2140 default:
2141 break;
2146 /* Output the call frame information used to record information
2147 that relates to calculating the frame pointer, and records the
2148 location of saved registers. */
2150 static void
2151 output_call_frame_info (int for_eh)
2153 unsigned int i;
2154 dw_fde_ref fde;
2155 dw_cfi_ref cfi;
2156 char l1[20], l2[20], section_start_label[20];
2157 bool any_lsda_needed = false;
2158 char augmentation[6];
2159 int augmentation_size;
2160 int fde_encoding = DW_EH_PE_absptr;
2161 int per_encoding = DW_EH_PE_absptr;
2162 int lsda_encoding = DW_EH_PE_absptr;
2163 int return_reg;
2165 /* Don't emit a CIE if there won't be any FDEs. */
2166 if (fde_table_in_use == 0)
2167 return;
2169 /* If we make FDEs linkonce, we may have to emit an empty label for
2170 an FDE that wouldn't otherwise be emitted. We want to avoid
2171 having an FDE kept around when the function it refers to is
2172 discarded. Example where this matters: a primary function
2173 template in C++ requires EH information, but an explicit
2174 specialization doesn't. */
2175 if (TARGET_USES_WEAK_UNWIND_INFO
2176 && ! flag_asynchronous_unwind_tables
2177 && for_eh)
2178 for (i = 0; i < fde_table_in_use; i++)
2179 if ((fde_table[i].nothrow || fde_table[i].all_throwers_are_sibcalls)
2180 && !fde_table[i].uses_eh_lsda
2181 && ! DECL_WEAK (fde_table[i].decl))
2182 targetm.asm_out.unwind_label (asm_out_file, fde_table[i].decl,
2183 for_eh, /* empty */ 1);
2185 /* If we don't have any functions we'll want to unwind out of, don't
2186 emit any EH unwind information. Note that if exceptions aren't
2187 enabled, we won't have collected nothrow information, and if we
2188 asked for asynchronous tables, we always want this info. */
2189 if (for_eh)
2191 bool any_eh_needed = !flag_exceptions || flag_asynchronous_unwind_tables;
2193 for (i = 0; i < fde_table_in_use; i++)
2194 if (fde_table[i].uses_eh_lsda)
2195 any_eh_needed = any_lsda_needed = true;
2196 else if (TARGET_USES_WEAK_UNWIND_INFO && DECL_WEAK (fde_table[i].decl))
2197 any_eh_needed = true;
2198 else if (! fde_table[i].nothrow
2199 && ! fde_table[i].all_throwers_are_sibcalls)
2200 any_eh_needed = true;
2202 if (! any_eh_needed)
2203 return;
2206 /* We're going to be generating comments, so turn on app. */
2207 if (flag_debug_asm)
2208 app_enable ();
2210 if (for_eh)
2211 switch_to_eh_frame_section ();
2212 else
2213 switch_to_section (debug_frame_section);
2215 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (section_start_label, FRAME_BEGIN_LABEL, for_eh);
2216 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, section_start_label);
2218 /* Output the CIE. */
2219 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l1, CIE_AFTER_SIZE_LABEL, for_eh);
2220 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l2, CIE_END_LABEL, for_eh);
2221 dw2_asm_output_delta (for_eh ? 4 : DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, l2, l1,
2222 "Length of Common Information Entry");
2223 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l1);
2225 /* Now that the CIE pointer is PC-relative for EH,
2226 use 0 to identify the CIE. */
2227 dw2_asm_output_data ((for_eh ? 4 : DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE),
2228 (for_eh ? 0 : DW_CIE_ID),
2229 "CIE Identifier Tag");
2231 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_CIE_VERSION, "CIE Version");
2233 augmentation[0] = 0;
2234 augmentation_size = 0;
2235 if (for_eh)
2237 char *p;
2239 /* Augmentation:
2240 z Indicates that a uleb128 is present to size the
2241 augmentation section.
2242 L Indicates the encoding (and thus presence) of
2243 an LSDA pointer in the FDE augmentation.
2244 R Indicates a non-default pointer encoding for
2245 FDE code pointers.
2246 P Indicates the presence of an encoding + language
2247 personality routine in the CIE augmentation. */
2249 fde_encoding = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/1, /*global=*/0);
2250 per_encoding = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/2, /*global=*/1);
2251 lsda_encoding = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/0, /*global=*/0);
2253 p = augmentation + 1;
2254 if (eh_personality_libfunc)
2256 *p++ = 'P';
2257 augmentation_size += 1 + size_of_encoded_value (per_encoding);
2259 if (any_lsda_needed)
2261 *p++ = 'L';
2262 augmentation_size += 1;
2264 if (fde_encoding != DW_EH_PE_absptr)
2266 *p++ = 'R';
2267 augmentation_size += 1;
2269 if (p > augmentation + 1)
2271 augmentation[0] = 'z';
2272 *p = '\0';
2275 /* Ug. Some platforms can't do unaligned dynamic relocations at all. */
2276 if (eh_personality_libfunc && per_encoding == DW_EH_PE_aligned)
2278 int offset = ( 4 /* Length */
2279 + 4 /* CIE Id */
2280 + 1 /* CIE version */
2281 + strlen (augmentation) + 1 /* Augmentation */
2282 + size_of_uleb128 (1) /* Code alignment */
2283 + size_of_sleb128 (DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT)
2284 + 1 /* RA column */
2285 + 1 /* Augmentation size */
2286 + 1 /* Personality encoding */ );
2287 int pad = -offset & (PTR_SIZE - 1);
2289 augmentation_size += pad;
2291 /* Augmentations should be small, so there's scarce need to
2292 iterate for a solution. Die if we exceed one uleb128 byte. */
2293 gcc_assert (size_of_uleb128 (augmentation_size) == 1);
2297 dw2_asm_output_nstring (augmentation, -1, "CIE Augmentation");
2298 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1, "CIE Code Alignment Factor");
2299 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT,
2300 "CIE Data Alignment Factor");
2302 return_reg = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN, for_eh);
2303 if (DW_CIE_VERSION == 1)
2304 dw2_asm_output_data (1, return_reg, "CIE RA Column");
2305 else
2306 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (return_reg, "CIE RA Column");
2308 if (augmentation[0])
2310 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (augmentation_size, "Augmentation size");
2311 if (eh_personality_libfunc)
2313 dw2_asm_output_data (1, per_encoding, "Personality (%s)",
2314 eh_data_format_name (per_encoding));
2315 dw2_asm_output_encoded_addr_rtx (per_encoding,
2316 eh_personality_libfunc,
2317 true, NULL);
2320 if (any_lsda_needed)
2321 dw2_asm_output_data (1, lsda_encoding, "LSDA Encoding (%s)",
2322 eh_data_format_name (lsda_encoding));
2324 if (fde_encoding != DW_EH_PE_absptr)
2325 dw2_asm_output_data (1, fde_encoding, "FDE Encoding (%s)",
2326 eh_data_format_name (fde_encoding));
2329 for (cfi = cie_cfi_head; cfi != NULL; cfi = cfi->dw_cfi_next)
2330 output_cfi (cfi, NULL, for_eh);
2332 /* Pad the CIE out to an address sized boundary. */
2333 ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (asm_out_file,
2334 floor_log2 (for_eh ? PTR_SIZE : DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE));
2335 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l2);
2337 /* Loop through all of the FDE's. */
2338 for (i = 0; i < fde_table_in_use; i++)
2340 fde = &fde_table[i];
2342 /* Don't emit EH unwind info for leaf functions that don't need it. */
2343 if (for_eh && !flag_asynchronous_unwind_tables && flag_exceptions
2344 && (fde->nothrow || fde->all_throwers_are_sibcalls)
2345 && ! (TARGET_USES_WEAK_UNWIND_INFO && DECL_WEAK (fde_table[i].decl))
2346 && !fde->uses_eh_lsda)
2347 continue;
2349 targetm.asm_out.unwind_label (asm_out_file, fde->decl, for_eh, /* empty */ 0);
2350 targetm.asm_out.internal_label (asm_out_file, FDE_LABEL, for_eh + i * 2);
2351 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l1, FDE_AFTER_SIZE_LABEL, for_eh + i * 2);
2352 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l2, FDE_END_LABEL, for_eh + i * 2);
2353 dw2_asm_output_delta (for_eh ? 4 : DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, l2, l1,
2354 "FDE Length");
2355 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l1);
2357 if (for_eh)
2358 dw2_asm_output_delta (4, l1, section_start_label, "FDE CIE offset");
2359 else
2360 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, section_start_label,
2361 debug_frame_section, "FDE CIE offset");
2363 if (for_eh)
2365 rtx sym_ref = gen_rtx_SYMBOL_REF (Pmode, fde->dw_fde_begin);
2366 SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS (sym_ref) |= SYMBOL_FLAG_LOCAL;
2367 dw2_asm_output_encoded_addr_rtx (fde_encoding,
2368 sym_ref,
2369 false,
2370 "FDE initial location");
2371 if (fde->dw_fde_switched_sections)
2373 rtx sym_ref2 = gen_rtx_SYMBOL_REF (Pmode,
2374 fde->dw_fde_unlikely_section_label);
2375 rtx sym_ref3= gen_rtx_SYMBOL_REF (Pmode,
2376 fde->dw_fde_hot_section_label);
2377 SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS (sym_ref2) |= SYMBOL_FLAG_LOCAL;
2378 SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS (sym_ref3) |= SYMBOL_FLAG_LOCAL;
2379 dw2_asm_output_encoded_addr_rtx (fde_encoding, sym_ref3, false,
2380 "FDE initial location");
2381 dw2_asm_output_delta (size_of_encoded_value (fde_encoding),
2382 fde->dw_fde_hot_section_end_label,
2383 fde->dw_fde_hot_section_label,
2384 "FDE address range");
2385 dw2_asm_output_encoded_addr_rtx (fde_encoding, sym_ref2, false,
2386 "FDE initial location");
2387 dw2_asm_output_delta (size_of_encoded_value (fde_encoding),
2388 fde->dw_fde_unlikely_section_end_label,
2389 fde->dw_fde_unlikely_section_label,
2390 "FDE address range");
2392 else
2393 dw2_asm_output_delta (size_of_encoded_value (fde_encoding),
2394 fde->dw_fde_end, fde->dw_fde_begin,
2395 "FDE address range");
2397 else
2399 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, fde->dw_fde_begin,
2400 "FDE initial location");
2401 if (fde->dw_fde_switched_sections)
2403 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
2404 fde->dw_fde_hot_section_label,
2405 "FDE initial location");
2406 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
2407 fde->dw_fde_hot_section_end_label,
2408 fde->dw_fde_hot_section_label,
2409 "FDE address range");
2410 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
2411 fde->dw_fde_unlikely_section_label,
2412 "FDE initial location");
2413 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
2414 fde->dw_fde_unlikely_section_end_label,
2415 fde->dw_fde_unlikely_section_label,
2416 "FDE address range");
2418 else
2419 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
2420 fde->dw_fde_end, fde->dw_fde_begin,
2421 "FDE address range");
2424 if (augmentation[0])
2426 if (any_lsda_needed)
2428 int size = size_of_encoded_value (lsda_encoding);
2430 if (lsda_encoding == DW_EH_PE_aligned)
2432 int offset = ( 4 /* Length */
2433 + 4 /* CIE offset */
2434 + 2 * size_of_encoded_value (fde_encoding)
2435 + 1 /* Augmentation size */ );
2436 int pad = -offset & (PTR_SIZE - 1);
2438 size += pad;
2439 gcc_assert (size_of_uleb128 (size) == 1);
2442 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (size, "Augmentation size");
2444 if (fde->uses_eh_lsda)
2446 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l1, "LLSDA",
2447 fde->funcdef_number);
2448 dw2_asm_output_encoded_addr_rtx (
2449 lsda_encoding, gen_rtx_SYMBOL_REF (Pmode, l1),
2450 false, "Language Specific Data Area");
2452 else
2454 if (lsda_encoding == DW_EH_PE_aligned)
2455 ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (asm_out_file, floor_log2 (PTR_SIZE));
2456 dw2_asm_output_data
2457 (size_of_encoded_value (lsda_encoding), 0,
2458 "Language Specific Data Area (none)");
2461 else
2462 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (0, "Augmentation size");
2465 /* Loop through the Call Frame Instructions associated with
2466 this FDE. */
2467 fde->dw_fde_current_label = fde->dw_fde_begin;
2468 for (cfi = fde->dw_fde_cfi; cfi != NULL; cfi = cfi->dw_cfi_next)
2469 output_cfi (cfi, fde, for_eh);
2471 /* Pad the FDE out to an address sized boundary. */
2472 ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (asm_out_file,
2473 floor_log2 ((for_eh ? PTR_SIZE : DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)));
2474 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l2);
2477 if (for_eh && targetm.terminate_dw2_eh_frame_info)
2478 dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0, "End of Table");
2479 #ifdef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
2480 /* Work around Irix 6 assembler bug whereby labels at the end of a section
2481 get a value of 0. Putting .align 0 after the label fixes it. */
2482 ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (asm_out_file, 0);
2483 #endif
2485 /* Turn off app to make assembly quicker. */
2486 if (flag_debug_asm)
2487 app_disable ();
2490 /* Output a marker (i.e. a label) for the beginning of a function, before
2491 the prologue. */
2493 void
2494 dwarf2out_begin_prologue (unsigned int line ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
2495 const char *file ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
2497 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
2498 char * dup_label;
2499 dw_fde_ref fde;
2501 current_function_func_begin_label = NULL;
2503 #ifdef TARGET_UNWIND_INFO
2504 /* ??? current_function_func_begin_label is also used by except.c
2505 for call-site information. We must emit this label if it might
2506 be used. */
2507 if ((! flag_exceptions || USING_SJLJ_EXCEPTIONS)
2508 && ! dwarf2out_do_frame ())
2509 return;
2510 #else
2511 if (! dwarf2out_do_frame ())
2512 return;
2513 #endif
2515 switch_to_section (function_section (current_function_decl));
2516 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, FUNC_BEGIN_LABEL,
2517 current_function_funcdef_no);
2518 ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (asm_out_file, FUNC_BEGIN_LABEL,
2519 current_function_funcdef_no);
2520 dup_label = xstrdup (label);
2521 current_function_func_begin_label = dup_label;
2523 #ifdef TARGET_UNWIND_INFO
2524 /* We can elide the fde allocation if we're not emitting debug info. */
2525 if (! dwarf2out_do_frame ())
2526 return;
2527 #endif
2529 /* Expand the fde table if necessary. */
2530 if (fde_table_in_use == fde_table_allocated)
2532 fde_table_allocated += FDE_TABLE_INCREMENT;
2533 fde_table = ggc_realloc (fde_table,
2534 fde_table_allocated * sizeof (dw_fde_node));
2535 memset (fde_table + fde_table_in_use, 0,
2536 FDE_TABLE_INCREMENT * sizeof (dw_fde_node));
2539 /* Record the FDE associated with this function. */
2540 current_funcdef_fde = fde_table_in_use;
2542 /* Add the new FDE at the end of the fde_table. */
2543 fde = &fde_table[fde_table_in_use++];
2544 fde->decl = current_function_decl;
2545 fde->dw_fde_begin = dup_label;
2546 fde->dw_fde_current_label = NULL;
2547 fde->dw_fde_hot_section_label = NULL;
2548 fde->dw_fde_hot_section_end_label = NULL;
2549 fde->dw_fde_unlikely_section_label = NULL;
2550 fde->dw_fde_unlikely_section_end_label = NULL;
2551 fde->dw_fde_switched_sections = false;
2552 fde->dw_fde_end = NULL;
2553 fde->dw_fde_cfi = NULL;
2554 fde->funcdef_number = current_function_funcdef_no;
2555 fde->nothrow = TREE_NOTHROW (current_function_decl);
2556 fde->uses_eh_lsda = cfun->uses_eh_lsda;
2557 fde->all_throwers_are_sibcalls = cfun->all_throwers_are_sibcalls;
2559 args_size = old_args_size = 0;
2561 /* We only want to output line number information for the genuine dwarf2
2562 prologue case, not the eh frame case. */
2563 #ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
2564 if (file)
2565 dwarf2out_source_line (line, file);
2566 #endif
2569 /* Output a marker (i.e. a label) for the absolute end of the generated code
2570 for a function definition. This gets called *after* the epilogue code has
2571 been generated. */
2573 void
2574 dwarf2out_end_epilogue (unsigned int line ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
2575 const char *file ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
2577 dw_fde_ref fde;
2578 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
2580 /* Output a label to mark the endpoint of the code generated for this
2581 function. */
2582 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, FUNC_END_LABEL,
2583 current_function_funcdef_no);
2584 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, label);
2585 fde = &fde_table[fde_table_in_use - 1];
2586 fde->dw_fde_end = xstrdup (label);
2589 void
2590 dwarf2out_frame_init (void)
2592 /* Allocate the initial hunk of the fde_table. */
2593 fde_table = ggc_alloc_cleared (FDE_TABLE_INCREMENT * sizeof (dw_fde_node));
2594 fde_table_allocated = FDE_TABLE_INCREMENT;
2595 fde_table_in_use = 0;
2597 /* Generate the CFA instructions common to all FDE's. Do it now for the
2598 sake of lookup_cfa. */
2600 /* On entry, the Canonical Frame Address is at SP. */
2601 dwarf2out_def_cfa (NULL, STACK_POINTER_REGNUM, INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET);
2603 #ifdef DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO
2604 if (DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO)
2605 initial_return_save (INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX);
2606 #endif
2609 void
2610 dwarf2out_frame_finish (void)
2612 /* Output call frame information. */
2613 if (DWARF2_FRAME_INFO)
2614 output_call_frame_info (0);
2616 #ifndef TARGET_UNWIND_INFO
2617 /* Output another copy for the unwinder. */
2618 if (! USING_SJLJ_EXCEPTIONS && (flag_unwind_tables || flag_exceptions))
2619 output_call_frame_info (1);
2620 #endif
2622 #endif
2624 /* And now, the subset of the debugging information support code necessary
2625 for emitting location expressions. */
2627 /* We need some way to distinguish DW_OP_addr with a direct symbol
2628 relocation from DW_OP_addr with a dtp-relative symbol relocation. */
2629 #define INTERNAL_DW_OP_tls_addr (0x100 + DW_OP_addr)
2632 typedef struct dw_val_struct *dw_val_ref;
2633 typedef struct die_struct *dw_die_ref;
2634 typedef struct dw_loc_descr_struct *dw_loc_descr_ref;
2635 typedef struct dw_loc_list_struct *dw_loc_list_ref;
2637 /* Each DIE may have a series of attribute/value pairs. Values
2638 can take on several forms. The forms that are used in this
2639 implementation are listed below. */
2641 enum dw_val_class
2643 dw_val_class_addr,
2644 dw_val_class_offset,
2645 dw_val_class_loc,
2646 dw_val_class_loc_list,
2647 dw_val_class_range_list,
2648 dw_val_class_const,
2649 dw_val_class_unsigned_const,
2650 dw_val_class_long_long,
2651 dw_val_class_vec,
2652 dw_val_class_flag,
2653 dw_val_class_die_ref,
2654 dw_val_class_fde_ref,
2655 dw_val_class_lbl_id,
2656 dw_val_class_lineptr,
2657 dw_val_class_str,
2658 dw_val_class_macptr
2661 /* Describe a double word constant value. */
2662 /* ??? Every instance of long_long in the code really means CONST_DOUBLE. */
2664 typedef struct dw_long_long_struct GTY(())
2666 unsigned long hi;
2667 unsigned long low;
2669 dw_long_long_const;
2671 /* Describe a floating point constant value, or a vector constant value. */
2673 typedef struct dw_vec_struct GTY(())
2675 unsigned char * GTY((length ("%h.length"))) array;
2676 unsigned length;
2677 unsigned elt_size;
2679 dw_vec_const;
2681 /* The dw_val_node describes an attribute's value, as it is
2682 represented internally. */
2684 typedef struct dw_val_struct GTY(())
2686 enum dw_val_class val_class;
2687 union dw_val_struct_union
2689 rtx GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_addr"))) val_addr;
2690 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_offset"))) val_offset;
2691 dw_loc_list_ref GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_loc_list"))) val_loc_list;
2692 dw_loc_descr_ref GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_loc"))) val_loc;
2693 HOST_WIDE_INT GTY ((default)) val_int;
2694 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_unsigned_const"))) val_unsigned;
2695 dw_long_long_const GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_long_long"))) val_long_long;
2696 dw_vec_const GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_vec"))) val_vec;
2697 struct dw_val_die_union
2699 dw_die_ref die;
2700 int external;
2701 } GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_die_ref"))) val_die_ref;
2702 unsigned GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_fde_ref"))) val_fde_index;
2703 struct indirect_string_node * GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_str"))) val_str;
2704 char * GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_lbl_id"))) val_lbl_id;
2705 unsigned char GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_flag"))) val_flag;
2707 GTY ((desc ("%1.val_class"))) v;
2709 dw_val_node;
2711 /* Locations in memory are described using a sequence of stack machine
2712 operations. */
2714 typedef struct dw_loc_descr_struct GTY(())
2716 dw_loc_descr_ref dw_loc_next;
2717 enum dwarf_location_atom dw_loc_opc;
2718 dw_val_node dw_loc_oprnd1;
2719 dw_val_node dw_loc_oprnd2;
2720 int dw_loc_addr;
2722 dw_loc_descr_node;
2724 /* Location lists are ranges + location descriptions for that range,
2725 so you can track variables that are in different places over
2726 their entire life. */
2727 typedef struct dw_loc_list_struct GTY(())
2729 dw_loc_list_ref dw_loc_next;
2730 const char *begin; /* Label for begin address of range */
2731 const char *end; /* Label for end address of range */
2732 char *ll_symbol; /* Label for beginning of location list.
2733 Only on head of list */
2734 const char *section; /* Section this loclist is relative to */
2735 dw_loc_descr_ref expr;
2736 } dw_loc_list_node;
2738 #if defined (DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO) || defined (DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO)
2740 static const char *dwarf_stack_op_name (unsigned);
2741 static dw_loc_descr_ref new_loc_descr (enum dwarf_location_atom,
2742 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT);
2743 static void add_loc_descr (dw_loc_descr_ref *, dw_loc_descr_ref);
2744 static unsigned long size_of_loc_descr (dw_loc_descr_ref);
2745 static unsigned long size_of_locs (dw_loc_descr_ref);
2746 static void output_loc_operands (dw_loc_descr_ref);
2747 static void output_loc_sequence (dw_loc_descr_ref);
2749 /* Convert a DWARF stack opcode into its string name. */
2751 static const char *
2752 dwarf_stack_op_name (unsigned int op)
2754 switch (op)
2756 case DW_OP_addr:
2757 case INTERNAL_DW_OP_tls_addr:
2758 return "DW_OP_addr";
2759 case DW_OP_deref:
2760 return "DW_OP_deref";
2761 case DW_OP_const1u:
2762 return "DW_OP_const1u";
2763 case DW_OP_const1s:
2764 return "DW_OP_const1s";
2765 case DW_OP_const2u:
2766 return "DW_OP_const2u";
2767 case DW_OP_const2s:
2768 return "DW_OP_const2s";
2769 case DW_OP_const4u:
2770 return "DW_OP_const4u";
2771 case DW_OP_const4s:
2772 return "DW_OP_const4s";
2773 case DW_OP_const8u:
2774 return "DW_OP_const8u";
2775 case DW_OP_const8s:
2776 return "DW_OP_const8s";
2777 case DW_OP_constu:
2778 return "DW_OP_constu";
2779 case DW_OP_consts:
2780 return "DW_OP_consts";
2781 case DW_OP_dup:
2782 return "DW_OP_dup";
2783 case DW_OP_drop:
2784 return "DW_OP_drop";
2785 case DW_OP_over:
2786 return "DW_OP_over";
2787 case DW_OP_pick:
2788 return "DW_OP_pick";
2789 case DW_OP_swap:
2790 return "DW_OP_swap";
2791 case DW_OP_rot:
2792 return "DW_OP_rot";
2793 case DW_OP_xderef:
2794 return "DW_OP_xderef";
2795 case DW_OP_abs:
2796 return "DW_OP_abs";
2797 case DW_OP_and:
2798 return "DW_OP_and";
2799 case DW_OP_div:
2800 return "DW_OP_div";
2801 case DW_OP_minus:
2802 return "DW_OP_minus";
2803 case DW_OP_mod:
2804 return "DW_OP_mod";
2805 case DW_OP_mul:
2806 return "DW_OP_mul";
2807 case DW_OP_neg:
2808 return "DW_OP_neg";
2809 case DW_OP_not:
2810 return "DW_OP_not";
2811 case DW_OP_or:
2812 return "DW_OP_or";
2813 case DW_OP_plus:
2814 return "DW_OP_plus";
2815 case DW_OP_plus_uconst:
2816 return "DW_OP_plus_uconst";
2817 case DW_OP_shl:
2818 return "DW_OP_shl";
2819 case DW_OP_shr:
2820 return "DW_OP_shr";
2821 case DW_OP_shra:
2822 return "DW_OP_shra";
2823 case DW_OP_xor:
2824 return "DW_OP_xor";
2825 case DW_OP_bra:
2826 return "DW_OP_bra";
2827 case DW_OP_eq:
2828 return "DW_OP_eq";
2829 case DW_OP_ge:
2830 return "DW_OP_ge";
2831 case DW_OP_gt:
2832 return "DW_OP_gt";
2833 case DW_OP_le:
2834 return "DW_OP_le";
2835 case DW_OP_lt:
2836 return "DW_OP_lt";
2837 case DW_OP_ne:
2838 return "DW_OP_ne";
2839 case DW_OP_skip:
2840 return "DW_OP_skip";
2841 case DW_OP_lit0:
2842 return "DW_OP_lit0";
2843 case DW_OP_lit1:
2844 return "DW_OP_lit1";
2845 case DW_OP_lit2:
2846 return "DW_OP_lit2";
2847 case DW_OP_lit3:
2848 return "DW_OP_lit3";
2849 case DW_OP_lit4:
2850 return "DW_OP_lit4";
2851 case DW_OP_lit5:
2852 return "DW_OP_lit5";
2853 case DW_OP_lit6:
2854 return "DW_OP_lit6";
2855 case DW_OP_lit7:
2856 return "DW_OP_lit7";
2857 case DW_OP_lit8:
2858 return "DW_OP_lit8";
2859 case DW_OP_lit9:
2860 return "DW_OP_lit9";
2861 case DW_OP_lit10:
2862 return "DW_OP_lit10";
2863 case DW_OP_lit11:
2864 return "DW_OP_lit11";
2865 case DW_OP_lit12:
2866 return "DW_OP_lit12";
2867 case DW_OP_lit13:
2868 return "DW_OP_lit13";
2869 case DW_OP_lit14:
2870 return "DW_OP_lit14";
2871 case DW_OP_lit15:
2872 return "DW_OP_lit15";
2873 case DW_OP_lit16:
2874 return "DW_OP_lit16";
2875 case DW_OP_lit17:
2876 return "DW_OP_lit17";
2877 case DW_OP_lit18:
2878 return "DW_OP_lit18";
2879 case DW_OP_lit19:
2880 return "DW_OP_lit19";
2881 case DW_OP_lit20:
2882 return "DW_OP_lit20";
2883 case DW_OP_lit21:
2884 return "DW_OP_lit21";
2885 case DW_OP_lit22:
2886 return "DW_OP_lit22";
2887 case DW_OP_lit23:
2888 return "DW_OP_lit23";
2889 case DW_OP_lit24:
2890 return "DW_OP_lit24";
2891 case DW_OP_lit25:
2892 return "DW_OP_lit25";
2893 case DW_OP_lit26:
2894 return "DW_OP_lit26";
2895 case DW_OP_lit27:
2896 return "DW_OP_lit27";
2897 case DW_OP_lit28:
2898 return "DW_OP_lit28";
2899 case DW_OP_lit29:
2900 return "DW_OP_lit29";
2901 case DW_OP_lit30:
2902 return "DW_OP_lit30";
2903 case DW_OP_lit31:
2904 return "DW_OP_lit31";
2905 case DW_OP_reg0:
2906 return "DW_OP_reg0";
2907 case DW_OP_reg1:
2908 return "DW_OP_reg1";
2909 case DW_OP_reg2:
2910 return "DW_OP_reg2";
2911 case DW_OP_reg3:
2912 return "DW_OP_reg3";
2913 case DW_OP_reg4:
2914 return "DW_OP_reg4";
2915 case DW_OP_reg5:
2916 return "DW_OP_reg5";
2917 case DW_OP_reg6:
2918 return "DW_OP_reg6";
2919 case DW_OP_reg7:
2920 return "DW_OP_reg7";
2921 case DW_OP_reg8:
2922 return "DW_OP_reg8";
2923 case DW_OP_reg9:
2924 return "DW_OP_reg9";
2925 case DW_OP_reg10:
2926 return "DW_OP_reg10";
2927 case DW_OP_reg11:
2928 return "DW_OP_reg11";
2929 case DW_OP_reg12:
2930 return "DW_OP_reg12";
2931 case DW_OP_reg13:
2932 return "DW_OP_reg13";
2933 case DW_OP_reg14:
2934 return "DW_OP_reg14";
2935 case DW_OP_reg15:
2936 return "DW_OP_reg15";
2937 case DW_OP_reg16:
2938 return "DW_OP_reg16";
2939 case DW_OP_reg17:
2940 return "DW_OP_reg17";
2941 case DW_OP_reg18:
2942 return "DW_OP_reg18";
2943 case DW_OP_reg19:
2944 return "DW_OP_reg19";
2945 case DW_OP_reg20:
2946 return "DW_OP_reg20";
2947 case DW_OP_reg21:
2948 return "DW_OP_reg21";
2949 case DW_OP_reg22:
2950 return "DW_OP_reg22";
2951 case DW_OP_reg23:
2952 return "DW_OP_reg23";
2953 case DW_OP_reg24:
2954 return "DW_OP_reg24";
2955 case DW_OP_reg25:
2956 return "DW_OP_reg25";
2957 case DW_OP_reg26:
2958 return "DW_OP_reg26";
2959 case DW_OP_reg27:
2960 return "DW_OP_reg27";
2961 case DW_OP_reg28:
2962 return "DW_OP_reg28";
2963 case DW_OP_reg29:
2964 return "DW_OP_reg29";
2965 case DW_OP_reg30:
2966 return "DW_OP_reg30";
2967 case DW_OP_reg31:
2968 return "DW_OP_reg31";
2969 case DW_OP_breg0:
2970 return "DW_OP_breg0";
2971 case DW_OP_breg1:
2972 return "DW_OP_breg1";
2973 case DW_OP_breg2:
2974 return "DW_OP_breg2";
2975 case DW_OP_breg3:
2976 return "DW_OP_breg3";
2977 case DW_OP_breg4:
2978 return "DW_OP_breg4";
2979 case DW_OP_breg5:
2980 return "DW_OP_breg5";
2981 case DW_OP_breg6:
2982 return "DW_OP_breg6";
2983 case DW_OP_breg7:
2984 return "DW_OP_breg7";
2985 case DW_OP_breg8:
2986 return "DW_OP_breg8";
2987 case DW_OP_breg9:
2988 return "DW_OP_breg9";
2989 case DW_OP_breg10:
2990 return "DW_OP_breg10";
2991 case DW_OP_breg11:
2992 return "DW_OP_breg11";
2993 case DW_OP_breg12:
2994 return "DW_OP_breg12";
2995 case DW_OP_breg13:
2996 return "DW_OP_breg13";
2997 case DW_OP_breg14:
2998 return "DW_OP_breg14";
2999 case DW_OP_breg15:
3000 return "DW_OP_breg15";
3001 case DW_OP_breg16:
3002 return "DW_OP_breg16";
3003 case DW_OP_breg17:
3004 return "DW_OP_breg17";
3005 case DW_OP_breg18:
3006 return "DW_OP_breg18";
3007 case DW_OP_breg19:
3008 return "DW_OP_breg19";
3009 case DW_OP_breg20:
3010 return "DW_OP_breg20";
3011 case DW_OP_breg21:
3012 return "DW_OP_breg21";
3013 case DW_OP_breg22:
3014 return "DW_OP_breg22";
3015 case DW_OP_breg23:
3016 return "DW_OP_breg23";
3017 case DW_OP_breg24:
3018 return "DW_OP_breg24";
3019 case DW_OP_breg25:
3020 return "DW_OP_breg25";
3021 case DW_OP_breg26:
3022 return "DW_OP_breg26";
3023 case DW_OP_breg27:
3024 return "DW_OP_breg27";
3025 case DW_OP_breg28:
3026 return "DW_OP_breg28";
3027 case DW_OP_breg29:
3028 return "DW_OP_breg29";
3029 case DW_OP_breg30:
3030 return "DW_OP_breg30";
3031 case DW_OP_breg31:
3032 return "DW_OP_breg31";
3033 case DW_OP_regx:
3034 return "DW_OP_regx";
3035 case DW_OP_fbreg:
3036 return "DW_OP_fbreg";
3037 case DW_OP_bregx:
3038 return "DW_OP_bregx";
3039 case DW_OP_piece:
3040 return "DW_OP_piece";
3041 case DW_OP_deref_size:
3042 return "DW_OP_deref_size";
3043 case DW_OP_xderef_size:
3044 return "DW_OP_xderef_size";
3045 case DW_OP_nop:
3046 return "DW_OP_nop";
3047 case DW_OP_push_object_address:
3048 return "DW_OP_push_object_address";
3049 case DW_OP_call2:
3050 return "DW_OP_call2";
3051 case DW_OP_call4:
3052 return "DW_OP_call4";
3053 case DW_OP_call_ref:
3054 return "DW_OP_call_ref";
3055 case DW_OP_GNU_push_tls_address:
3056 return "DW_OP_GNU_push_tls_address";
3057 default:
3058 return "OP_<unknown>";
3062 /* Return a pointer to a newly allocated location description. Location
3063 descriptions are simple expression terms that can be strung
3064 together to form more complicated location (address) descriptions. */
3066 static inline dw_loc_descr_ref
3067 new_loc_descr (enum dwarf_location_atom op, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT oprnd1,
3068 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT oprnd2)
3070 dw_loc_descr_ref descr = ggc_alloc_cleared (sizeof (dw_loc_descr_node));
3072 descr->dw_loc_opc = op;
3073 descr->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_unsigned_const;
3074 descr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned = oprnd1;
3075 descr->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class = dw_val_class_unsigned_const;
3076 descr->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_unsigned = oprnd2;
3078 return descr;
3081 /* Add a location description term to a location description expression. */
3083 static inline void
3084 add_loc_descr (dw_loc_descr_ref *list_head, dw_loc_descr_ref descr)
3086 dw_loc_descr_ref *d;
3088 /* Find the end of the chain. */
3089 for (d = list_head; (*d) != NULL; d = &(*d)->dw_loc_next)
3092 *d = descr;
3095 /* Return the size of a location descriptor. */
3097 static unsigned long
3098 size_of_loc_descr (dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
3100 unsigned long size = 1;
3102 switch (loc->dw_loc_opc)
3104 case DW_OP_addr:
3105 case INTERNAL_DW_OP_tls_addr:
3106 size += DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
3107 break;
3108 case DW_OP_const1u:
3109 case DW_OP_const1s:
3110 size += 1;
3111 break;
3112 case DW_OP_const2u:
3113 case DW_OP_const2s:
3114 size += 2;
3115 break;
3116 case DW_OP_const4u:
3117 case DW_OP_const4s:
3118 size += 4;
3119 break;
3120 case DW_OP_const8u:
3121 case DW_OP_const8s:
3122 size += 8;
3123 break;
3124 case DW_OP_constu:
3125 size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
3126 break;
3127 case DW_OP_consts:
3128 size += size_of_sleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int);
3129 break;
3130 case DW_OP_pick:
3131 size += 1;
3132 break;
3133 case DW_OP_plus_uconst:
3134 size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
3135 break;
3136 case DW_OP_skip:
3137 case DW_OP_bra:
3138 size += 2;
3139 break;
3140 case DW_OP_breg0:
3141 case DW_OP_breg1:
3142 case DW_OP_breg2:
3143 case DW_OP_breg3:
3144 case DW_OP_breg4:
3145 case DW_OP_breg5:
3146 case DW_OP_breg6:
3147 case DW_OP_breg7:
3148 case DW_OP_breg8:
3149 case DW_OP_breg9:
3150 case DW_OP_breg10:
3151 case DW_OP_breg11:
3152 case DW_OP_breg12:
3153 case DW_OP_breg13:
3154 case DW_OP_breg14:
3155 case DW_OP_breg15:
3156 case DW_OP_breg16:
3157 case DW_OP_breg17:
3158 case DW_OP_breg18:
3159 case DW_OP_breg19:
3160 case DW_OP_breg20:
3161 case DW_OP_breg21:
3162 case DW_OP_breg22:
3163 case DW_OP_breg23:
3164 case DW_OP_breg24:
3165 case DW_OP_breg25:
3166 case DW_OP_breg26:
3167 case DW_OP_breg27:
3168 case DW_OP_breg28:
3169 case DW_OP_breg29:
3170 case DW_OP_breg30:
3171 case DW_OP_breg31:
3172 size += size_of_sleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int);
3173 break;
3174 case DW_OP_regx:
3175 size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
3176 break;
3177 case DW_OP_fbreg:
3178 size += size_of_sleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int);
3179 break;
3180 case DW_OP_bregx:
3181 size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
3182 size += size_of_sleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_int);
3183 break;
3184 case DW_OP_piece:
3185 size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
3186 break;
3187 case DW_OP_deref_size:
3188 case DW_OP_xderef_size:
3189 size += 1;
3190 break;
3191 case DW_OP_call2:
3192 size += 2;
3193 break;
3194 case DW_OP_call4:
3195 size += 4;
3196 break;
3197 case DW_OP_call_ref:
3198 size += DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
3199 break;
3200 default:
3201 break;
3204 return size;
3207 /* Return the size of a series of location descriptors. */
3209 static unsigned long
3210 size_of_locs (dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
3212 unsigned long size;
3214 for (size = 0; loc != NULL; loc = loc->dw_loc_next)
3216 loc->dw_loc_addr = size;
3217 size += size_of_loc_descr (loc);
3220 return size;
3223 /* Output location description stack opcode's operands (if any). */
3225 static void
3226 output_loc_operands (dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
3228 dw_val_ref val1 = &loc->dw_loc_oprnd1;
3229 dw_val_ref val2 = &loc->dw_loc_oprnd2;
3231 switch (loc->dw_loc_opc)
3233 #ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
3234 case DW_OP_addr:
3235 dw2_asm_output_addr_rtx (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, val1->v.val_addr, NULL);
3236 break;
3237 case DW_OP_const2u:
3238 case DW_OP_const2s:
3239 dw2_asm_output_data (2, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
3240 break;
3241 case DW_OP_const4u:
3242 case DW_OP_const4s:
3243 dw2_asm_output_data (4, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
3244 break;
3245 case DW_OP_const8u:
3246 case DW_OP_const8s:
3247 gcc_assert (HOST_BITS_PER_LONG >= 64);
3248 dw2_asm_output_data (8, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
3249 break;
3250 case DW_OP_skip:
3251 case DW_OP_bra:
3253 int offset;
3255 gcc_assert (val1->val_class == dw_val_class_loc);
3256 offset = val1->v.val_loc->dw_loc_addr - (loc->dw_loc_addr + 3);
3258 dw2_asm_output_data (2, offset, NULL);
3260 break;
3261 #else
3262 case DW_OP_addr:
3263 case DW_OP_const2u:
3264 case DW_OP_const2s:
3265 case DW_OP_const4u:
3266 case DW_OP_const4s:
3267 case DW_OP_const8u:
3268 case DW_OP_const8s:
3269 case DW_OP_skip:
3270 case DW_OP_bra:
3271 /* We currently don't make any attempt to make sure these are
3272 aligned properly like we do for the main unwind info, so
3273 don't support emitting things larger than a byte if we're
3274 only doing unwinding. */
3275 gcc_unreachable ();
3276 #endif
3277 case DW_OP_const1u:
3278 case DW_OP_const1s:
3279 dw2_asm_output_data (1, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
3280 break;
3281 case DW_OP_constu:
3282 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned, NULL);
3283 break;
3284 case DW_OP_consts:
3285 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (val1->v.val_int, NULL);
3286 break;
3287 case DW_OP_pick:
3288 dw2_asm_output_data (1, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
3289 break;
3290 case DW_OP_plus_uconst:
3291 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned, NULL);
3292 break;
3293 case DW_OP_breg0:
3294 case DW_OP_breg1:
3295 case DW_OP_breg2:
3296 case DW_OP_breg3:
3297 case DW_OP_breg4:
3298 case DW_OP_breg5:
3299 case DW_OP_breg6:
3300 case DW_OP_breg7:
3301 case DW_OP_breg8:
3302 case DW_OP_breg9:
3303 case DW_OP_breg10:
3304 case DW_OP_breg11:
3305 case DW_OP_breg12:
3306 case DW_OP_breg13:
3307 case DW_OP_breg14:
3308 case DW_OP_breg15:
3309 case DW_OP_breg16:
3310 case DW_OP_breg17:
3311 case DW_OP_breg18:
3312 case DW_OP_breg19:
3313 case DW_OP_breg20:
3314 case DW_OP_breg21:
3315 case DW_OP_breg22:
3316 case DW_OP_breg23:
3317 case DW_OP_breg24:
3318 case DW_OP_breg25:
3319 case DW_OP_breg26:
3320 case DW_OP_breg27:
3321 case DW_OP_breg28:
3322 case DW_OP_breg29:
3323 case DW_OP_breg30:
3324 case DW_OP_breg31:
3325 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (val1->v.val_int, NULL);
3326 break;
3327 case DW_OP_regx:
3328 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned, NULL);
3329 break;
3330 case DW_OP_fbreg:
3331 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (val1->v.val_int, NULL);
3332 break;
3333 case DW_OP_bregx:
3334 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned, NULL);
3335 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (val2->v.val_int, NULL);
3336 break;
3337 case DW_OP_piece:
3338 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned, NULL);
3339 break;
3340 case DW_OP_deref_size:
3341 case DW_OP_xderef_size:
3342 dw2_asm_output_data (1, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
3343 break;
3345 case INTERNAL_DW_OP_tls_addr:
3346 if (targetm.asm_out.output_dwarf_dtprel)
3348 targetm.asm_out.output_dwarf_dtprel (asm_out_file,
3349 DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
3350 val1->v.val_addr);
3351 fputc ('\n', asm_out_file);
3353 else
3354 gcc_unreachable ();
3355 break;
3357 default:
3358 /* Other codes have no operands. */
3359 break;
3363 /* Output a sequence of location operations. */
3365 static void
3366 output_loc_sequence (dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
3368 for (; loc != NULL; loc = loc->dw_loc_next)
3370 /* Output the opcode. */
3371 dw2_asm_output_data (1, loc->dw_loc_opc,
3372 "%s", dwarf_stack_op_name (loc->dw_loc_opc));
3374 /* Output the operand(s) (if any). */
3375 output_loc_operands (loc);
3379 /* This routine will generate the correct assembly data for a location
3380 description based on a cfi entry with a complex address. */
3382 static void
3383 output_cfa_loc (dw_cfi_ref cfi)
3385 dw_loc_descr_ref loc;
3386 unsigned long size;
3388 /* Output the size of the block. */
3389 loc = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_loc;
3390 size = size_of_locs (loc);
3391 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (size, NULL);
3393 /* Now output the operations themselves. */
3394 output_loc_sequence (loc);
3397 /* This function builds a dwarf location descriptor sequence from a
3398 dw_cfa_location, adding the given OFFSET to the result of the
3399 expression. */
3401 static struct dw_loc_descr_struct *
3402 build_cfa_loc (dw_cfa_location *cfa, HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
3404 struct dw_loc_descr_struct *head, *tmp;
3406 offset += cfa->offset;
3408 if (cfa->indirect)
3410 if (cfa->base_offset)
3412 if (cfa->reg <= 31)
3413 head = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_breg0 + cfa->reg, cfa->base_offset, 0);
3414 else
3415 head = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bregx, cfa->reg, cfa->base_offset);
3417 else if (cfa->reg <= 31)
3418 head = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_reg0 + cfa->reg, 0, 0);
3419 else
3420 head = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_regx, cfa->reg, 0);
3422 head->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_const;
3423 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_deref, 0, 0);
3424 add_loc_descr (&head, tmp);
3425 if (offset != 0)
3427 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst, offset, 0);
3428 add_loc_descr (&head, tmp);
3431 else
3433 if (offset == 0)
3434 if (cfa->reg <= 31)
3435 head = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_reg0 + cfa->reg, 0, 0);
3436 else
3437 head = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_regx, cfa->reg, 0);
3438 else if (cfa->reg <= 31)
3439 head = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_breg0 + cfa->reg, offset, 0);
3440 else
3441 head = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bregx, cfa->reg, offset);
3444 return head;
3447 /* This function fills in aa dw_cfa_location structure from a dwarf location
3448 descriptor sequence. */
3450 static void
3451 get_cfa_from_loc_descr (dw_cfa_location *cfa, struct dw_loc_descr_struct *loc)
3453 struct dw_loc_descr_struct *ptr;
3454 cfa->offset = 0;
3455 cfa->base_offset = 0;
3456 cfa->indirect = 0;
3457 cfa->reg = -1;
3459 for (ptr = loc; ptr != NULL; ptr = ptr->dw_loc_next)
3461 enum dwarf_location_atom op = ptr->dw_loc_opc;
3463 switch (op)
3465 case DW_OP_reg0:
3466 case DW_OP_reg1:
3467 case DW_OP_reg2:
3468 case DW_OP_reg3:
3469 case DW_OP_reg4:
3470 case DW_OP_reg5:
3471 case DW_OP_reg6:
3472 case DW_OP_reg7:
3473 case DW_OP_reg8:
3474 case DW_OP_reg9:
3475 case DW_OP_reg10:
3476 case DW_OP_reg11:
3477 case DW_OP_reg12:
3478 case DW_OP_reg13:
3479 case DW_OP_reg14:
3480 case DW_OP_reg15:
3481 case DW_OP_reg16:
3482 case DW_OP_reg17:
3483 case DW_OP_reg18:
3484 case DW_OP_reg19:
3485 case DW_OP_reg20:
3486 case DW_OP_reg21:
3487 case DW_OP_reg22:
3488 case DW_OP_reg23:
3489 case DW_OP_reg24:
3490 case DW_OP_reg25:
3491 case DW_OP_reg26:
3492 case DW_OP_reg27:
3493 case DW_OP_reg28:
3494 case DW_OP_reg29:
3495 case DW_OP_reg30:
3496 case DW_OP_reg31:
3497 cfa->reg = op - DW_OP_reg0;
3498 break;
3499 case DW_OP_regx:
3500 cfa->reg = ptr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int;
3501 break;
3502 case DW_OP_breg0:
3503 case DW_OP_breg1:
3504 case DW_OP_breg2:
3505 case DW_OP_breg3:
3506 case DW_OP_breg4:
3507 case DW_OP_breg5:
3508 case DW_OP_breg6:
3509 case DW_OP_breg7:
3510 case DW_OP_breg8:
3511 case DW_OP_breg9:
3512 case DW_OP_breg10:
3513 case DW_OP_breg11:
3514 case DW_OP_breg12:
3515 case DW_OP_breg13:
3516 case DW_OP_breg14:
3517 case DW_OP_breg15:
3518 case DW_OP_breg16:
3519 case DW_OP_breg17:
3520 case DW_OP_breg18:
3521 case DW_OP_breg19:
3522 case DW_OP_breg20:
3523 case DW_OP_breg21:
3524 case DW_OP_breg22:
3525 case DW_OP_breg23:
3526 case DW_OP_breg24:
3527 case DW_OP_breg25:
3528 case DW_OP_breg26:
3529 case DW_OP_breg27:
3530 case DW_OP_breg28:
3531 case DW_OP_breg29:
3532 case DW_OP_breg30:
3533 case DW_OP_breg31:
3534 cfa->reg = op - DW_OP_breg0;
3535 cfa->base_offset = ptr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int;
3536 break;
3537 case DW_OP_bregx:
3538 cfa->reg = ptr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int;
3539 cfa->base_offset = ptr->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_int;
3540 break;
3541 case DW_OP_deref:
3542 cfa->indirect = 1;
3543 break;
3544 case DW_OP_plus_uconst:
3545 cfa->offset = ptr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned;
3546 break;
3547 default:
3548 internal_error ("DW_LOC_OP %s not implemented",
3549 dwarf_stack_op_name (ptr->dw_loc_opc));
3553 #endif /* .debug_frame support */
3555 /* And now, the support for symbolic debugging information. */
3556 #ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
3558 /* .debug_str support. */
3559 static int output_indirect_string (void **, void *);
3561 static void dwarf2out_init (const char *);
3562 static void dwarf2out_finish (const char *);
3563 static void dwarf2out_define (unsigned int, const char *);
3564 static void dwarf2out_undef (unsigned int, const char *);
3565 static void dwarf2out_start_source_file (unsigned, const char *);
3566 static void dwarf2out_end_source_file (unsigned);
3567 static void dwarf2out_begin_block (unsigned, unsigned);
3568 static void dwarf2out_end_block (unsigned, unsigned);
3569 static bool dwarf2out_ignore_block (tree);
3570 static void dwarf2out_global_decl (tree);
3571 static void dwarf2out_type_decl (tree, int);
3572 static void dwarf2out_imported_module_or_decl (tree, tree);
3573 static void dwarf2out_abstract_function (tree);
3574 static void dwarf2out_var_location (rtx);
3575 static void dwarf2out_begin_function (tree);
3576 static void dwarf2out_switch_text_section (void);
3578 /* The debug hooks structure. */
3580 const struct gcc_debug_hooks dwarf2_debug_hooks =
3582 dwarf2out_init,
3583 dwarf2out_finish,
3584 dwarf2out_define,
3585 dwarf2out_undef,
3586 dwarf2out_start_source_file,
3587 dwarf2out_end_source_file,
3588 dwarf2out_begin_block,
3589 dwarf2out_end_block,
3590 dwarf2out_ignore_block,
3591 dwarf2out_source_line,
3592 dwarf2out_begin_prologue,
3593 debug_nothing_int_charstar, /* end_prologue */
3594 dwarf2out_end_epilogue,
3595 dwarf2out_begin_function,
3596 debug_nothing_int, /* end_function */
3597 dwarf2out_decl, /* function_decl */
3598 dwarf2out_global_decl,
3599 dwarf2out_type_decl, /* type_decl */
3600 dwarf2out_imported_module_or_decl,
3601 debug_nothing_tree, /* deferred_inline_function */
3602 /* The DWARF 2 backend tries to reduce debugging bloat by not
3603 emitting the abstract description of inline functions until
3604 something tries to reference them. */
3605 dwarf2out_abstract_function, /* outlining_inline_function */
3606 debug_nothing_rtx, /* label */
3607 debug_nothing_int, /* handle_pch */
3608 dwarf2out_var_location,
3609 dwarf2out_switch_text_section,
3610 1 /* start_end_main_source_file */
3612 #endif
3614 /* NOTE: In the comments in this file, many references are made to
3615 "Debugging Information Entries". This term is abbreviated as `DIE'
3616 throughout the remainder of this file. */
3618 /* An internal representation of the DWARF output is built, and then
3619 walked to generate the DWARF debugging info. The walk of the internal
3620 representation is done after the entire program has been compiled.
3621 The types below are used to describe the internal representation. */
3623 /* Various DIE's use offsets relative to the beginning of the
3624 .debug_info section to refer to each other. */
3626 typedef long int dw_offset;
3628 /* Define typedefs here to avoid circular dependencies. */
3630 typedef struct dw_attr_struct *dw_attr_ref;
3631 typedef struct dw_line_info_struct *dw_line_info_ref;
3632 typedef struct dw_separate_line_info_struct *dw_separate_line_info_ref;
3633 typedef struct pubname_struct *pubname_ref;
3634 typedef struct dw_ranges_struct *dw_ranges_ref;
3636 /* Each entry in the line_info_table maintains the file and
3637 line number associated with the label generated for that
3638 entry. The label gives the PC value associated with
3639 the line number entry. */
3641 typedef struct dw_line_info_struct GTY(())
3643 unsigned long dw_file_num;
3644 unsigned long dw_line_num;
3646 dw_line_info_entry;
3648 /* Line information for functions in separate sections; each one gets its
3649 own sequence. */
3650 typedef struct dw_separate_line_info_struct GTY(())
3652 unsigned long dw_file_num;
3653 unsigned long dw_line_num;
3654 unsigned long function;
3656 dw_separate_line_info_entry;
3658 /* Each DIE attribute has a field specifying the attribute kind,
3659 a link to the next attribute in the chain, and an attribute value.
3660 Attributes are typically linked below the DIE they modify. */
3662 typedef struct dw_attr_struct GTY(())
3664 enum dwarf_attribute dw_attr;
3665 dw_attr_ref dw_attr_next;
3666 dw_val_node dw_attr_val;
3668 dw_attr_node;
3670 /* The Debugging Information Entry (DIE) structure */
3672 typedef struct die_struct GTY(())
3674 enum dwarf_tag die_tag;
3675 char *die_symbol;
3676 dw_attr_ref die_attr;
3677 dw_die_ref die_parent;
3678 dw_die_ref die_child;
3679 dw_die_ref die_sib;
3680 dw_die_ref die_definition; /* ref from a specification to its definition */
3681 dw_offset die_offset;
3682 unsigned long die_abbrev;
3683 int die_mark;
3684 unsigned int decl_id;
3686 die_node;
3688 /* The pubname structure */
3690 typedef struct pubname_struct GTY(())
3692 dw_die_ref die;
3693 char *name;
3695 pubname_entry;
3697 struct dw_ranges_struct GTY(())
3699 int block_num;
3702 /* The limbo die list structure. */
3703 typedef struct limbo_die_struct GTY(())
3705 dw_die_ref die;
3706 tree created_for;
3707 struct limbo_die_struct *next;
3709 limbo_die_node;
3711 /* How to start an assembler comment. */
3712 #ifndef ASM_COMMENT_START
3713 #define ASM_COMMENT_START ";#"
3714 #endif
3716 /* Define a macro which returns nonzero for a TYPE_DECL which was
3717 implicitly generated for a tagged type.
3719 Note that unlike the gcc front end (which generates a NULL named
3720 TYPE_DECL node for each complete tagged type, each array type, and
3721 each function type node created) the g++ front end generates a
3722 _named_ TYPE_DECL node for each tagged type node created.
3723 These TYPE_DECLs have DECL_ARTIFICIAL set, so we know not to
3724 generate a DW_TAG_typedef DIE for them. */
3726 #define TYPE_DECL_IS_STUB(decl) \
3727 (DECL_NAME (decl) == NULL_TREE \
3728 || (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl) \
3729 && is_tagged_type (TREE_TYPE (decl)) \
3730 && ((decl == TYPE_STUB_DECL (TREE_TYPE (decl))) \
3731 /* This is necessary for stub decls that \
3732 appear in nested inline functions. */ \
3733 || (DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl) != NULL_TREE \
3734 && (decl_ultimate_origin (decl) \
3735 == TYPE_STUB_DECL (TREE_TYPE (decl)))))))
3737 /* Information concerning the compilation unit's programming
3738 language, and compiler version. */
3740 /* Fixed size portion of the DWARF compilation unit header. */
3741 #define DWARF_COMPILE_UNIT_HEADER_SIZE \
3742 (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE + DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + 3)
3744 /* Fixed size portion of public names info. */
3745 #define DWARF_PUBNAMES_HEADER_SIZE (2 * DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + 2)
3747 /* Fixed size portion of the address range info. */
3748 #define DWARF_ARANGES_HEADER_SIZE \
3749 (DWARF_ROUND (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE + DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + 4, \
3750 DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE * 2) \
3751 - DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE)
3753 /* Size of padding portion in the address range info. It must be
3754 aligned to twice the pointer size. */
3755 #define DWARF_ARANGES_PAD_SIZE \
3756 (DWARF_ROUND (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE + DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + 4, \
3757 DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE * 2) \
3758 - (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE + DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + 4))
3760 /* Use assembler line directives if available. */
3761 #ifndef DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO
3762 #ifdef HAVE_AS_DWARF2_DEBUG_LINE
3763 #define DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO 1
3764 #else
3765 #define DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO 0
3766 #endif
3767 #endif
3769 /* Minimum line offset in a special line info. opcode.
3770 This value was chosen to give a reasonable range of values. */
3771 #define DWARF_LINE_BASE -10
3773 /* First special line opcode - leave room for the standard opcodes. */
3774 #define DWARF_LINE_OPCODE_BASE 10
3776 /* Range of line offsets in a special line info. opcode. */
3777 #define DWARF_LINE_RANGE (254-DWARF_LINE_OPCODE_BASE+1)
3779 /* Flag that indicates the initial value of the is_stmt_start flag.
3780 In the present implementation, we do not mark any lines as
3781 the beginning of a source statement, because that information
3782 is not made available by the GCC front-end. */
3783 #define DWARF_LINE_DEFAULT_IS_STMT_START 1
3785 #ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
3786 /* This location is used by calc_die_sizes() to keep track
3787 the offset of each DIE within the .debug_info section. */
3788 static unsigned long next_die_offset;
3789 #endif
3791 /* Record the root of the DIE's built for the current compilation unit. */
3792 static GTY(()) dw_die_ref comp_unit_die;
3794 /* A list of DIEs with a NULL parent waiting to be relocated. */
3795 static GTY(()) limbo_die_node *limbo_die_list;
3797 /* Filenames referenced by this compilation unit. */
3798 static GTY(()) varray_type file_table;
3799 static GTY(()) varray_type file_table_emitted;
3800 static GTY(()) size_t file_table_last_lookup_index;
3802 /* A hash table of references to DIE's that describe declarations.
3803 The key is a DECL_UID() which is a unique number identifying each decl. */
3804 static GTY ((param_is (struct die_struct))) htab_t decl_die_table;
3806 /* Node of the variable location list. */
3807 struct var_loc_node GTY ((chain_next ("%h.next")))
3809 rtx GTY (()) var_loc_note;
3810 const char * GTY (()) label;
3811 const char * GTY (()) section_label;
3812 struct var_loc_node * GTY (()) next;
3815 /* Variable location list. */
3816 struct var_loc_list_def GTY (())
3818 struct var_loc_node * GTY (()) first;
3820 /* Do not mark the last element of the chained list because
3821 it is marked through the chain. */
3822 struct var_loc_node * GTY ((skip ("%h"))) last;
3824 /* DECL_UID of the variable decl. */
3825 unsigned int decl_id;
3827 typedef struct var_loc_list_def var_loc_list;
3830 /* Table of decl location linked lists. */
3831 static GTY ((param_is (var_loc_list))) htab_t decl_loc_table;
3833 /* A pointer to the base of a list of references to DIE's that
3834 are uniquely identified by their tag, presence/absence of
3835 children DIE's, and list of attribute/value pairs. */
3836 static GTY((length ("abbrev_die_table_allocated")))
3837 dw_die_ref *abbrev_die_table;
3839 /* Number of elements currently allocated for abbrev_die_table. */
3840 static GTY(()) unsigned abbrev_die_table_allocated;
3842 /* Number of elements in type_die_table currently in use. */
3843 static GTY(()) unsigned abbrev_die_table_in_use;
3845 /* Size (in elements) of increments by which we may expand the
3846 abbrev_die_table. */
3847 #define ABBREV_DIE_TABLE_INCREMENT 256
3849 /* A pointer to the base of a table that contains line information
3850 for each source code line in .text in the compilation unit. */
3851 static GTY((length ("line_info_table_allocated")))
3852 dw_line_info_ref line_info_table;
3854 /* Number of elements currently allocated for line_info_table. */
3855 static GTY(()) unsigned line_info_table_allocated;
3857 /* Number of elements in line_info_table currently in use. */
3858 static GTY(()) unsigned line_info_table_in_use;
3860 /* True if the compilation unit places functions in more than one section. */
3861 static GTY(()) bool have_multiple_function_sections = false;
3863 /* A pointer to the base of a table that contains line information
3864 for each source code line outside of .text in the compilation unit. */
3865 static GTY ((length ("separate_line_info_table_allocated")))
3866 dw_separate_line_info_ref separate_line_info_table;
3868 /* Number of elements currently allocated for separate_line_info_table. */
3869 static GTY(()) unsigned separate_line_info_table_allocated;
3871 /* Number of elements in separate_line_info_table currently in use. */
3872 static GTY(()) unsigned separate_line_info_table_in_use;
3874 /* Size (in elements) of increments by which we may expand the
3875 line_info_table. */
3876 #define LINE_INFO_TABLE_INCREMENT 1024
3878 /* A pointer to the base of a table that contains a list of publicly
3879 accessible names. */
3880 static GTY ((length ("pubname_table_allocated"))) pubname_ref pubname_table;
3882 /* Number of elements currently allocated for pubname_table. */
3883 static GTY(()) unsigned pubname_table_allocated;
3885 /* Number of elements in pubname_table currently in use. */
3886 static GTY(()) unsigned pubname_table_in_use;
3888 /* Size (in elements) of increments by which we may expand the
3889 pubname_table. */
3890 #define PUBNAME_TABLE_INCREMENT 64
3892 /* Array of dies for which we should generate .debug_arange info. */
3893 static GTY((length ("arange_table_allocated"))) dw_die_ref *arange_table;
3895 /* Number of elements currently allocated for arange_table. */
3896 static GTY(()) unsigned arange_table_allocated;
3898 /* Number of elements in arange_table currently in use. */
3899 static GTY(()) unsigned arange_table_in_use;
3901 /* Size (in elements) of increments by which we may expand the
3902 arange_table. */
3903 #define ARANGE_TABLE_INCREMENT 64
3905 /* Array of dies for which we should generate .debug_ranges info. */
3906 static GTY ((length ("ranges_table_allocated"))) dw_ranges_ref ranges_table;
3908 /* Number of elements currently allocated for ranges_table. */
3909 static GTY(()) unsigned ranges_table_allocated;
3911 /* Number of elements in ranges_table currently in use. */
3912 static GTY(()) unsigned ranges_table_in_use;
3914 /* Size (in elements) of increments by which we may expand the
3915 ranges_table. */
3916 #define RANGES_TABLE_INCREMENT 64
3918 /* Whether we have location lists that need outputting */
3919 static GTY(()) bool have_location_lists;
3921 /* Unique label counter. */
3922 static GTY(()) unsigned int loclabel_num;
3924 #ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
3925 /* Record whether the function being analyzed contains inlined functions. */
3926 static int current_function_has_inlines;
3927 #endif
3928 #if 0 && defined (MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO)
3929 static int comp_unit_has_inlines;
3930 #endif
3932 /* Number of file tables emitted in maybe_emit_file(). */
3933 static GTY(()) int emitcount = 0;
3935 /* Number of internal labels generated by gen_internal_sym(). */
3936 static GTY(()) int label_num;
3938 #ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
3940 /* Offset from the "steady-state frame pointer" to the frame base,
3941 within the current function. */
3942 static HOST_WIDE_INT frame_pointer_fb_offset;
3944 /* Forward declarations for functions defined in this file. */
3946 static int is_pseudo_reg (rtx);
3947 static tree type_main_variant (tree);
3948 static int is_tagged_type (tree);
3949 static const char *dwarf_tag_name (unsigned);
3950 static const char *dwarf_attr_name (unsigned);
3951 static const char *dwarf_form_name (unsigned);
3952 static tree decl_ultimate_origin (tree);
3953 static tree block_ultimate_origin (tree);
3954 static tree decl_class_context (tree);
3955 static void add_dwarf_attr (dw_die_ref, dw_attr_ref);
3956 static inline enum dw_val_class AT_class (dw_attr_ref);
3957 static void add_AT_flag (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, unsigned);
3958 static inline unsigned AT_flag (dw_attr_ref);
3959 static void add_AT_int (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, HOST_WIDE_INT);
3960 static inline HOST_WIDE_INT AT_int (dw_attr_ref);
3961 static void add_AT_unsigned (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT);
3962 static inline unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT AT_unsigned (dw_attr_ref);
3963 static void add_AT_long_long (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, unsigned long,
3964 unsigned long);
3965 static inline void add_AT_vec (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, unsigned int,
3966 unsigned int, unsigned char *);
3967 static hashval_t debug_str_do_hash (const void *);
3968 static int debug_str_eq (const void *, const void *);
3969 static void add_AT_string (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, const char *);
3970 static inline const char *AT_string (dw_attr_ref);
3971 static int AT_string_form (dw_attr_ref);
3972 static void add_AT_die_ref (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, dw_die_ref);
3973 static void add_AT_specification (dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref);
3974 static inline dw_die_ref AT_ref (dw_attr_ref);
3975 static inline int AT_ref_external (dw_attr_ref);
3976 static inline void set_AT_ref_external (dw_attr_ref, int);
3977 static void add_AT_fde_ref (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, unsigned);
3978 static void add_AT_loc (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, dw_loc_descr_ref);
3979 static inline dw_loc_descr_ref AT_loc (dw_attr_ref);
3980 static void add_AT_loc_list (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute,
3981 dw_loc_list_ref);
3982 static inline dw_loc_list_ref AT_loc_list (dw_attr_ref);
3983 static void add_AT_addr (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, rtx);
3984 static inline rtx AT_addr (dw_attr_ref);
3985 static void add_AT_lbl_id (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, const char *);
3986 static void add_AT_lineptr (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, const char *);
3987 static void add_AT_macptr (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, const char *);
3988 static void add_AT_offset (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute,
3989 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT);
3990 static void add_AT_range_list (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute,
3991 unsigned long);
3992 static inline const char *AT_lbl (dw_attr_ref);
3993 static dw_attr_ref get_AT (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute);
3994 static const char *get_AT_low_pc (dw_die_ref);
3995 static const char *get_AT_hi_pc (dw_die_ref);
3996 static const char *get_AT_string (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute);
3997 static int get_AT_flag (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute);
3998 static unsigned get_AT_unsigned (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute);
3999 static inline dw_die_ref get_AT_ref (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute);
4000 static bool is_c_family (void);
4001 static bool is_cxx (void);
4002 static bool is_java (void);
4003 static bool is_fortran (void);
4004 static bool is_ada (void);
4005 static void remove_AT (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute);
4006 static void remove_child_TAG (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_tag);
4007 static inline void free_die (dw_die_ref);
4008 static void remove_children (dw_die_ref);
4009 static void add_child_die (dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref);
4010 static dw_die_ref new_die (enum dwarf_tag, dw_die_ref, tree);
4011 static dw_die_ref lookup_type_die (tree);
4012 static void equate_type_number_to_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4013 static hashval_t decl_die_table_hash (const void *);
4014 static int decl_die_table_eq (const void *, const void *);
4015 static dw_die_ref lookup_decl_die (tree);
4016 static hashval_t decl_loc_table_hash (const void *);
4017 static int decl_loc_table_eq (const void *, const void *);
4018 static var_loc_list *lookup_decl_loc (tree);
4019 static void equate_decl_number_to_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4020 static void add_var_loc_to_decl (tree, struct var_loc_node *);
4021 static void print_spaces (FILE *);
4022 static void print_die (dw_die_ref, FILE *);
4023 static void print_dwarf_line_table (FILE *);
4024 static void reverse_die_lists (dw_die_ref);
4025 static void reverse_all_dies (dw_die_ref);
4026 static dw_die_ref push_new_compile_unit (dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref);
4027 static dw_die_ref pop_compile_unit (dw_die_ref);
4028 static void loc_checksum (dw_loc_descr_ref, struct md5_ctx *);
4029 static void attr_checksum (dw_attr_ref, struct md5_ctx *, int *);
4030 static void die_checksum (dw_die_ref, struct md5_ctx *, int *);
4031 static int same_loc_p (dw_loc_descr_ref, dw_loc_descr_ref, int *);
4032 static int same_dw_val_p (dw_val_node *, dw_val_node *, int *);
4033 static int same_attr_p (dw_attr_ref, dw_attr_ref, int *);
4034 static int same_die_p (dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref, int *);
4035 static int same_die_p_wrap (dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref);
4036 static void compute_section_prefix (dw_die_ref);
4037 static int is_type_die (dw_die_ref);
4038 static int is_comdat_die (dw_die_ref);
4039 static int is_symbol_die (dw_die_ref);
4040 static void assign_symbol_names (dw_die_ref);
4041 static void break_out_includes (dw_die_ref);
4042 static hashval_t htab_cu_hash (const void *);
4043 static int htab_cu_eq (const void *, const void *);
4044 static void htab_cu_del (void *);
4045 static int check_duplicate_cu (dw_die_ref, htab_t, unsigned *);
4046 static void record_comdat_symbol_number (dw_die_ref, htab_t, unsigned);
4047 static void add_sibling_attributes (dw_die_ref);
4048 static void build_abbrev_table (dw_die_ref);
4049 static void output_location_lists (dw_die_ref);
4050 static int constant_size (long unsigned);
4051 static unsigned long size_of_die (dw_die_ref);
4052 static void calc_die_sizes (dw_die_ref);
4053 static void mark_dies (dw_die_ref);
4054 static void unmark_dies (dw_die_ref);
4055 static void unmark_all_dies (dw_die_ref);
4056 static unsigned long size_of_pubnames (void);
4057 static unsigned long size_of_aranges (void);
4058 static enum dwarf_form value_format (dw_attr_ref);
4059 static void output_value_format (dw_attr_ref);
4060 static void output_abbrev_section (void);
4061 static void output_die_symbol (dw_die_ref);
4062 static void output_die (dw_die_ref);
4063 static void output_compilation_unit_header (void);
4064 static void output_comp_unit (dw_die_ref, int);
4065 static const char *dwarf2_name (tree, int);
4066 static void add_pubname (tree, dw_die_ref);
4067 static void output_pubnames (void);
4068 static void add_arange (tree, dw_die_ref);
4069 static void output_aranges (void);
4070 static unsigned int add_ranges (tree);
4071 static void output_ranges (void);
4072 static void output_line_info (void);
4073 static void output_file_names (void);
4074 static dw_die_ref base_type_die (tree);
4075 static tree root_type (tree);
4076 static int is_base_type (tree);
4077 static bool is_subrange_type (tree);
4078 static dw_die_ref subrange_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4079 static dw_die_ref modified_type_die (tree, int, int, dw_die_ref);
4080 static int type_is_enum (tree);
4081 static unsigned int dbx_reg_number (rtx);
4082 static void add_loc_descr_op_piece (dw_loc_descr_ref *, int);
4083 static dw_loc_descr_ref reg_loc_descriptor (rtx);
4084 static dw_loc_descr_ref one_reg_loc_descriptor (unsigned int);
4085 static dw_loc_descr_ref multiple_reg_loc_descriptor (rtx, rtx);
4086 static dw_loc_descr_ref int_loc_descriptor (HOST_WIDE_INT);
4087 static dw_loc_descr_ref based_loc_descr (rtx, HOST_WIDE_INT);
4088 static int is_based_loc (rtx);
4089 static dw_loc_descr_ref mem_loc_descriptor (rtx, enum machine_mode mode);
4090 static dw_loc_descr_ref concat_loc_descriptor (rtx, rtx);
4091 static dw_loc_descr_ref loc_descriptor (rtx);
4092 static dw_loc_descr_ref loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (tree, int);
4093 static dw_loc_descr_ref loc_descriptor_from_tree (tree);
4094 static HOST_WIDE_INT ceiling (HOST_WIDE_INT, unsigned int);
4095 static tree field_type (tree);
4096 static unsigned int simple_type_align_in_bits (tree);
4097 static unsigned int simple_decl_align_in_bits (tree);
4098 static unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT simple_type_size_in_bits (tree);
4099 static HOST_WIDE_INT field_byte_offset (tree);
4100 static void add_AT_location_description (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute,
4101 dw_loc_descr_ref);
4102 static void add_data_member_location_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
4103 static void add_const_value_attribute (dw_die_ref, rtx);
4104 static void insert_int (HOST_WIDE_INT, unsigned, unsigned char *);
4105 static HOST_WIDE_INT extract_int (const unsigned char *, unsigned);
4106 static void insert_float (rtx, unsigned char *);
4107 static rtx rtl_for_decl_location (tree);
4108 static void add_location_or_const_value_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree,
4109 enum dwarf_attribute);
4110 static void tree_add_const_value_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
4111 static void add_name_attribute (dw_die_ref, const char *);
4112 static void add_comp_dir_attribute (dw_die_ref);
4113 static void add_bound_info (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, tree);
4114 static void add_subscript_info (dw_die_ref, tree);
4115 static void add_byte_size_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
4116 static void add_bit_offset_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
4117 static void add_bit_size_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
4118 static void add_prototyped_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
4119 static void add_abstract_origin_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
4120 static void add_pure_or_virtual_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
4121 static void add_src_coords_attributes (dw_die_ref, tree);
4122 static void add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (dw_die_ref, tree);
4123 static void push_decl_scope (tree);
4124 static void pop_decl_scope (void);
4125 static dw_die_ref scope_die_for (tree, dw_die_ref);
4126 static inline int local_scope_p (dw_die_ref);
4127 static inline int class_or_namespace_scope_p (dw_die_ref);
4128 static void add_type_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree, int, int, dw_die_ref);
4129 static void add_calling_convention_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
4130 static const char *type_tag (tree);
4131 static tree member_declared_type (tree);
4132 #if 0
4133 static const char *decl_start_label (tree);
4134 #endif
4135 static void gen_array_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4136 #if 0
4137 static void gen_entry_point_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4138 #endif
4139 static void gen_inlined_enumeration_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4140 static void gen_inlined_structure_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4141 static void gen_inlined_union_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4142 static dw_die_ref gen_enumeration_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4143 static dw_die_ref gen_formal_parameter_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4144 static void gen_unspecified_parameters_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4145 static void gen_formal_types_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4146 static void gen_subprogram_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4147 static void gen_variable_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4148 static void gen_label_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4149 static void gen_lexical_block_die (tree, dw_die_ref, int);
4150 static void gen_inlined_subroutine_die (tree, dw_die_ref, int);
4151 static void gen_field_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4152 static void gen_ptr_to_mbr_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4153 static dw_die_ref gen_compile_unit_die (const char *);
4154 static void gen_inheritance_die (tree, tree, dw_die_ref);
4155 static void gen_member_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4156 static void gen_struct_or_union_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4157 static void gen_subroutine_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4158 static void gen_typedef_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4159 static void gen_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4160 static void gen_tagged_type_instantiation_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4161 static void gen_block_die (tree, dw_die_ref, int);
4162 static void decls_for_scope (tree, dw_die_ref, int);
4163 static int is_redundant_typedef (tree);
4164 static void gen_namespace_die (tree);
4165 static void gen_decl_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4166 static dw_die_ref force_decl_die (tree);
4167 static dw_die_ref force_type_die (tree);
4168 static dw_die_ref setup_namespace_context (tree, dw_die_ref);
4169 static void declare_in_namespace (tree, dw_die_ref);
4170 static unsigned lookup_filename (const char *);
4171 static void init_file_table (void);
4172 static void retry_incomplete_types (void);
4173 static void gen_type_die_for_member (tree, tree, dw_die_ref);
4174 static void splice_child_die (dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref);
4175 static int file_info_cmp (const void *, const void *);
4176 static dw_loc_list_ref new_loc_list (dw_loc_descr_ref, const char *,
4177 const char *, const char *, unsigned);
4178 static void add_loc_descr_to_loc_list (dw_loc_list_ref *, dw_loc_descr_ref,
4179 const char *, const char *,
4180 const char *);
4181 static void output_loc_list (dw_loc_list_ref);
4182 static char *gen_internal_sym (const char *);
4184 static void prune_unmark_dies (dw_die_ref);
4185 static void prune_unused_types_mark (dw_die_ref, int);
4186 static void prune_unused_types_walk (dw_die_ref);
4187 static void prune_unused_types_walk_attribs (dw_die_ref);
4188 static void prune_unused_types_prune (dw_die_ref);
4189 static void prune_unused_types (void);
4190 static int maybe_emit_file (int);
4192 /* Section names used to hold DWARF debugging information. */
4193 #ifndef DEBUG_INFO_SECTION
4194 #define DEBUG_INFO_SECTION ".debug_info"
4195 #endif
4196 #ifndef DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION
4197 #define DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION ".debug_abbrev"
4198 #endif
4199 #ifndef DEBUG_ARANGES_SECTION
4200 #define DEBUG_ARANGES_SECTION ".debug_aranges"
4201 #endif
4202 #ifndef DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION
4203 #define DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION ".debug_macinfo"
4204 #endif
4205 #ifndef DEBUG_LINE_SECTION
4206 #define DEBUG_LINE_SECTION ".debug_line"
4207 #endif
4208 #ifndef DEBUG_LOC_SECTION
4209 #define DEBUG_LOC_SECTION ".debug_loc"
4210 #endif
4211 #ifndef DEBUG_PUBNAMES_SECTION
4212 #define DEBUG_PUBNAMES_SECTION ".debug_pubnames"
4213 #endif
4214 #ifndef DEBUG_STR_SECTION
4215 #define DEBUG_STR_SECTION ".debug_str"
4216 #endif
4217 #ifndef DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION
4218 #define DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION ".debug_ranges"
4219 #endif
4221 /* Standard ELF section names for compiled code and data. */
4222 #ifndef TEXT_SECTION_NAME
4223 #define TEXT_SECTION_NAME ".text"
4224 #endif
4226 /* Section flags for .debug_str section. */
4227 #define DEBUG_STR_SECTION_FLAGS \
4228 (HAVE_GAS_SHF_MERGE && flag_merge_constants \
4229 ? SECTION_DEBUG | SECTION_MERGE | SECTION_STRINGS | 1 \
4230 : SECTION_DEBUG)
4232 /* Labels we insert at beginning sections we can reference instead of
4233 the section names themselves. */
4235 #ifndef TEXT_SECTION_LABEL
4236 #define TEXT_SECTION_LABEL "Ltext"
4237 #endif
4238 #ifndef COLD_TEXT_SECTION_LABEL
4239 #define COLD_TEXT_SECTION_LABEL "Ltext_cold"
4240 #endif
4241 #ifndef DEBUG_LINE_SECTION_LABEL
4242 #define DEBUG_LINE_SECTION_LABEL "Ldebug_line"
4243 #endif
4244 #ifndef DEBUG_INFO_SECTION_LABEL
4245 #define DEBUG_INFO_SECTION_LABEL "Ldebug_info"
4246 #endif
4247 #ifndef DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION_LABEL
4248 #define DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION_LABEL "Ldebug_abbrev"
4249 #endif
4250 #ifndef DEBUG_LOC_SECTION_LABEL
4251 #define DEBUG_LOC_SECTION_LABEL "Ldebug_loc"
4252 #endif
4253 #ifndef DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION_LABEL
4254 #define DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION_LABEL "Ldebug_ranges"
4255 #endif
4256 #ifndef DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION_LABEL
4257 #define DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION_LABEL "Ldebug_macinfo"
4258 #endif
4260 /* Definitions of defaults for formats and names of various special
4261 (artificial) labels which may be generated within this file (when the -g
4262 options is used and DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO is in effect.
4263 If necessary, these may be overridden from within the tm.h file, but
4264 typically, overriding these defaults is unnecessary. */
4266 static char text_end_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
4267 static char text_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
4268 static char cold_text_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
4269 static char cold_end_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
4270 static char abbrev_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
4271 static char debug_info_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
4272 static char debug_line_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
4273 static char macinfo_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
4274 static char loc_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
4275 static char ranges_section_label[2 * MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
4277 #ifndef TEXT_END_LABEL
4278 #define TEXT_END_LABEL "Letext"
4279 #endif
4280 #ifndef COLD_END_LABEL
4281 #define COLD_END_LABEL "Letext_cold"
4282 #endif
4283 #ifndef BLOCK_BEGIN_LABEL
4284 #define BLOCK_BEGIN_LABEL "LBB"
4285 #endif
4286 #ifndef BLOCK_END_LABEL
4287 #define BLOCK_END_LABEL "LBE"
4288 #endif
4289 #ifndef LINE_CODE_LABEL
4290 #define LINE_CODE_LABEL "LM"
4291 #endif
4292 #ifndef SEPARATE_LINE_CODE_LABEL
4293 #define SEPARATE_LINE_CODE_LABEL "LSM"
4294 #endif
4296 /* We allow a language front-end to designate a function that is to be
4297 called to "demangle" any name before it is put into a DIE. */
4299 static const char *(*demangle_name_func) (const char *);
4301 void
4302 dwarf2out_set_demangle_name_func (const char *(*func) (const char *))
4304 demangle_name_func = func;
4307 /* Test if rtl node points to a pseudo register. */
4309 static inline int
4310 is_pseudo_reg (rtx rtl)
4312 return ((REG_P (rtl) && REGNO (rtl) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
4313 || (GET_CODE (rtl) == SUBREG
4314 && REGNO (SUBREG_REG (rtl)) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER));
4317 /* Return a reference to a type, with its const and volatile qualifiers
4318 removed. */
4320 static inline tree
4321 type_main_variant (tree type)
4323 type = TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (type);
4325 /* ??? There really should be only one main variant among any group of
4326 variants of a given type (and all of the MAIN_VARIANT values for all
4327 members of the group should point to that one type) but sometimes the C
4328 front-end messes this up for array types, so we work around that bug
4329 here. */
4330 if (TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE)
4331 while (type != TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (type))
4332 type = TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (type);
4334 return type;
4337 /* Return nonzero if the given type node represents a tagged type. */
4339 static inline int
4340 is_tagged_type (tree type)
4342 enum tree_code code = TREE_CODE (type);
4344 return (code == RECORD_TYPE || code == UNION_TYPE
4345 || code == QUAL_UNION_TYPE || code == ENUMERAL_TYPE);
4348 /* Convert a DIE tag into its string name. */
4350 static const char *
4351 dwarf_tag_name (unsigned int tag)
4353 switch (tag)
4355 case DW_TAG_padding:
4356 return "DW_TAG_padding";
4357 case DW_TAG_array_type:
4358 return "DW_TAG_array_type";
4359 case DW_TAG_class_type:
4360 return "DW_TAG_class_type";
4361 case DW_TAG_entry_point:
4362 return "DW_TAG_entry_point";
4363 case DW_TAG_enumeration_type:
4364 return "DW_TAG_enumeration_type";
4365 case DW_TAG_formal_parameter:
4366 return "DW_TAG_formal_parameter";
4367 case DW_TAG_imported_declaration:
4368 return "DW_TAG_imported_declaration";
4369 case DW_TAG_label:
4370 return "DW_TAG_label";
4371 case DW_TAG_lexical_block:
4372 return "DW_TAG_lexical_block";
4373 case DW_TAG_member:
4374 return "DW_TAG_member";
4375 case DW_TAG_pointer_type:
4376 return "DW_TAG_pointer_type";
4377 case DW_TAG_reference_type:
4378 return "DW_TAG_reference_type";
4379 case DW_TAG_compile_unit:
4380 return "DW_TAG_compile_unit";
4381 case DW_TAG_string_type:
4382 return "DW_TAG_string_type";
4383 case DW_TAG_structure_type:
4384 return "DW_TAG_structure_type";
4385 case DW_TAG_subroutine_type:
4386 return "DW_TAG_subroutine_type";
4387 case DW_TAG_typedef:
4388 return "DW_TAG_typedef";
4389 case DW_TAG_union_type:
4390 return "DW_TAG_union_type";
4391 case DW_TAG_unspecified_parameters:
4392 return "DW_TAG_unspecified_parameters";
4393 case DW_TAG_variant:
4394 return "DW_TAG_variant";
4395 case DW_TAG_common_block:
4396 return "DW_TAG_common_block";
4397 case DW_TAG_common_inclusion:
4398 return "DW_TAG_common_inclusion";
4399 case DW_TAG_inheritance:
4400 return "DW_TAG_inheritance";
4401 case DW_TAG_inlined_subroutine:
4402 return "DW_TAG_inlined_subroutine";
4403 case DW_TAG_module:
4404 return "DW_TAG_module";
4405 case DW_TAG_ptr_to_member_type:
4406 return "DW_TAG_ptr_to_member_type";
4407 case DW_TAG_set_type:
4408 return "DW_TAG_set_type";
4409 case DW_TAG_subrange_type:
4410 return "DW_TAG_subrange_type";
4411 case DW_TAG_with_stmt:
4412 return "DW_TAG_with_stmt";
4413 case DW_TAG_access_declaration:
4414 return "DW_TAG_access_declaration";
4415 case DW_TAG_base_type:
4416 return "DW_TAG_base_type";
4417 case DW_TAG_catch_block:
4418 return "DW_TAG_catch_block";
4419 case DW_TAG_const_type:
4420 return "DW_TAG_const_type";
4421 case DW_TAG_constant:
4422 return "DW_TAG_constant";
4423 case DW_TAG_enumerator:
4424 return "DW_TAG_enumerator";
4425 case DW_TAG_file_type:
4426 return "DW_TAG_file_type";
4427 case DW_TAG_friend:
4428 return "DW_TAG_friend";
4429 case DW_TAG_namelist:
4430 return "DW_TAG_namelist";
4431 case DW_TAG_namelist_item:
4432 return "DW_TAG_namelist_item";
4433 case DW_TAG_namespace:
4434 return "DW_TAG_namespace";
4435 case DW_TAG_packed_type:
4436 return "DW_TAG_packed_type";
4437 case DW_TAG_subprogram:
4438 return "DW_TAG_subprogram";
4439 case DW_TAG_template_type_param:
4440 return "DW_TAG_template_type_param";
4441 case DW_TAG_template_value_param:
4442 return "DW_TAG_template_value_param";
4443 case DW_TAG_thrown_type:
4444 return "DW_TAG_thrown_type";
4445 case DW_TAG_try_block:
4446 return "DW_TAG_try_block";
4447 case DW_TAG_variant_part:
4448 return "DW_TAG_variant_part";
4449 case DW_TAG_variable:
4450 return "DW_TAG_variable";
4451 case DW_TAG_volatile_type:
4452 return "DW_TAG_volatile_type";
4453 case DW_TAG_imported_module:
4454 return "DW_TAG_imported_module";
4455 case DW_TAG_MIPS_loop:
4456 return "DW_TAG_MIPS_loop";
4457 case DW_TAG_format_label:
4458 return "DW_TAG_format_label";
4459 case DW_TAG_function_template:
4460 return "DW_TAG_function_template";
4461 case DW_TAG_class_template:
4462 return "DW_TAG_class_template";
4463 case DW_TAG_GNU_BINCL:
4464 return "DW_TAG_GNU_BINCL";
4465 case DW_TAG_GNU_EINCL:
4466 return "DW_TAG_GNU_EINCL";
4467 default:
4468 return "DW_TAG_<unknown>";
4472 /* Convert a DWARF attribute code into its string name. */
4474 static const char *
4475 dwarf_attr_name (unsigned int attr)
4477 switch (attr)
4479 case DW_AT_sibling:
4480 return "DW_AT_sibling";
4481 case DW_AT_location:
4482 return "DW_AT_location";
4483 case DW_AT_name:
4484 return "DW_AT_name";
4485 case DW_AT_ordering:
4486 return "DW_AT_ordering";
4487 case DW_AT_subscr_data:
4488 return "DW_AT_subscr_data";
4489 case DW_AT_byte_size:
4490 return "DW_AT_byte_size";
4491 case DW_AT_bit_offset:
4492 return "DW_AT_bit_offset";
4493 case DW_AT_bit_size:
4494 return "DW_AT_bit_size";
4495 case DW_AT_element_list:
4496 return "DW_AT_element_list";
4497 case DW_AT_stmt_list:
4498 return "DW_AT_stmt_list";
4499 case DW_AT_low_pc:
4500 return "DW_AT_low_pc";
4501 case DW_AT_high_pc:
4502 return "DW_AT_high_pc";
4503 case DW_AT_language:
4504 return "DW_AT_language";
4505 case DW_AT_member:
4506 return "DW_AT_member";
4507 case DW_AT_discr:
4508 return "DW_AT_discr";
4509 case DW_AT_discr_value:
4510 return "DW_AT_discr_value";
4511 case DW_AT_visibility:
4512 return "DW_AT_visibility";
4513 case DW_AT_import:
4514 return "DW_AT_import";
4515 case DW_AT_string_length:
4516 return "DW_AT_string_length";
4517 case DW_AT_common_reference:
4518 return "DW_AT_common_reference";
4519 case DW_AT_comp_dir:
4520 return "DW_AT_comp_dir";
4521 case DW_AT_const_value:
4522 return "DW_AT_const_value";
4523 case DW_AT_containing_type:
4524 return "DW_AT_containing_type";
4525 case DW_AT_default_value:
4526 return "DW_AT_default_value";
4527 case DW_AT_inline:
4528 return "DW_AT_inline";
4529 case DW_AT_is_optional:
4530 return "DW_AT_is_optional";
4531 case DW_AT_lower_bound:
4532 return "DW_AT_lower_bound";
4533 case DW_AT_producer:
4534 return "DW_AT_producer";
4535 case DW_AT_prototyped:
4536 return "DW_AT_prototyped";
4537 case DW_AT_return_addr:
4538 return "DW_AT_return_addr";
4539 case DW_AT_start_scope:
4540 return "DW_AT_start_scope";
4541 case DW_AT_stride_size:
4542 return "DW_AT_stride_size";
4543 case DW_AT_upper_bound:
4544 return "DW_AT_upper_bound";
4545 case DW_AT_abstract_origin:
4546 return "DW_AT_abstract_origin";
4547 case DW_AT_accessibility:
4548 return "DW_AT_accessibility";
4549 case DW_AT_address_class:
4550 return "DW_AT_address_class";
4551 case DW_AT_artificial:
4552 return "DW_AT_artificial";
4553 case DW_AT_base_types:
4554 return "DW_AT_base_types";
4555 case DW_AT_calling_convention:
4556 return "DW_AT_calling_convention";
4557 case DW_AT_count:
4558 return "DW_AT_count";
4559 case DW_AT_data_member_location:
4560 return "DW_AT_data_member_location";
4561 case DW_AT_decl_column:
4562 return "DW_AT_decl_column";
4563 case DW_AT_decl_file:
4564 return "DW_AT_decl_file";
4565 case DW_AT_decl_line:
4566 return "DW_AT_decl_line";
4567 case DW_AT_declaration:
4568 return "DW_AT_declaration";
4569 case DW_AT_discr_list:
4570 return "DW_AT_discr_list";
4571 case DW_AT_encoding:
4572 return "DW_AT_encoding";
4573 case DW_AT_external:
4574 return "DW_AT_external";
4575 case DW_AT_frame_base:
4576 return "DW_AT_frame_base";
4577 case DW_AT_friend:
4578 return "DW_AT_friend";
4579 case DW_AT_identifier_case:
4580 return "DW_AT_identifier_case";
4581 case DW_AT_macro_info:
4582 return "DW_AT_macro_info";
4583 case DW_AT_namelist_items:
4584 return "DW_AT_namelist_items";
4585 case DW_AT_priority:
4586 return "DW_AT_priority";
4587 case DW_AT_segment:
4588 return "DW_AT_segment";
4589 case DW_AT_specification:
4590 return "DW_AT_specification";
4591 case DW_AT_static_link:
4592 return "DW_AT_static_link";
4593 case DW_AT_type:
4594 return "DW_AT_type";
4595 case DW_AT_use_location:
4596 return "DW_AT_use_location";
4597 case DW_AT_variable_parameter:
4598 return "DW_AT_variable_parameter";
4599 case DW_AT_virtuality:
4600 return "DW_AT_virtuality";
4601 case DW_AT_vtable_elem_location:
4602 return "DW_AT_vtable_elem_location";
4604 case DW_AT_allocated:
4605 return "DW_AT_allocated";
4606 case DW_AT_associated:
4607 return "DW_AT_associated";
4608 case DW_AT_data_location:
4609 return "DW_AT_data_location";
4610 case DW_AT_stride:
4611 return "DW_AT_stride";
4612 case DW_AT_entry_pc:
4613 return "DW_AT_entry_pc";
4614 case DW_AT_use_UTF8:
4615 return "DW_AT_use_UTF8";
4616 case DW_AT_extension:
4617 return "DW_AT_extension";
4618 case DW_AT_ranges:
4619 return "DW_AT_ranges";
4620 case DW_AT_trampoline:
4621 return "DW_AT_trampoline";
4622 case DW_AT_call_column:
4623 return "DW_AT_call_column";
4624 case DW_AT_call_file:
4625 return "DW_AT_call_file";
4626 case DW_AT_call_line:
4627 return "DW_AT_call_line";
4629 case DW_AT_MIPS_fde:
4630 return "DW_AT_MIPS_fde";
4631 case DW_AT_MIPS_loop_begin:
4632 return "DW_AT_MIPS_loop_begin";
4633 case DW_AT_MIPS_tail_loop_begin:
4634 return "DW_AT_MIPS_tail_loop_begin";
4635 case DW_AT_MIPS_epilog_begin:
4636 return "DW_AT_MIPS_epilog_begin";
4637 case DW_AT_MIPS_loop_unroll_factor:
4638 return "DW_AT_MIPS_loop_unroll_factor";
4639 case DW_AT_MIPS_software_pipeline_depth:
4640 return "DW_AT_MIPS_software_pipeline_depth";
4641 case DW_AT_MIPS_linkage_name:
4642 return "DW_AT_MIPS_linkage_name";
4643 case DW_AT_MIPS_stride:
4644 return "DW_AT_MIPS_stride";
4645 case DW_AT_MIPS_abstract_name:
4646 return "DW_AT_MIPS_abstract_name";
4647 case DW_AT_MIPS_clone_origin:
4648 return "DW_AT_MIPS_clone_origin";
4649 case DW_AT_MIPS_has_inlines:
4650 return "DW_AT_MIPS_has_inlines";
4652 case DW_AT_sf_names:
4653 return "DW_AT_sf_names";
4654 case DW_AT_src_info:
4655 return "DW_AT_src_info";
4656 case DW_AT_mac_info:
4657 return "DW_AT_mac_info";
4658 case DW_AT_src_coords:
4659 return "DW_AT_src_coords";
4660 case DW_AT_body_begin:
4661 return "DW_AT_body_begin";
4662 case DW_AT_body_end:
4663 return "DW_AT_body_end";
4664 case DW_AT_GNU_vector:
4665 return "DW_AT_GNU_vector";
4667 case DW_AT_VMS_rtnbeg_pd_address:
4668 return "DW_AT_VMS_rtnbeg_pd_address";
4670 default:
4671 return "DW_AT_<unknown>";
4675 /* Convert a DWARF value form code into its string name. */
4677 static const char *
4678 dwarf_form_name (unsigned int form)
4680 switch (form)
4682 case DW_FORM_addr:
4683 return "DW_FORM_addr";
4684 case DW_FORM_block2:
4685 return "DW_FORM_block2";
4686 case DW_FORM_block4:
4687 return "DW_FORM_block4";
4688 case DW_FORM_data2:
4689 return "DW_FORM_data2";
4690 case DW_FORM_data4:
4691 return "DW_FORM_data4";
4692 case DW_FORM_data8:
4693 return "DW_FORM_data8";
4694 case DW_FORM_string:
4695 return "DW_FORM_string";
4696 case DW_FORM_block:
4697 return "DW_FORM_block";
4698 case DW_FORM_block1:
4699 return "DW_FORM_block1";
4700 case DW_FORM_data1:
4701 return "DW_FORM_data1";
4702 case DW_FORM_flag:
4703 return "DW_FORM_flag";
4704 case DW_FORM_sdata:
4705 return "DW_FORM_sdata";
4706 case DW_FORM_strp:
4707 return "DW_FORM_strp";
4708 case DW_FORM_udata:
4709 return "DW_FORM_udata";
4710 case DW_FORM_ref_addr:
4711 return "DW_FORM_ref_addr";
4712 case DW_FORM_ref1:
4713 return "DW_FORM_ref1";
4714 case DW_FORM_ref2:
4715 return "DW_FORM_ref2";
4716 case DW_FORM_ref4:
4717 return "DW_FORM_ref4";
4718 case DW_FORM_ref8:
4719 return "DW_FORM_ref8";
4720 case DW_FORM_ref_udata:
4721 return "DW_FORM_ref_udata";
4722 case DW_FORM_indirect:
4723 return "DW_FORM_indirect";
4724 default:
4725 return "DW_FORM_<unknown>";
4729 /* Determine the "ultimate origin" of a decl. The decl may be an inlined
4730 instance of an inlined instance of a decl which is local to an inline
4731 function, so we have to trace all of the way back through the origin chain
4732 to find out what sort of node actually served as the original seed for the
4733 given block. */
4735 static tree
4736 decl_ultimate_origin (tree decl)
4738 if (!CODE_CONTAINS_STRUCT (TREE_CODE (decl), TS_DECL_COMMON))
4739 return NULL_TREE;
4741 /* output_inline_function sets DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN for all the
4742 nodes in the function to point to themselves; ignore that if
4743 we're trying to output the abstract instance of this function. */
4744 if (DECL_ABSTRACT (decl) && DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl) == decl)
4745 return NULL_TREE;
4747 /* Since the DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN for a DECL is supposed to be the
4748 most distant ancestor, this should never happen. */
4749 gcc_assert (!DECL_FROM_INLINE (DECL_ORIGIN (decl)));
4751 return DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl);
4754 /* Determine the "ultimate origin" of a block. The block may be an inlined
4755 instance of an inlined instance of a block which is local to an inline
4756 function, so we have to trace all of the way back through the origin chain
4757 to find out what sort of node actually served as the original seed for the
4758 given block. */
4760 static tree
4761 block_ultimate_origin (tree block)
4763 tree immediate_origin = BLOCK_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (block);
4765 /* output_inline_function sets BLOCK_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN for all the
4766 nodes in the function to point to themselves; ignore that if
4767 we're trying to output the abstract instance of this function. */
4768 if (BLOCK_ABSTRACT (block) && immediate_origin == block)
4769 return NULL_TREE;
4771 if (immediate_origin == NULL_TREE)
4772 return NULL_TREE;
4773 else
4775 tree ret_val;
4776 tree lookahead = immediate_origin;
4780 ret_val = lookahead;
4781 lookahead = (TREE_CODE (ret_val) == BLOCK
4782 ? BLOCK_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (ret_val) : NULL);
4784 while (lookahead != NULL && lookahead != ret_val);
4786 /* The block's abstract origin chain may not be the *ultimate* origin of
4787 the block. It could lead to a DECL that has an abstract origin set.
4788 If so, we want that DECL's abstract origin (which is what DECL_ORIGIN
4789 will give us if it has one). Note that DECL's abstract origins are
4790 supposed to be the most distant ancestor (or so decl_ultimate_origin
4791 claims), so we don't need to loop following the DECL origins. */
4792 if (DECL_P (ret_val))
4793 return DECL_ORIGIN (ret_val);
4795 return ret_val;
4799 /* Get the class to which DECL belongs, if any. In g++, the DECL_CONTEXT
4800 of a virtual function may refer to a base class, so we check the 'this'
4801 parameter. */
4803 static tree
4804 decl_class_context (tree decl)
4806 tree context = NULL_TREE;
4808 if (TREE_CODE (decl) != FUNCTION_DECL || ! DECL_VINDEX (decl))
4809 context = DECL_CONTEXT (decl);
4810 else
4811 context = TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT
4812 (TREE_TYPE (TREE_VALUE (TYPE_ARG_TYPES (TREE_TYPE (decl)))));
4814 if (context && !TYPE_P (context))
4815 context = NULL_TREE;
4817 return context;
4820 /* Add an attribute/value pair to a DIE. We build the lists up in reverse
4821 addition order, and correct that in reverse_all_dies. */
4823 static inline void
4824 add_dwarf_attr (dw_die_ref die, dw_attr_ref attr)
4826 if (die != NULL && attr != NULL)
4828 attr->dw_attr_next = die->die_attr;
4829 die->die_attr = attr;
4833 static inline enum dw_val_class
4834 AT_class (dw_attr_ref a)
4836 return a->dw_attr_val.val_class;
4839 /* Add a flag value attribute to a DIE. */
4841 static inline void
4842 add_AT_flag (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, unsigned int flag)
4844 dw_attr_ref attr = ggc_alloc (sizeof (dw_attr_node));
4846 attr->dw_attr_next = NULL;
4847 attr->dw_attr = attr_kind;
4848 attr->dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_flag;
4849 attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_flag = flag;
4850 add_dwarf_attr (die, attr);
4853 static inline unsigned
4854 AT_flag (dw_attr_ref a)
4856 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_flag);
4857 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_flag;
4860 /* Add a signed integer attribute value to a DIE. */
4862 static inline void
4863 add_AT_int (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, HOST_WIDE_INT int_val)
4865 dw_attr_ref attr = ggc_alloc (sizeof (dw_attr_node));
4867 attr->dw_attr_next = NULL;
4868 attr->dw_attr = attr_kind;
4869 attr->dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_const;
4870 attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_int = int_val;
4871 add_dwarf_attr (die, attr);
4874 static inline HOST_WIDE_INT
4875 AT_int (dw_attr_ref a)
4877 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_const);
4878 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_int;
4881 /* Add an unsigned integer attribute value to a DIE. */
4883 static inline void
4884 add_AT_unsigned (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
4885 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT unsigned_val)
4887 dw_attr_ref attr = ggc_alloc (sizeof (dw_attr_node));
4889 attr->dw_attr_next = NULL;
4890 attr->dw_attr = attr_kind;
4891 attr->dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_unsigned_const;
4892 attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_unsigned = unsigned_val;
4893 add_dwarf_attr (die, attr);
4896 static inline unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT
4897 AT_unsigned (dw_attr_ref a)
4899 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_unsigned_const);
4900 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_unsigned;
4903 /* Add an unsigned double integer attribute value to a DIE. */
4905 static inline void
4906 add_AT_long_long (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
4907 long unsigned int val_hi, long unsigned int val_low)
4909 dw_attr_ref attr = ggc_alloc (sizeof (dw_attr_node));
4911 attr->dw_attr_next = NULL;
4912 attr->dw_attr = attr_kind;
4913 attr->dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_long_long;
4914 attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_long_long.hi = val_hi;
4915 attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_long_long.low = val_low;
4916 add_dwarf_attr (die, attr);
4919 /* Add a floating point attribute value to a DIE and return it. */
4921 static inline void
4922 add_AT_vec (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
4923 unsigned int length, unsigned int elt_size, unsigned char *array)
4925 dw_attr_ref attr = ggc_alloc (sizeof (dw_attr_node));
4927 attr->dw_attr_next = NULL;
4928 attr->dw_attr = attr_kind;
4929 attr->dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_vec;
4930 attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.length = length;
4931 attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.elt_size = elt_size;
4932 attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.array = array;
4933 add_dwarf_attr (die, attr);
4936 /* Hash and equality functions for debug_str_hash. */
4938 static hashval_t
4939 debug_str_do_hash (const void *x)
4941 return htab_hash_string (((const struct indirect_string_node *)x)->str);
4944 static int
4945 debug_str_eq (const void *x1, const void *x2)
4947 return strcmp ((((const struct indirect_string_node *)x1)->str),
4948 (const char *)x2) == 0;
4951 /* Add a string attribute value to a DIE. */
4953 static inline void
4954 add_AT_string (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, const char *str)
4956 dw_attr_ref attr = ggc_alloc (sizeof (dw_attr_node));
4957 struct indirect_string_node *node;
4958 void **slot;
4960 if (! debug_str_hash)
4961 debug_str_hash = htab_create_ggc (10, debug_str_do_hash,
4962 debug_str_eq, NULL);
4964 slot = htab_find_slot_with_hash (debug_str_hash, str,
4965 htab_hash_string (str), INSERT);
4966 if (*slot == NULL)
4967 *slot = ggc_alloc_cleared (sizeof (struct indirect_string_node));
4968 node = (struct indirect_string_node *) *slot;
4969 node->str = ggc_strdup (str);
4970 node->refcount++;
4972 attr->dw_attr_next = NULL;
4973 attr->dw_attr = attr_kind;
4974 attr->dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_str;
4975 attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_str = node;
4976 add_dwarf_attr (die, attr);
4979 static inline const char *
4980 AT_string (dw_attr_ref a)
4982 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_str);
4983 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->str;
4986 /* Find out whether a string should be output inline in DIE
4987 or out-of-line in .debug_str section. */
4989 static int
4990 AT_string_form (dw_attr_ref a)
4992 struct indirect_string_node *node;
4993 unsigned int len;
4994 char label[32];
4996 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_str);
4998 node = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str;
4999 if (node->form)
5000 return node->form;
5002 len = strlen (node->str) + 1;
5004 /* If the string is shorter or equal to the size of the reference, it is
5005 always better to put it inline. */
5006 if (len <= DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE || node->refcount == 0)
5007 return node->form = DW_FORM_string;
5009 /* If we cannot expect the linker to merge strings in .debug_str
5010 section, only put it into .debug_str if it is worth even in this
5011 single module. */
5012 if ((debug_str_section->common.flags & SECTION_MERGE) == 0
5013 && (len - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE) * node->refcount <= len)
5014 return node->form = DW_FORM_string;
5016 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, "LASF", dw2_string_counter);
5017 ++dw2_string_counter;
5018 node->label = xstrdup (label);
5020 return node->form = DW_FORM_strp;
5023 /* Add a DIE reference attribute value to a DIE. */
5025 static inline void
5026 add_AT_die_ref (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, dw_die_ref targ_die)
5028 dw_attr_ref attr = ggc_alloc (sizeof (dw_attr_node));
5030 attr->dw_attr_next = NULL;
5031 attr->dw_attr = attr_kind;
5032 attr->dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
5033 attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.die = targ_die;
5034 attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
5035 add_dwarf_attr (die, attr);
5038 /* Add an AT_specification attribute to a DIE, and also make the back
5039 pointer from the specification to the definition. */
5041 static inline void
5042 add_AT_specification (dw_die_ref die, dw_die_ref targ_die)
5044 add_AT_die_ref (die, DW_AT_specification, targ_die);
5045 gcc_assert (!targ_die->die_definition);
5046 targ_die->die_definition = die;
5049 static inline dw_die_ref
5050 AT_ref (dw_attr_ref a)
5052 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_die_ref);
5053 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.die;
5056 static inline int
5057 AT_ref_external (dw_attr_ref a)
5059 if (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_die_ref)
5060 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.external;
5062 return 0;
5065 static inline void
5066 set_AT_ref_external (dw_attr_ref a, int i)
5068 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_die_ref);
5069 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.external = i;
5072 /* Add an FDE reference attribute value to a DIE. */
5074 static inline void
5075 add_AT_fde_ref (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, unsigned int targ_fde)
5077 dw_attr_ref attr = ggc_alloc (sizeof (dw_attr_node));
5079 attr->dw_attr_next = NULL;
5080 attr->dw_attr = attr_kind;
5081 attr->dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_fde_ref;
5082 attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_fde_index = targ_fde;
5083 add_dwarf_attr (die, attr);
5086 /* Add a location description attribute value to a DIE. */
5088 static inline void
5089 add_AT_loc (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
5091 dw_attr_ref attr = ggc_alloc (sizeof (dw_attr_node));
5093 attr->dw_attr_next = NULL;
5094 attr->dw_attr = attr_kind;
5095 attr->dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
5096 attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_loc = loc;
5097 add_dwarf_attr (die, attr);
5100 static inline dw_loc_descr_ref
5101 AT_loc (dw_attr_ref a)
5103 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_loc);
5104 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_loc;
5107 static inline void
5108 add_AT_loc_list (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, dw_loc_list_ref loc_list)
5110 dw_attr_ref attr = ggc_alloc (sizeof (dw_attr_node));
5112 attr->dw_attr_next = NULL;
5113 attr->dw_attr = attr_kind;
5114 attr->dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_loc_list;
5115 attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_loc_list = loc_list;
5116 add_dwarf_attr (die, attr);
5117 have_location_lists = true;
5120 static inline dw_loc_list_ref
5121 AT_loc_list (dw_attr_ref a)
5123 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_loc_list);
5124 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_loc_list;
5127 /* Add an address constant attribute value to a DIE. */
5129 static inline void
5130 add_AT_addr (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, rtx addr)
5132 dw_attr_ref attr = ggc_alloc (sizeof (dw_attr_node));
5134 attr->dw_attr_next = NULL;
5135 attr->dw_attr = attr_kind;
5136 attr->dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_addr;
5137 attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_addr = addr;
5138 add_dwarf_attr (die, attr);
5141 static inline rtx
5142 AT_addr (dw_attr_ref a)
5144 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_addr);
5145 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_addr;
5148 /* Add a label identifier attribute value to a DIE. */
5150 static inline void
5151 add_AT_lbl_id (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, const char *lbl_id)
5153 dw_attr_ref attr = ggc_alloc (sizeof (dw_attr_node));
5155 attr->dw_attr_next = NULL;
5156 attr->dw_attr = attr_kind;
5157 attr->dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_lbl_id;
5158 attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_lbl_id = xstrdup (lbl_id);
5159 add_dwarf_attr (die, attr);
5162 /* Add a section offset attribute value to a DIE, an offset into the
5163 debug_line section. */
5165 static inline void
5166 add_AT_lineptr (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
5167 const char *label)
5169 dw_attr_ref attr = ggc_alloc (sizeof (dw_attr_node));
5171 attr->dw_attr_next = NULL;
5172 attr->dw_attr = attr_kind;
5173 attr->dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_lineptr;
5174 attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_lbl_id = xstrdup (label);
5175 add_dwarf_attr (die, attr);
5178 /* Add a section offset attribute value to a DIE, an offset into the
5179 debug_macinfo section. */
5181 static inline void
5182 add_AT_macptr (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
5183 const char *label)
5185 dw_attr_ref attr = ggc_alloc (sizeof (dw_attr_node));
5187 attr->dw_attr_next = NULL;
5188 attr->dw_attr = attr_kind;
5189 attr->dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_macptr;
5190 attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_lbl_id = xstrdup (label);
5191 add_dwarf_attr (die, attr);
5194 /* Add an offset attribute value to a DIE. */
5196 static inline void
5197 add_AT_offset (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
5198 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
5200 dw_attr_ref attr = ggc_alloc (sizeof (dw_attr_node));
5202 attr->dw_attr_next = NULL;
5203 attr->dw_attr = attr_kind;
5204 attr->dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_offset;
5205 attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_offset = offset;
5206 add_dwarf_attr (die, attr);
5209 /* Add an range_list attribute value to a DIE. */
5211 static void
5212 add_AT_range_list (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
5213 long unsigned int offset)
5215 dw_attr_ref attr = ggc_alloc (sizeof (dw_attr_node));
5217 attr->dw_attr_next = NULL;
5218 attr->dw_attr = attr_kind;
5219 attr->dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_range_list;
5220 attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_offset = offset;
5221 add_dwarf_attr (die, attr);
5224 static inline const char *
5225 AT_lbl (dw_attr_ref a)
5227 gcc_assert (a && (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_lbl_id
5228 || AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_lineptr
5229 || AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_macptr));
5230 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_lbl_id;
5233 /* Get the attribute of type attr_kind. */
5235 static dw_attr_ref
5236 get_AT (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)
5238 dw_attr_ref a;
5239 dw_die_ref spec = NULL;
5241 if (die != NULL)
5243 for (a = die->die_attr; a != NULL; a = a->dw_attr_next)
5244 if (a->dw_attr == attr_kind)
5245 return a;
5246 else if (a->dw_attr == DW_AT_specification
5247 || a->dw_attr == DW_AT_abstract_origin)
5248 spec = AT_ref (a);
5250 if (spec)
5251 return get_AT (spec, attr_kind);
5254 return NULL;
5257 /* Return the "low pc" attribute value, typically associated with a subprogram
5258 DIE. Return null if the "low pc" attribute is either not present, or if it
5259 cannot be represented as an assembler label identifier. */
5261 static inline const char *
5262 get_AT_low_pc (dw_die_ref die)
5264 dw_attr_ref a = get_AT (die, DW_AT_low_pc);
5266 return a ? AT_lbl (a) : NULL;
5269 /* Return the "high pc" attribute value, typically associated with a subprogram
5270 DIE. Return null if the "high pc" attribute is either not present, or if it
5271 cannot be represented as an assembler label identifier. */
5273 static inline const char *
5274 get_AT_hi_pc (dw_die_ref die)
5276 dw_attr_ref a = get_AT (die, DW_AT_high_pc);
5278 return a ? AT_lbl (a) : NULL;
5281 /* Return the value of the string attribute designated by ATTR_KIND, or
5282 NULL if it is not present. */
5284 static inline const char *
5285 get_AT_string (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)
5287 dw_attr_ref a = get_AT (die, attr_kind);
5289 return a ? AT_string (a) : NULL;
5292 /* Return the value of the flag attribute designated by ATTR_KIND, or -1
5293 if it is not present. */
5295 static inline int
5296 get_AT_flag (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)
5298 dw_attr_ref a = get_AT (die, attr_kind);
5300 return a ? AT_flag (a) : 0;
5303 /* Return the value of the unsigned attribute designated by ATTR_KIND, or 0
5304 if it is not present. */
5306 static inline unsigned
5307 get_AT_unsigned (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)
5309 dw_attr_ref a = get_AT (die, attr_kind);
5311 return a ? AT_unsigned (a) : 0;
5314 static inline dw_die_ref
5315 get_AT_ref (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)
5317 dw_attr_ref a = get_AT (die, attr_kind);
5319 return a ? AT_ref (a) : NULL;
5322 /* Return TRUE if the language is C or C++. */
5324 static inline bool
5325 is_c_family (void)
5327 unsigned int lang = get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_language);
5329 return (lang == DW_LANG_C || lang == DW_LANG_C89
5330 || lang == DW_LANG_C_plus_plus);
5333 /* Return TRUE if the language is C++. */
5335 static inline bool
5336 is_cxx (void)
5338 return (get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_language)
5339 == DW_LANG_C_plus_plus);
5342 /* Return TRUE if the language is Fortran. */
5344 static inline bool
5345 is_fortran (void)
5347 unsigned int lang = get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_language);
5349 return (lang == DW_LANG_Fortran77
5350 || lang == DW_LANG_Fortran90
5351 || lang == DW_LANG_Fortran95);
5354 /* Return TRUE if the language is Java. */
5356 static inline bool
5357 is_java (void)
5359 unsigned int lang = get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_language);
5361 return lang == DW_LANG_Java;
5364 /* Return TRUE if the language is Ada. */
5366 static inline bool
5367 is_ada (void)
5369 unsigned int lang = get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_language);
5371 return lang == DW_LANG_Ada95 || lang == DW_LANG_Ada83;
5374 /* Free up the memory used by A. */
5376 static inline void free_AT (dw_attr_ref);
5377 static inline void
5378 free_AT (dw_attr_ref a)
5380 if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_str)
5381 if (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->refcount)
5382 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->refcount--;
5385 /* Remove the specified attribute if present. */
5387 static void
5388 remove_AT (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)
5390 dw_attr_ref *p;
5391 dw_attr_ref removed = NULL;
5393 if (die != NULL)
5395 for (p = &(die->die_attr); *p; p = &((*p)->dw_attr_next))
5396 if ((*p)->dw_attr == attr_kind)
5398 removed = *p;
5399 *p = (*p)->dw_attr_next;
5400 break;
5403 if (removed != 0)
5404 free_AT (removed);
5408 /* Remove child die whose die_tag is specified tag. */
5410 static void
5411 remove_child_TAG (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_tag tag)
5413 dw_die_ref current, prev, next;
5414 current = die->die_child;
5415 prev = NULL;
5416 while (current != NULL)
5418 if (current->die_tag == tag)
5420 next = current->die_sib;
5421 if (prev == NULL)
5422 die->die_child = next;
5423 else
5424 prev->die_sib = next;
5425 free_die (current);
5426 current = next;
5428 else
5430 prev = current;
5431 current = current->die_sib;
5436 /* Free up the memory used by DIE. */
5438 static inline void
5439 free_die (dw_die_ref die)
5441 remove_children (die);
5444 /* Discard the children of this DIE. */
5446 static void
5447 remove_children (dw_die_ref die)
5449 dw_die_ref child_die = die->die_child;
5451 die->die_child = NULL;
5453 while (child_die != NULL)
5455 dw_die_ref tmp_die = child_die;
5456 dw_attr_ref a;
5458 child_die = child_die->die_sib;
5460 for (a = tmp_die->die_attr; a != NULL;)
5462 dw_attr_ref tmp_a = a;
5464 a = a->dw_attr_next;
5465 free_AT (tmp_a);
5468 free_die (tmp_die);
5472 /* Add a child DIE below its parent. We build the lists up in reverse
5473 addition order, and correct that in reverse_all_dies. */
5475 static inline void
5476 add_child_die (dw_die_ref die, dw_die_ref child_die)
5478 if (die != NULL && child_die != NULL)
5480 gcc_assert (die != child_die);
5482 child_die->die_parent = die;
5483 child_die->die_sib = die->die_child;
5484 die->die_child = child_die;
5488 /* Move CHILD, which must be a child of PARENT or the DIE for which PARENT
5489 is the specification, to the front of PARENT's list of children. */
5491 static void
5492 splice_child_die (dw_die_ref parent, dw_die_ref child)
5494 dw_die_ref *p;
5496 /* We want the declaration DIE from inside the class, not the
5497 specification DIE at toplevel. */
5498 if (child->die_parent != parent)
5500 dw_die_ref tmp = get_AT_ref (child, DW_AT_specification);
5502 if (tmp)
5503 child = tmp;
5506 gcc_assert (child->die_parent == parent
5507 || (child->die_parent
5508 == get_AT_ref (parent, DW_AT_specification)));
5510 for (p = &(child->die_parent->die_child); *p; p = &((*p)->die_sib))
5511 if (*p == child)
5513 *p = child->die_sib;
5514 break;
5517 child->die_parent = parent;
5518 child->die_sib = parent->die_child;
5519 parent->die_child = child;
5522 /* Return a pointer to a newly created DIE node. */
5524 static inline dw_die_ref
5525 new_die (enum dwarf_tag tag_value, dw_die_ref parent_die, tree t)
5527 dw_die_ref die = ggc_alloc_cleared (sizeof (die_node));
5529 die->die_tag = tag_value;
5531 if (parent_die != NULL)
5532 add_child_die (parent_die, die);
5533 else
5535 limbo_die_node *limbo_node;
5537 limbo_node = ggc_alloc_cleared (sizeof (limbo_die_node));
5538 limbo_node->die = die;
5539 limbo_node->created_for = t;
5540 limbo_node->next = limbo_die_list;
5541 limbo_die_list = limbo_node;
5544 return die;
5547 /* Return the DIE associated with the given type specifier. */
5549 static inline dw_die_ref
5550 lookup_type_die (tree type)
5552 return TYPE_SYMTAB_DIE (type);
5555 /* Equate a DIE to a given type specifier. */
5557 static inline void
5558 equate_type_number_to_die (tree type, dw_die_ref type_die)
5560 TYPE_SYMTAB_DIE (type) = type_die;
5563 /* Returns a hash value for X (which really is a die_struct). */
5565 static hashval_t
5566 decl_die_table_hash (const void *x)
5568 return (hashval_t) ((const dw_die_ref) x)->decl_id;
5571 /* Return nonzero if decl_id of die_struct X is the same as UID of decl *Y. */
5573 static int
5574 decl_die_table_eq (const void *x, const void *y)
5576 return (((const dw_die_ref) x)->decl_id == DECL_UID ((const tree) y));
5579 /* Return the DIE associated with a given declaration. */
5581 static inline dw_die_ref
5582 lookup_decl_die (tree decl)
5584 return htab_find_with_hash (decl_die_table, decl, DECL_UID (decl));
5587 /* Returns a hash value for X (which really is a var_loc_list). */
5589 static hashval_t
5590 decl_loc_table_hash (const void *x)
5592 return (hashval_t) ((const var_loc_list *) x)->decl_id;
5595 /* Return nonzero if decl_id of var_loc_list X is the same as
5596 UID of decl *Y. */
5598 static int
5599 decl_loc_table_eq (const void *x, const void *y)
5601 return (((const var_loc_list *) x)->decl_id == DECL_UID ((const tree) y));
5604 /* Return the var_loc list associated with a given declaration. */
5606 static inline var_loc_list *
5607 lookup_decl_loc (tree decl)
5609 return htab_find_with_hash (decl_loc_table, decl, DECL_UID (decl));
5612 /* Equate a DIE to a particular declaration. */
5614 static void
5615 equate_decl_number_to_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref decl_die)
5617 unsigned int decl_id = DECL_UID (decl);
5618 void **slot;
5620 slot = htab_find_slot_with_hash (decl_die_table, decl, decl_id, INSERT);
5621 *slot = decl_die;
5622 decl_die->decl_id = decl_id;
5625 /* Add a variable location node to the linked list for DECL. */
5627 static void
5628 add_var_loc_to_decl (tree decl, struct var_loc_node *loc)
5630 unsigned int decl_id = DECL_UID (decl);
5631 var_loc_list *temp;
5632 void **slot;
5634 slot = htab_find_slot_with_hash (decl_loc_table, decl, decl_id, INSERT);
5635 if (*slot == NULL)
5637 temp = ggc_alloc_cleared (sizeof (var_loc_list));
5638 temp->decl_id = decl_id;
5639 *slot = temp;
5641 else
5642 temp = *slot;
5644 if (temp->last)
5646 /* If the current location is the same as the end of the list,
5647 we have nothing to do. */
5648 if (!rtx_equal_p (NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (temp->last->var_loc_note),
5649 NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (loc->var_loc_note)))
5651 /* Add LOC to the end of list and update LAST. */
5652 temp->last->next = loc;
5653 temp->last = loc;
5656 /* Do not add empty location to the beginning of the list. */
5657 else if (NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (loc->var_loc_note) != NULL_RTX)
5659 temp->first = loc;
5660 temp->last = loc;
5664 /* Keep track of the number of spaces used to indent the
5665 output of the debugging routines that print the structure of
5666 the DIE internal representation. */
5667 static int print_indent;
5669 /* Indent the line the number of spaces given by print_indent. */
5671 static inline void
5672 print_spaces (FILE *outfile)
5674 fprintf (outfile, "%*s", print_indent, "");
5677 /* Print the information associated with a given DIE, and its children.
5678 This routine is a debugging aid only. */
5680 static void
5681 print_die (dw_die_ref die, FILE *outfile)
5683 dw_attr_ref a;
5684 dw_die_ref c;
5686 print_spaces (outfile);
5687 fprintf (outfile, "DIE %4lu: %s\n",
5688 die->die_offset, dwarf_tag_name (die->die_tag));
5689 print_spaces (outfile);
5690 fprintf (outfile, " abbrev id: %lu", die->die_abbrev);
5691 fprintf (outfile, " offset: %lu\n", die->die_offset);
5693 for (a = die->die_attr; a != NULL; a = a->dw_attr_next)
5695 print_spaces (outfile);
5696 fprintf (outfile, " %s: ", dwarf_attr_name (a->dw_attr));
5698 switch (AT_class (a))
5700 case dw_val_class_addr:
5701 fprintf (outfile, "address");
5702 break;
5703 case dw_val_class_offset:
5704 fprintf (outfile, "offset");
5705 break;
5706 case dw_val_class_loc:
5707 fprintf (outfile, "location descriptor");
5708 break;
5709 case dw_val_class_loc_list:
5710 fprintf (outfile, "location list -> label:%s",
5711 AT_loc_list (a)->ll_symbol);
5712 break;
5713 case dw_val_class_range_list:
5714 fprintf (outfile, "range list");
5715 break;
5716 case dw_val_class_const:
5717 fprintf (outfile, HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_DEC, AT_int (a));
5718 break;
5719 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
5720 fprintf (outfile, HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_UNSIGNED, AT_unsigned (a));
5721 break;
5722 case dw_val_class_long_long:
5723 fprintf (outfile, "constant (%lu,%lu)",
5724 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_long_long.hi,
5725 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_long_long.low);
5726 break;
5727 case dw_val_class_vec:
5728 fprintf (outfile, "floating-point or vector constant");
5729 break;
5730 case dw_val_class_flag:
5731 fprintf (outfile, "%u", AT_flag (a));
5732 break;
5733 case dw_val_class_die_ref:
5734 if (AT_ref (a) != NULL)
5736 if (AT_ref (a)->die_symbol)
5737 fprintf (outfile, "die -> label: %s", AT_ref (a)->die_symbol);
5738 else
5739 fprintf (outfile, "die -> %lu", AT_ref (a)->die_offset);
5741 else
5742 fprintf (outfile, "die -> <null>");
5743 break;
5744 case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
5745 case dw_val_class_lineptr:
5746 case dw_val_class_macptr:
5747 fprintf (outfile, "label: %s", AT_lbl (a));
5748 break;
5749 case dw_val_class_str:
5750 if (AT_string (a) != NULL)
5751 fprintf (outfile, "\"%s\"", AT_string (a));
5752 else
5753 fprintf (outfile, "<null>");
5754 break;
5755 default:
5756 break;
5759 fprintf (outfile, "\n");
5762 if (die->die_child != NULL)
5764 print_indent += 4;
5765 for (c = die->die_child; c != NULL; c = c->die_sib)
5766 print_die (c, outfile);
5768 print_indent -= 4;
5770 if (print_indent == 0)
5771 fprintf (outfile, "\n");
5774 /* Print the contents of the source code line number correspondence table.
5775 This routine is a debugging aid only. */
5777 static void
5778 print_dwarf_line_table (FILE *outfile)
5780 unsigned i;
5781 dw_line_info_ref line_info;
5783 fprintf (outfile, "\n\nDWARF source line information\n");
5784 for (i = 1; i < line_info_table_in_use; i++)
5786 line_info = &line_info_table[i];
5787 fprintf (outfile, "%5d: ", i);
5788 fprintf (outfile, "%-20s",
5789 VARRAY_CHAR_PTR (file_table, line_info->dw_file_num));
5790 fprintf (outfile, "%6ld", line_info->dw_line_num);
5791 fprintf (outfile, "\n");
5794 fprintf (outfile, "\n\n");
5797 /* Print the information collected for a given DIE. */
5799 void
5800 debug_dwarf_die (dw_die_ref die)
5802 print_die (die, stderr);
5805 /* Print all DWARF information collected for the compilation unit.
5806 This routine is a debugging aid only. */
5808 void
5809 debug_dwarf (void)
5811 print_indent = 0;
5812 print_die (comp_unit_die, stderr);
5813 if (! DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO)
5814 print_dwarf_line_table (stderr);
5817 /* We build up the lists of children and attributes by pushing new ones
5818 onto the beginning of the list. Reverse the lists for DIE so that
5819 they are in order of addition. */
5821 static void
5822 reverse_die_lists (dw_die_ref die)
5824 dw_die_ref c, cp, cn;
5825 dw_attr_ref a, ap, an;
5827 for (a = die->die_attr, ap = 0; a; a = an)
5829 an = a->dw_attr_next;
5830 a->dw_attr_next = ap;
5831 ap = a;
5834 die->die_attr = ap;
5836 for (c = die->die_child, cp = 0; c; c = cn)
5838 cn = c->die_sib;
5839 c->die_sib = cp;
5840 cp = c;
5843 die->die_child = cp;
5846 /* reverse_die_lists only reverses the single die you pass it. Since we used to
5847 reverse all dies in add_sibling_attributes, which runs through all the dies,
5848 it would reverse all the dies. Now, however, since we don't call
5849 reverse_die_lists in add_sibling_attributes, we need a routine to
5850 recursively reverse all the dies. This is that routine. */
5852 static void
5853 reverse_all_dies (dw_die_ref die)
5855 dw_die_ref c;
5857 reverse_die_lists (die);
5859 for (c = die->die_child; c; c = c->die_sib)
5860 reverse_all_dies (c);
5863 /* Start a new compilation unit DIE for an include file. OLD_UNIT is the CU
5864 for the enclosing include file, if any. BINCL_DIE is the DW_TAG_GNU_BINCL
5865 DIE that marks the start of the DIEs for this include file. */
5867 static dw_die_ref
5868 push_new_compile_unit (dw_die_ref old_unit, dw_die_ref bincl_die)
5870 const char *filename = get_AT_string (bincl_die, DW_AT_name);
5871 dw_die_ref new_unit = gen_compile_unit_die (filename);
5873 new_unit->die_sib = old_unit;
5874 return new_unit;
5877 /* Close an include-file CU and reopen the enclosing one. */
5879 static dw_die_ref
5880 pop_compile_unit (dw_die_ref old_unit)
5882 dw_die_ref new_unit = old_unit->die_sib;
5884 old_unit->die_sib = NULL;
5885 return new_unit;
5888 #define CHECKSUM(FOO) md5_process_bytes (&(FOO), sizeof (FOO), ctx)
5889 #define CHECKSUM_STRING(FOO) md5_process_bytes ((FOO), strlen (FOO), ctx)
5891 /* Calculate the checksum of a location expression. */
5893 static inline void
5894 loc_checksum (dw_loc_descr_ref loc, struct md5_ctx *ctx)
5896 CHECKSUM (loc->dw_loc_opc);
5897 CHECKSUM (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1);
5898 CHECKSUM (loc->dw_loc_oprnd2);
5901 /* Calculate the checksum of an attribute. */
5903 static void
5904 attr_checksum (dw_attr_ref at, struct md5_ctx *ctx, int *mark)
5906 dw_loc_descr_ref loc;
5907 rtx r;
5909 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr);
5911 /* We don't care about differences in file numbering. */
5912 if (at->dw_attr == DW_AT_decl_file
5913 /* Or that this was compiled with a different compiler snapshot; if
5914 the output is the same, that's what matters. */
5915 || at->dw_attr == DW_AT_producer)
5916 return;
5918 switch (AT_class (at))
5920 case dw_val_class_const:
5921 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_int);
5922 break;
5923 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
5924 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_unsigned);
5925 break;
5926 case dw_val_class_long_long:
5927 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_long_long);
5928 break;
5929 case dw_val_class_vec:
5930 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec);
5931 break;
5932 case dw_val_class_flag:
5933 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_flag);
5934 break;
5935 case dw_val_class_str:
5936 CHECKSUM_STRING (AT_string (at));
5937 break;
5939 case dw_val_class_addr:
5940 r = AT_addr (at);
5941 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (r) == SYMBOL_REF);
5942 CHECKSUM_STRING (XSTR (r, 0));
5943 break;
5945 case dw_val_class_offset:
5946 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_offset);
5947 break;
5949 case dw_val_class_loc:
5950 for (loc = AT_loc (at); loc; loc = loc->dw_loc_next)
5951 loc_checksum (loc, ctx);
5952 break;
5954 case dw_val_class_die_ref:
5955 die_checksum (AT_ref (at), ctx, mark);
5956 break;
5958 case dw_val_class_fde_ref:
5959 case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
5960 case dw_val_class_lineptr:
5961 case dw_val_class_macptr:
5962 break;
5964 default:
5965 break;
5969 /* Calculate the checksum of a DIE. */
5971 static void
5972 die_checksum (dw_die_ref die, struct md5_ctx *ctx, int *mark)
5974 dw_die_ref c;
5975 dw_attr_ref a;
5977 /* To avoid infinite recursion. */
5978 if (die->die_mark)
5980 CHECKSUM (die->die_mark);
5981 return;
5983 die->die_mark = ++(*mark);
5985 CHECKSUM (die->die_tag);
5987 for (a = die->die_attr; a; a = a->dw_attr_next)
5988 attr_checksum (a, ctx, mark);
5990 for (c = die->die_child; c; c = c->die_sib)
5991 die_checksum (c, ctx, mark);
5994 #undef CHECKSUM
5995 #undef CHECKSUM_STRING
5997 /* Do the location expressions look same? */
5998 static inline int
5999 same_loc_p (dw_loc_descr_ref loc1, dw_loc_descr_ref loc2, int *mark)
6001 return loc1->dw_loc_opc == loc2->dw_loc_opc
6002 && same_dw_val_p (&loc1->dw_loc_oprnd1, &loc2->dw_loc_oprnd1, mark)
6003 && same_dw_val_p (&loc1->dw_loc_oprnd2, &loc2->dw_loc_oprnd2, mark);
6006 /* Do the values look the same? */
6007 static int
6008 same_dw_val_p (dw_val_node *v1, dw_val_node *v2, int *mark)
6010 dw_loc_descr_ref loc1, loc2;
6011 rtx r1, r2;
6013 if (v1->val_class != v2->val_class)
6014 return 0;
6016 switch (v1->val_class)
6018 case dw_val_class_const:
6019 return v1->v.val_int == v2->v.val_int;
6020 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
6021 return v1->v.val_unsigned == v2->v.val_unsigned;
6022 case dw_val_class_long_long:
6023 return v1->v.val_long_long.hi == v2->v.val_long_long.hi
6024 && v1->v.val_long_long.low == v2->v.val_long_long.low;
6025 case dw_val_class_vec:
6026 if (v1->v.val_vec.length != v2->v.val_vec.length
6027 || v1->v.val_vec.elt_size != v2->v.val_vec.elt_size)
6028 return 0;
6029 if (memcmp (v1->v.val_vec.array, v2->v.val_vec.array,
6030 v1->v.val_vec.length * v1->v.val_vec.elt_size))
6031 return 0;
6032 return 1;
6033 case dw_val_class_flag:
6034 return v1->v.val_flag == v2->v.val_flag;
6035 case dw_val_class_str:
6036 return !strcmp(v1->v.val_str->str, v2->v.val_str->str);
6038 case dw_val_class_addr:
6039 r1 = v1->v.val_addr;
6040 r2 = v2->v.val_addr;
6041 if (GET_CODE (r1) != GET_CODE (r2))
6042 return 0;
6043 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (r1) == SYMBOL_REF);
6044 return !strcmp (XSTR (r1, 0), XSTR (r2, 0));
6046 case dw_val_class_offset:
6047 return v1->v.val_offset == v2->v.val_offset;
6049 case dw_val_class_loc:
6050 for (loc1 = v1->v.val_loc, loc2 = v2->v.val_loc;
6051 loc1 && loc2;
6052 loc1 = loc1->dw_loc_next, loc2 = loc2->dw_loc_next)
6053 if (!same_loc_p (loc1, loc2, mark))
6054 return 0;
6055 return !loc1 && !loc2;
6057 case dw_val_class_die_ref:
6058 return same_die_p (v1->v.val_die_ref.die, v2->v.val_die_ref.die, mark);
6060 case dw_val_class_fde_ref:
6061 case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
6062 case dw_val_class_lineptr:
6063 case dw_val_class_macptr:
6064 return 1;
6066 default:
6067 return 1;
6071 /* Do the attributes look the same? */
6073 static int
6074 same_attr_p (dw_attr_ref at1, dw_attr_ref at2, int *mark)
6076 if (at1->dw_attr != at2->dw_attr)
6077 return 0;
6079 /* We don't care about differences in file numbering. */
6080 if (at1->dw_attr == DW_AT_decl_file
6081 /* Or that this was compiled with a different compiler snapshot; if
6082 the output is the same, that's what matters. */
6083 || at1->dw_attr == DW_AT_producer)
6084 return 1;
6086 return same_dw_val_p (&at1->dw_attr_val, &at2->dw_attr_val, mark);
6089 /* Do the dies look the same? */
6091 static int
6092 same_die_p (dw_die_ref die1, dw_die_ref die2, int *mark)
6094 dw_die_ref c1, c2;
6095 dw_attr_ref a1, a2;
6097 /* To avoid infinite recursion. */
6098 if (die1->die_mark)
6099 return die1->die_mark == die2->die_mark;
6100 die1->die_mark = die2->die_mark = ++(*mark);
6102 if (die1->die_tag != die2->die_tag)
6103 return 0;
6105 for (a1 = die1->die_attr, a2 = die2->die_attr;
6106 a1 && a2;
6107 a1 = a1->dw_attr_next, a2 = a2->dw_attr_next)
6108 if (!same_attr_p (a1, a2, mark))
6109 return 0;
6110 if (a1 || a2)
6111 return 0;
6113 for (c1 = die1->die_child, c2 = die2->die_child;
6114 c1 && c2;
6115 c1 = c1->die_sib, c2 = c2->die_sib)
6116 if (!same_die_p (c1, c2, mark))
6117 return 0;
6118 if (c1 || c2)
6119 return 0;
6121 return 1;
6124 /* Do the dies look the same? Wrapper around same_die_p. */
6126 static int
6127 same_die_p_wrap (dw_die_ref die1, dw_die_ref die2)
6129 int mark = 0;
6130 int ret = same_die_p (die1, die2, &mark);
6132 unmark_all_dies (die1);
6133 unmark_all_dies (die2);
6135 return ret;
6138 /* The prefix to attach to symbols on DIEs in the current comdat debug
6139 info section. */
6140 static char *comdat_symbol_id;
6142 /* The index of the current symbol within the current comdat CU. */
6143 static unsigned int comdat_symbol_number;
6145 /* Calculate the MD5 checksum of the compilation unit DIE UNIT_DIE and its
6146 children, and set comdat_symbol_id accordingly. */
6148 static void
6149 compute_section_prefix (dw_die_ref unit_die)
6151 const char *die_name = get_AT_string (unit_die, DW_AT_name);
6152 const char *base = die_name ? lbasename (die_name) : "anonymous";
6153 char *name = alloca (strlen (base) + 64);
6154 char *p;
6155 int i, mark;
6156 unsigned char checksum[16];
6157 struct md5_ctx ctx;
6159 /* Compute the checksum of the DIE, then append part of it as hex digits to
6160 the name filename of the unit. */
6162 md5_init_ctx (&ctx);
6163 mark = 0;
6164 die_checksum (unit_die, &ctx, &mark);
6165 unmark_all_dies (unit_die);
6166 md5_finish_ctx (&ctx, checksum);
6168 sprintf (name, "%s.", base);
6169 clean_symbol_name (name);
6171 p = name + strlen (name);
6172 for (i = 0; i < 4; i++)
6174 sprintf (p, "%.2x", checksum[i]);
6175 p += 2;
6178 comdat_symbol_id = unit_die->die_symbol = xstrdup (name);
6179 comdat_symbol_number = 0;
6182 /* Returns nonzero if DIE represents a type, in the sense of TYPE_P. */
6184 static int
6185 is_type_die (dw_die_ref die)
6187 switch (die->die_tag)
6189 case DW_TAG_array_type:
6190 case DW_TAG_class_type:
6191 case DW_TAG_enumeration_type:
6192 case DW_TAG_pointer_type:
6193 case DW_TAG_reference_type:
6194 case DW_TAG_string_type:
6195 case DW_TAG_structure_type:
6196 case DW_TAG_subroutine_type:
6197 case DW_TAG_union_type:
6198 case DW_TAG_ptr_to_member_type:
6199 case DW_TAG_set_type:
6200 case DW_TAG_subrange_type:
6201 case DW_TAG_base_type:
6202 case DW_TAG_const_type:
6203 case DW_TAG_file_type:
6204 case DW_TAG_packed_type:
6205 case DW_TAG_volatile_type:
6206 case DW_TAG_typedef:
6207 return 1;
6208 default:
6209 return 0;
6213 /* Returns 1 iff C is the sort of DIE that should go into a COMDAT CU.
6214 Basically, we want to choose the bits that are likely to be shared between
6215 compilations (types) and leave out the bits that are specific to individual
6216 compilations (functions). */
6218 static int
6219 is_comdat_die (dw_die_ref c)
6221 /* I think we want to leave base types and __vtbl_ptr_type in the main CU, as
6222 we do for stabs. The advantage is a greater likelihood of sharing between
6223 objects that don't include headers in the same order (and therefore would
6224 put the base types in a different comdat). jason 8/28/00 */
6226 if (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_base_type)
6227 return 0;
6229 if (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_pointer_type
6230 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_reference_type
6231 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_const_type
6232 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_volatile_type)
6234 dw_die_ref t = get_AT_ref (c, DW_AT_type);
6236 return t ? is_comdat_die (t) : 0;
6239 return is_type_die (c);
6242 /* Returns 1 iff C is the sort of DIE that might be referred to from another
6243 compilation unit. */
6245 static int
6246 is_symbol_die (dw_die_ref c)
6248 return (is_type_die (c)
6249 || (get_AT (c, DW_AT_declaration)
6250 && !get_AT (c, DW_AT_specification)));
6253 static char *
6254 gen_internal_sym (const char *prefix)
6256 char buf[256];
6258 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (buf, prefix, label_num++);
6259 return xstrdup (buf);
6262 /* Assign symbols to all worthy DIEs under DIE. */
6264 static void
6265 assign_symbol_names (dw_die_ref die)
6267 dw_die_ref c;
6269 if (is_symbol_die (die))
6271 if (comdat_symbol_id)
6273 char *p = alloca (strlen (comdat_symbol_id) + 64);
6275 sprintf (p, "%s.%s.%x", DIE_LABEL_PREFIX,
6276 comdat_symbol_id, comdat_symbol_number++);
6277 die->die_symbol = xstrdup (p);
6279 else
6280 die->die_symbol = gen_internal_sym ("LDIE");
6283 for (c = die->die_child; c != NULL; c = c->die_sib)
6284 assign_symbol_names (c);
6287 struct cu_hash_table_entry
6289 dw_die_ref cu;
6290 unsigned min_comdat_num, max_comdat_num;
6291 struct cu_hash_table_entry *next;
6294 /* Routines to manipulate hash table of CUs. */
6295 static hashval_t
6296 htab_cu_hash (const void *of)
6298 const struct cu_hash_table_entry *entry = of;
6300 return htab_hash_string (entry->cu->die_symbol);
6303 static int
6304 htab_cu_eq (const void *of1, const void *of2)
6306 const struct cu_hash_table_entry *entry1 = of1;
6307 const struct die_struct *entry2 = of2;
6309 return !strcmp (entry1->cu->die_symbol, entry2->die_symbol);
6312 static void
6313 htab_cu_del (void *what)
6315 struct cu_hash_table_entry *next, *entry = what;
6317 while (entry)
6319 next = entry->next;
6320 free (entry);
6321 entry = next;
6325 /* Check whether we have already seen this CU and set up SYM_NUM
6326 accordingly. */
6327 static int
6328 check_duplicate_cu (dw_die_ref cu, htab_t htable, unsigned int *sym_num)
6330 struct cu_hash_table_entry dummy;
6331 struct cu_hash_table_entry **slot, *entry, *last = &dummy;
6333 dummy.max_comdat_num = 0;
6335 slot = (struct cu_hash_table_entry **)
6336 htab_find_slot_with_hash (htable, cu, htab_hash_string (cu->die_symbol),
6337 INSERT);
6338 entry = *slot;
6340 for (; entry; last = entry, entry = entry->next)
6342 if (same_die_p_wrap (cu, entry->cu))
6343 break;
6346 if (entry)
6348 *sym_num = entry->min_comdat_num;
6349 return 1;
6352 entry = XCNEW (struct cu_hash_table_entry);
6353 entry->cu = cu;
6354 entry->min_comdat_num = *sym_num = last->max_comdat_num;
6355 entry->next = *slot;
6356 *slot = entry;
6358 return 0;
6361 /* Record SYM_NUM to record of CU in HTABLE. */
6362 static void
6363 record_comdat_symbol_number (dw_die_ref cu, htab_t htable, unsigned int sym_num)
6365 struct cu_hash_table_entry **slot, *entry;
6367 slot = (struct cu_hash_table_entry **)
6368 htab_find_slot_with_hash (htable, cu, htab_hash_string (cu->die_symbol),
6369 NO_INSERT);
6370 entry = *slot;
6372 entry->max_comdat_num = sym_num;
6375 /* Traverse the DIE (which is always comp_unit_die), and set up
6376 additional compilation units for each of the include files we see
6377 bracketed by BINCL/EINCL. */
6379 static void
6380 break_out_includes (dw_die_ref die)
6382 dw_die_ref *ptr;
6383 dw_die_ref unit = NULL;
6384 limbo_die_node *node, **pnode;
6385 htab_t cu_hash_table;
6387 for (ptr = &(die->die_child); *ptr;)
6389 dw_die_ref c = *ptr;
6391 if (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_GNU_BINCL || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_GNU_EINCL
6392 || (unit && is_comdat_die (c)))
6394 /* This DIE is for a secondary CU; remove it from the main one. */
6395 *ptr = c->die_sib;
6397 if (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_GNU_BINCL)
6399 unit = push_new_compile_unit (unit, c);
6400 free_die (c);
6402 else if (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_GNU_EINCL)
6404 unit = pop_compile_unit (unit);
6405 free_die (c);
6407 else
6408 add_child_die (unit, c);
6410 else
6412 /* Leave this DIE in the main CU. */
6413 ptr = &(c->die_sib);
6414 continue;
6418 #if 0
6419 /* We can only use this in debugging, since the frontend doesn't check
6420 to make sure that we leave every include file we enter. */
6421 gcc_assert (!unit);
6422 #endif
6424 assign_symbol_names (die);
6425 cu_hash_table = htab_create (10, htab_cu_hash, htab_cu_eq, htab_cu_del);
6426 for (node = limbo_die_list, pnode = &limbo_die_list;
6427 node;
6428 node = node->next)
6430 int is_dupl;
6432 compute_section_prefix (node->die);
6433 is_dupl = check_duplicate_cu (node->die, cu_hash_table,
6434 &comdat_symbol_number);
6435 assign_symbol_names (node->die);
6436 if (is_dupl)
6437 *pnode = node->next;
6438 else
6440 pnode = &node->next;
6441 record_comdat_symbol_number (node->die, cu_hash_table,
6442 comdat_symbol_number);
6445 htab_delete (cu_hash_table);
6448 /* Traverse the DIE and add a sibling attribute if it may have the
6449 effect of speeding up access to siblings. To save some space,
6450 avoid generating sibling attributes for DIE's without children. */
6452 static void
6453 add_sibling_attributes (dw_die_ref die)
6455 dw_die_ref c;
6457 if (die->die_tag != DW_TAG_compile_unit
6458 && die->die_sib && die->die_child != NULL)
6459 /* Add the sibling link to the front of the attribute list. */
6460 add_AT_die_ref (die, DW_AT_sibling, die->die_sib);
6462 for (c = die->die_child; c != NULL; c = c->die_sib)
6463 add_sibling_attributes (c);
6466 /* Output all location lists for the DIE and its children. */
6468 static void
6469 output_location_lists (dw_die_ref die)
6471 dw_die_ref c;
6472 dw_attr_ref d_attr;
6474 for (d_attr = die->die_attr; d_attr; d_attr = d_attr->dw_attr_next)
6475 if (AT_class (d_attr) == dw_val_class_loc_list)
6476 output_loc_list (AT_loc_list (d_attr));
6478 for (c = die->die_child; c != NULL; c = c->die_sib)
6479 output_location_lists (c);
6483 /* The format of each DIE (and its attribute value pairs) is encoded in an
6484 abbreviation table. This routine builds the abbreviation table and assigns
6485 a unique abbreviation id for each abbreviation entry. The children of each
6486 die are visited recursively. */
6488 static void
6489 build_abbrev_table (dw_die_ref die)
6491 unsigned long abbrev_id;
6492 unsigned int n_alloc;
6493 dw_die_ref c;
6494 dw_attr_ref d_attr, a_attr;
6496 /* Scan the DIE references, and mark as external any that refer to
6497 DIEs from other CUs (i.e. those which are not marked). */
6498 for (d_attr = die->die_attr; d_attr; d_attr = d_attr->dw_attr_next)
6499 if (AT_class (d_attr) == dw_val_class_die_ref
6500 && AT_ref (d_attr)->die_mark == 0)
6502 gcc_assert (AT_ref (d_attr)->die_symbol);
6504 set_AT_ref_external (d_attr, 1);
6507 for (abbrev_id = 1; abbrev_id < abbrev_die_table_in_use; ++abbrev_id)
6509 dw_die_ref abbrev = abbrev_die_table[abbrev_id];
6511 if (abbrev->die_tag == die->die_tag)
6513 if ((abbrev->die_child != NULL) == (die->die_child != NULL))
6515 a_attr = abbrev->die_attr;
6516 d_attr = die->die_attr;
6518 while (a_attr != NULL && d_attr != NULL)
6520 if ((a_attr->dw_attr != d_attr->dw_attr)
6521 || (value_format (a_attr) != value_format (d_attr)))
6522 break;
6524 a_attr = a_attr->dw_attr_next;
6525 d_attr = d_attr->dw_attr_next;
6528 if (a_attr == NULL && d_attr == NULL)
6529 break;
6534 if (abbrev_id >= abbrev_die_table_in_use)
6536 if (abbrev_die_table_in_use >= abbrev_die_table_allocated)
6538 n_alloc = abbrev_die_table_allocated + ABBREV_DIE_TABLE_INCREMENT;
6539 abbrev_die_table = ggc_realloc (abbrev_die_table,
6540 sizeof (dw_die_ref) * n_alloc);
6542 memset (&abbrev_die_table[abbrev_die_table_allocated], 0,
6543 (n_alloc - abbrev_die_table_allocated) * sizeof (dw_die_ref));
6544 abbrev_die_table_allocated = n_alloc;
6547 ++abbrev_die_table_in_use;
6548 abbrev_die_table[abbrev_id] = die;
6551 die->die_abbrev = abbrev_id;
6552 for (c = die->die_child; c != NULL; c = c->die_sib)
6553 build_abbrev_table (c);
6556 /* Return the power-of-two number of bytes necessary to represent VALUE. */
6558 static int
6559 constant_size (long unsigned int value)
6561 int log;
6563 if (value == 0)
6564 log = 0;
6565 else
6566 log = floor_log2 (value);
6568 log = log / 8;
6569 log = 1 << (floor_log2 (log) + 1);
6571 return log;
6574 /* Return the size of a DIE as it is represented in the
6575 .debug_info section. */
6577 static unsigned long
6578 size_of_die (dw_die_ref die)
6580 unsigned long size = 0;
6581 dw_attr_ref a;
6583 size += size_of_uleb128 (die->die_abbrev);
6584 for (a = die->die_attr; a != NULL; a = a->dw_attr_next)
6586 switch (AT_class (a))
6588 case dw_val_class_addr:
6589 size += DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
6590 break;
6591 case dw_val_class_offset:
6592 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
6593 break;
6594 case dw_val_class_loc:
6596 unsigned long lsize = size_of_locs (AT_loc (a));
6598 /* Block length. */
6599 size += constant_size (lsize);
6600 size += lsize;
6602 break;
6603 case dw_val_class_loc_list:
6604 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
6605 break;
6606 case dw_val_class_range_list:
6607 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
6608 break;
6609 case dw_val_class_const:
6610 size += size_of_sleb128 (AT_int (a));
6611 break;
6612 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
6613 size += constant_size (AT_unsigned (a));
6614 break;
6615 case dw_val_class_long_long:
6616 size += 1 + 2*HOST_BITS_PER_LONG/HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR; /* block */
6617 break;
6618 case dw_val_class_vec:
6619 size += 1 + (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.length
6620 * a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.elt_size); /* block */
6621 break;
6622 case dw_val_class_flag:
6623 size += 1;
6624 break;
6625 case dw_val_class_die_ref:
6626 if (AT_ref_external (a))
6627 size += DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
6628 else
6629 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
6630 break;
6631 case dw_val_class_fde_ref:
6632 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
6633 break;
6634 case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
6635 size += DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
6636 break;
6637 case dw_val_class_lineptr:
6638 case dw_val_class_macptr:
6639 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
6640 break;
6641 case dw_val_class_str:
6642 if (AT_string_form (a) == DW_FORM_strp)
6643 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
6644 else
6645 size += strlen (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->str) + 1;
6646 break;
6647 default:
6648 gcc_unreachable ();
6652 return size;
6655 /* Size the debugging information associated with a given DIE. Visits the
6656 DIE's children recursively. Updates the global variable next_die_offset, on
6657 each time through. Uses the current value of next_die_offset to update the
6658 die_offset field in each DIE. */
6660 static void
6661 calc_die_sizes (dw_die_ref die)
6663 dw_die_ref c;
6665 die->die_offset = next_die_offset;
6666 next_die_offset += size_of_die (die);
6668 for (c = die->die_child; c != NULL; c = c->die_sib)
6669 calc_die_sizes (c);
6671 if (die->die_child != NULL)
6672 /* Count the null byte used to terminate sibling lists. */
6673 next_die_offset += 1;
6676 /* Set the marks for a die and its children. We do this so
6677 that we know whether or not a reference needs to use FORM_ref_addr; only
6678 DIEs in the same CU will be marked. We used to clear out the offset
6679 and use that as the flag, but ran into ordering problems. */
6681 static void
6682 mark_dies (dw_die_ref die)
6684 dw_die_ref c;
6686 gcc_assert (!die->die_mark);
6688 die->die_mark = 1;
6689 for (c = die->die_child; c; c = c->die_sib)
6690 mark_dies (c);
6693 /* Clear the marks for a die and its children. */
6695 static void
6696 unmark_dies (dw_die_ref die)
6698 dw_die_ref c;
6700 gcc_assert (die->die_mark);
6702 die->die_mark = 0;
6703 for (c = die->die_child; c; c = c->die_sib)
6704 unmark_dies (c);
6707 /* Clear the marks for a die, its children and referred dies. */
6709 static void
6710 unmark_all_dies (dw_die_ref die)
6712 dw_die_ref c;
6713 dw_attr_ref a;
6715 if (!die->die_mark)
6716 return;
6717 die->die_mark = 0;
6719 for (c = die->die_child; c; c = c->die_sib)
6720 unmark_all_dies (c);
6722 for (a = die->die_attr; a; a = a->dw_attr_next)
6723 if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_die_ref)
6724 unmark_all_dies (AT_ref (a));
6727 /* Return the size of the .debug_pubnames table generated for the
6728 compilation unit. */
6730 static unsigned long
6731 size_of_pubnames (void)
6733 unsigned long size;
6734 unsigned i;
6736 size = DWARF_PUBNAMES_HEADER_SIZE;
6737 for (i = 0; i < pubname_table_in_use; i++)
6739 pubname_ref p = &pubname_table[i];
6740 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + strlen (p->name) + 1;
6743 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
6744 return size;
6747 /* Return the size of the information in the .debug_aranges section. */
6749 static unsigned long
6750 size_of_aranges (void)
6752 unsigned long size;
6754 size = DWARF_ARANGES_HEADER_SIZE;
6756 /* Count the address/length pair for this compilation unit. */
6757 size += 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
6758 size += 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE * arange_table_in_use;
6760 /* Count the two zero words used to terminated the address range table. */
6761 size += 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
6762 return size;
6765 /* Select the encoding of an attribute value. */
6767 static enum dwarf_form
6768 value_format (dw_attr_ref a)
6770 switch (a->dw_attr_val.val_class)
6772 case dw_val_class_addr:
6773 return DW_FORM_addr;
6774 case dw_val_class_range_list:
6775 case dw_val_class_offset:
6776 switch (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE)
6778 case 4:
6779 return DW_FORM_data4;
6780 case 8:
6781 return DW_FORM_data8;
6782 default:
6783 gcc_unreachable ();
6785 case dw_val_class_loc_list:
6786 /* FIXME: Could be DW_FORM_data8, with a > 32 bit size
6787 .debug_loc section */
6788 return DW_FORM_data4;
6789 case dw_val_class_loc:
6790 switch (constant_size (size_of_locs (AT_loc (a))))
6792 case 1:
6793 return DW_FORM_block1;
6794 case 2:
6795 return DW_FORM_block2;
6796 default:
6797 gcc_unreachable ();
6799 case dw_val_class_const:
6800 return DW_FORM_sdata;
6801 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
6802 switch (constant_size (AT_unsigned (a)))
6804 case 1:
6805 return DW_FORM_data1;
6806 case 2:
6807 return DW_FORM_data2;
6808 case 4:
6809 return DW_FORM_data4;
6810 case 8:
6811 return DW_FORM_data8;
6812 default:
6813 gcc_unreachable ();
6815 case dw_val_class_long_long:
6816 return DW_FORM_block1;
6817 case dw_val_class_vec:
6818 return DW_FORM_block1;
6819 case dw_val_class_flag:
6820 return DW_FORM_flag;
6821 case dw_val_class_die_ref:
6822 if (AT_ref_external (a))
6823 return DW_FORM_ref_addr;
6824 else
6825 return DW_FORM_ref;
6826 case dw_val_class_fde_ref:
6827 return DW_FORM_data;
6828 case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
6829 return DW_FORM_addr;
6830 case dw_val_class_lineptr:
6831 case dw_val_class_macptr:
6832 return DW_FORM_data;
6833 case dw_val_class_str:
6834 return AT_string_form (a);
6836 default:
6837 gcc_unreachable ();
6841 /* Output the encoding of an attribute value. */
6843 static void
6844 output_value_format (dw_attr_ref a)
6846 enum dwarf_form form = value_format (a);
6848 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (form, "(%s)", dwarf_form_name (form));
6851 /* Output the .debug_abbrev section which defines the DIE abbreviation
6852 table. */
6854 static void
6855 output_abbrev_section (void)
6857 unsigned long abbrev_id;
6859 dw_attr_ref a_attr;
6861 for (abbrev_id = 1; abbrev_id < abbrev_die_table_in_use; ++abbrev_id)
6863 dw_die_ref abbrev = abbrev_die_table[abbrev_id];
6865 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (abbrev_id, "(abbrev code)");
6866 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (abbrev->die_tag, "(TAG: %s)",
6867 dwarf_tag_name (abbrev->die_tag));
6869 if (abbrev->die_child != NULL)
6870 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_children_yes, "DW_children_yes");
6871 else
6872 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_children_no, "DW_children_no");
6874 for (a_attr = abbrev->die_attr; a_attr != NULL;
6875 a_attr = a_attr->dw_attr_next)
6877 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (a_attr->dw_attr, "(%s)",
6878 dwarf_attr_name (a_attr->dw_attr));
6879 output_value_format (a_attr);
6882 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, NULL);
6883 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, NULL);
6886 /* Terminate the table. */
6887 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, NULL);
6890 /* Output a symbol we can use to refer to this DIE from another CU. */
6892 static inline void
6893 output_die_symbol (dw_die_ref die)
6895 char *sym = die->die_symbol;
6897 if (sym == 0)
6898 return;
6900 if (strncmp (sym, DIE_LABEL_PREFIX, sizeof (DIE_LABEL_PREFIX) - 1) == 0)
6901 /* We make these global, not weak; if the target doesn't support
6902 .linkonce, it doesn't support combining the sections, so debugging
6903 will break. */
6904 targetm.asm_out.globalize_label (asm_out_file, sym);
6906 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, sym);
6909 /* Return a new location list, given the begin and end range, and the
6910 expression. gensym tells us whether to generate a new internal symbol for
6911 this location list node, which is done for the head of the list only. */
6913 static inline dw_loc_list_ref
6914 new_loc_list (dw_loc_descr_ref expr, const char *begin, const char *end,
6915 const char *section, unsigned int gensym)
6917 dw_loc_list_ref retlist = ggc_alloc_cleared (sizeof (dw_loc_list_node));
6919 retlist->begin = begin;
6920 retlist->end = end;
6921 retlist->expr = expr;
6922 retlist->section = section;
6923 if (gensym)
6924 retlist->ll_symbol = gen_internal_sym ("LLST");
6926 return retlist;
6929 /* Add a location description expression to a location list. */
6931 static inline void
6932 add_loc_descr_to_loc_list (dw_loc_list_ref *list_head, dw_loc_descr_ref descr,
6933 const char *begin, const char *end,
6934 const char *section)
6936 dw_loc_list_ref *d;
6938 /* Find the end of the chain. */
6939 for (d = list_head; (*d) != NULL; d = &(*d)->dw_loc_next)
6942 /* Add a new location list node to the list. */
6943 *d = new_loc_list (descr, begin, end, section, 0);
6946 static void
6947 dwarf2out_switch_text_section (void)
6949 dw_fde_ref fde;
6951 gcc_assert (cfun);
6953 fde = &fde_table[fde_table_in_use - 1];
6954 fde->dw_fde_switched_sections = true;
6955 fde->dw_fde_hot_section_label = cfun->hot_section_label;
6956 fde->dw_fde_hot_section_end_label = cfun->hot_section_end_label;
6957 fde->dw_fde_unlikely_section_label = cfun->cold_section_label;
6958 fde->dw_fde_unlikely_section_end_label = cfun->cold_section_end_label;
6959 have_multiple_function_sections = true;
6962 /* Output the location list given to us. */
6964 static void
6965 output_loc_list (dw_loc_list_ref list_head)
6967 dw_loc_list_ref curr = list_head;
6969 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, list_head->ll_symbol);
6971 /* Walk the location list, and output each range + expression. */
6972 for (curr = list_head; curr != NULL; curr = curr->dw_loc_next)
6974 unsigned long size;
6975 if (!have_multiple_function_sections)
6977 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, curr->begin, curr->section,
6978 "Location list begin address (%s)",
6979 list_head->ll_symbol);
6980 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, curr->end, curr->section,
6981 "Location list end address (%s)",
6982 list_head->ll_symbol);
6984 else
6986 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, curr->begin,
6987 "Location list begin address (%s)",
6988 list_head->ll_symbol);
6989 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, curr->end,
6990 "Location list end address (%s)",
6991 list_head->ll_symbol);
6993 size = size_of_locs (curr->expr);
6995 /* Output the block length for this list of location operations. */
6996 gcc_assert (size <= 0xffff);
6997 dw2_asm_output_data (2, size, "%s", "Location expression size");
6999 output_loc_sequence (curr->expr);
7002 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, 0,
7003 "Location list terminator begin (%s)",
7004 list_head->ll_symbol);
7005 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, 0,
7006 "Location list terminator end (%s)",
7007 list_head->ll_symbol);
7010 /* Output the DIE and its attributes. Called recursively to generate
7011 the definitions of each child DIE. */
7013 static void
7014 output_die (dw_die_ref die)
7016 dw_attr_ref a;
7017 dw_die_ref c;
7018 unsigned long size;
7020 /* If someone in another CU might refer to us, set up a symbol for
7021 them to point to. */
7022 if (die->die_symbol)
7023 output_die_symbol (die);
7025 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (die->die_abbrev, "(DIE (0x%lx) %s)",
7026 die->die_offset, dwarf_tag_name (die->die_tag));
7028 for (a = die->die_attr; a != NULL; a = a->dw_attr_next)
7030 const char *name = dwarf_attr_name (a->dw_attr);
7032 switch (AT_class (a))
7034 case dw_val_class_addr:
7035 dw2_asm_output_addr_rtx (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, AT_addr (a), "%s", name);
7036 break;
7038 case dw_val_class_offset:
7039 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, a->dw_attr_val.v.val_offset,
7040 "%s", name);
7041 break;
7043 case dw_val_class_range_list:
7045 char *p = strchr (ranges_section_label, '\0');
7047 sprintf (p, "+" HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_HEX,
7048 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_offset);
7049 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, ranges_section_label,
7050 debug_ranges_section, "%s", name);
7051 *p = '\0';
7053 break;
7055 case dw_val_class_loc:
7056 size = size_of_locs (AT_loc (a));
7058 /* Output the block length for this list of location operations. */
7059 dw2_asm_output_data (constant_size (size), size, "%s", name);
7061 output_loc_sequence (AT_loc (a));
7062 break;
7064 case dw_val_class_const:
7065 /* ??? It would be slightly more efficient to use a scheme like is
7066 used for unsigned constants below, but gdb 4.x does not sign
7067 extend. Gdb 5.x does sign extend. */
7068 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (AT_int (a), "%s", name);
7069 break;
7071 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
7072 dw2_asm_output_data (constant_size (AT_unsigned (a)),
7073 AT_unsigned (a), "%s", name);
7074 break;
7076 case dw_val_class_long_long:
7078 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT first, second;
7080 dw2_asm_output_data (1,
7081 2 * HOST_BITS_PER_LONG / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR,
7082 "%s", name);
7084 if (WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN)
7086 first = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_long_long.hi;
7087 second = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_long_long.low;
7089 else
7091 first = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_long_long.low;
7092 second = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_long_long.hi;
7095 dw2_asm_output_data (HOST_BITS_PER_LONG / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR,
7096 first, "long long constant");
7097 dw2_asm_output_data (HOST_BITS_PER_LONG / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR,
7098 second, NULL);
7100 break;
7102 case dw_val_class_vec:
7104 unsigned int elt_size = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.elt_size;
7105 unsigned int len = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.length;
7106 unsigned int i;
7107 unsigned char *p;
7109 dw2_asm_output_data (1, len * elt_size, "%s", name);
7110 if (elt_size > sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT))
7112 elt_size /= 2;
7113 len *= 2;
7115 for (i = 0, p = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.array;
7116 i < len;
7117 i++, p += elt_size)
7118 dw2_asm_output_data (elt_size, extract_int (p, elt_size),
7119 "fp or vector constant word %u", i);
7120 break;
7123 case dw_val_class_flag:
7124 dw2_asm_output_data (1, AT_flag (a), "%s", name);
7125 break;
7127 case dw_val_class_loc_list:
7129 char *sym = AT_loc_list (a)->ll_symbol;
7131 gcc_assert (sym);
7132 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, sym, debug_loc_section,
7133 "%s", name);
7135 break;
7137 case dw_val_class_die_ref:
7138 if (AT_ref_external (a))
7140 char *sym = AT_ref (a)->die_symbol;
7142 gcc_assert (sym);
7143 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, sym, debug_info_section,
7144 "%s", name);
7146 else
7148 gcc_assert (AT_ref (a)->die_offset);
7149 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, AT_ref (a)->die_offset,
7150 "%s", name);
7152 break;
7154 case dw_val_class_fde_ref:
7156 char l1[20];
7158 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l1, FDE_LABEL,
7159 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_fde_index * 2);
7160 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, l1, debug_frame_section,
7161 "%s", name);
7163 break;
7165 case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
7166 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, AT_lbl (a), "%s", name);
7167 break;
7169 case dw_val_class_lineptr:
7170 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, AT_lbl (a),
7171 debug_line_section, "%s", name);
7172 break;
7174 case dw_val_class_macptr:
7175 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, AT_lbl (a),
7176 debug_macinfo_section, "%s", name);
7177 break;
7179 case dw_val_class_str:
7180 if (AT_string_form (a) == DW_FORM_strp)
7181 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE,
7182 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->label,
7183 debug_str_section,
7184 "%s: \"%s\"", name, AT_string (a));
7185 else
7186 dw2_asm_output_nstring (AT_string (a), -1, "%s", name);
7187 break;
7189 default:
7190 gcc_unreachable ();
7194 for (c = die->die_child; c != NULL; c = c->die_sib)
7195 output_die (c);
7197 /* Add null byte to terminate sibling list. */
7198 if (die->die_child != NULL)
7199 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "end of children of DIE 0x%lx",
7200 die->die_offset);
7203 /* Output the compilation unit that appears at the beginning of the
7204 .debug_info section, and precedes the DIE descriptions. */
7206 static void
7207 output_compilation_unit_header (void)
7209 if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4)
7210 dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff,
7211 "Initial length escape value indicating 64-bit DWARF extension");
7212 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE,
7213 next_die_offset - DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE,
7214 "Length of Compilation Unit Info");
7215 dw2_asm_output_data (2, DWARF_VERSION, "DWARF version number");
7216 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, abbrev_section_label,
7217 debug_abbrev_section,
7218 "Offset Into Abbrev. Section");
7219 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, "Pointer Size (in bytes)");
7222 /* Output the compilation unit DIE and its children. */
7224 static void
7225 output_comp_unit (dw_die_ref die, int output_if_empty)
7227 const char *secname;
7228 char *oldsym, *tmp;
7230 /* Unless we are outputting main CU, we may throw away empty ones. */
7231 if (!output_if_empty && die->die_child == NULL)
7232 return;
7234 /* Even if there are no children of this DIE, we must output the information
7235 about the compilation unit. Otherwise, on an empty translation unit, we
7236 will generate a present, but empty, .debug_info section. IRIX 6.5 `nm'
7237 will then complain when examining the file. First mark all the DIEs in
7238 this CU so we know which get local refs. */
7239 mark_dies (die);
7241 build_abbrev_table (die);
7243 /* Initialize the beginning DIE offset - and calculate sizes/offsets. */
7244 next_die_offset = DWARF_COMPILE_UNIT_HEADER_SIZE;
7245 calc_die_sizes (die);
7247 oldsym = die->die_symbol;
7248 if (oldsym)
7250 tmp = alloca (strlen (oldsym) + 24);
7252 sprintf (tmp, ".gnu.linkonce.wi.%s", oldsym);
7253 secname = tmp;
7254 die->die_symbol = NULL;
7255 switch_to_section (get_section (secname, SECTION_DEBUG, NULL));
7257 else
7258 switch_to_section (debug_info_section);
7260 /* Output debugging information. */
7261 output_compilation_unit_header ();
7262 output_die (die);
7264 /* Leave the marks on the main CU, so we can check them in
7265 output_pubnames. */
7266 if (oldsym)
7268 unmark_dies (die);
7269 die->die_symbol = oldsym;
7273 /* The DWARF2 pubname for a nested thingy looks like "A::f". The
7274 output of lang_hooks.decl_printable_name for C++ looks like
7275 "A::f(int)". Let's drop the argument list, and maybe the scope. */
7277 static const char *
7278 dwarf2_name (tree decl, int scope)
7280 return lang_hooks.decl_printable_name (decl, scope ? 1 : 0);
7283 /* Add a new entry to .debug_pubnames if appropriate. */
7285 static void
7286 add_pubname (tree decl, dw_die_ref die)
7288 pubname_ref p;
7290 if (! TREE_PUBLIC (decl))
7291 return;
7293 if (pubname_table_in_use == pubname_table_allocated)
7295 pubname_table_allocated += PUBNAME_TABLE_INCREMENT;
7296 pubname_table
7297 = ggc_realloc (pubname_table,
7298 (pubname_table_allocated * sizeof (pubname_entry)));
7299 memset (pubname_table + pubname_table_in_use, 0,
7300 PUBNAME_TABLE_INCREMENT * sizeof (pubname_entry));
7303 p = &pubname_table[pubname_table_in_use++];
7304 p->die = die;
7305 p->name = xstrdup (dwarf2_name (decl, 1));
7308 /* Output the public names table used to speed up access to externally
7309 visible names. For now, only generate entries for externally
7310 visible procedures. */
7312 static void
7313 output_pubnames (void)
7315 unsigned i;
7316 unsigned long pubnames_length = size_of_pubnames ();
7318 if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4)
7319 dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff,
7320 "Initial length escape value indicating 64-bit DWARF extension");
7321 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, pubnames_length,
7322 "Length of Public Names Info");
7323 dw2_asm_output_data (2, DWARF_VERSION, "DWARF Version");
7324 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, debug_info_section_label,
7325 debug_info_section,
7326 "Offset of Compilation Unit Info");
7327 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, next_die_offset,
7328 "Compilation Unit Length");
7330 for (i = 0; i < pubname_table_in_use; i++)
7332 pubname_ref pub = &pubname_table[i];
7334 /* We shouldn't see pubnames for DIEs outside of the main CU. */
7335 gcc_assert (pub->die->die_mark);
7337 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, pub->die->die_offset,
7338 "DIE offset");
7340 dw2_asm_output_nstring (pub->name, -1, "external name");
7343 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, 0, NULL);
7346 /* Add a new entry to .debug_aranges if appropriate. */
7348 static void
7349 add_arange (tree decl, dw_die_ref die)
7351 if (! DECL_SECTION_NAME (decl))
7352 return;
7354 if (arange_table_in_use == arange_table_allocated)
7356 arange_table_allocated += ARANGE_TABLE_INCREMENT;
7357 arange_table = ggc_realloc (arange_table,
7358 (arange_table_allocated
7359 * sizeof (dw_die_ref)));
7360 memset (arange_table + arange_table_in_use, 0,
7361 ARANGE_TABLE_INCREMENT * sizeof (dw_die_ref));
7364 arange_table[arange_table_in_use++] = die;
7367 /* Output the information that goes into the .debug_aranges table.
7368 Namely, define the beginning and ending address range of the
7369 text section generated for this compilation unit. */
7371 static void
7372 output_aranges (void)
7374 unsigned i;
7375 unsigned long aranges_length = size_of_aranges ();
7377 if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4)
7378 dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff,
7379 "Initial length escape value indicating 64-bit DWARF extension");
7380 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, aranges_length,
7381 "Length of Address Ranges Info");
7382 dw2_asm_output_data (2, DWARF_VERSION, "DWARF Version");
7383 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, debug_info_section_label,
7384 debug_info_section,
7385 "Offset of Compilation Unit Info");
7386 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, "Size of Address");
7387 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "Size of Segment Descriptor");
7389 /* We need to align to twice the pointer size here. */
7390 if (DWARF_ARANGES_PAD_SIZE)
7392 /* Pad using a 2 byte words so that padding is correct for any
7393 pointer size. */
7394 dw2_asm_output_data (2, 0, "Pad to %d byte boundary",
7395 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE);
7396 for (i = 2; i < (unsigned) DWARF_ARANGES_PAD_SIZE; i += 2)
7397 dw2_asm_output_data (2, 0, NULL);
7400 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, text_section_label, "Address");
7401 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, text_end_label,
7402 text_section_label, "Length");
7403 if (flag_reorder_blocks_and_partition)
7405 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, cold_text_section_label,
7406 "Address");
7407 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, cold_end_label,
7408 cold_text_section_label, "Length");
7411 for (i = 0; i < arange_table_in_use; i++)
7413 dw_die_ref die = arange_table[i];
7415 /* We shouldn't see aranges for DIEs outside of the main CU. */
7416 gcc_assert (die->die_mark);
7418 if (die->die_tag == DW_TAG_subprogram)
7420 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, get_AT_low_pc (die),
7421 "Address");
7422 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, get_AT_hi_pc (die),
7423 get_AT_low_pc (die), "Length");
7425 else
7427 /* A static variable; extract the symbol from DW_AT_location.
7428 Note that this code isn't currently hit, as we only emit
7429 aranges for functions (jason 9/23/99). */
7430 dw_attr_ref a = get_AT (die, DW_AT_location);
7431 dw_loc_descr_ref loc;
7433 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_loc);
7435 loc = AT_loc (a);
7436 gcc_assert (loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_addr);
7438 dw2_asm_output_addr_rtx (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
7439 loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr, "Address");
7440 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
7441 get_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_byte_size),
7442 "Length");
7446 /* Output the terminator words. */
7447 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, 0, NULL);
7448 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, 0, NULL);
7451 /* Add a new entry to .debug_ranges. Return the offset at which it
7452 was placed. */
7454 static unsigned int
7455 add_ranges (tree block)
7457 unsigned int in_use = ranges_table_in_use;
7459 if (in_use == ranges_table_allocated)
7461 ranges_table_allocated += RANGES_TABLE_INCREMENT;
7462 ranges_table
7463 = ggc_realloc (ranges_table, (ranges_table_allocated
7464 * sizeof (struct dw_ranges_struct)));
7465 memset (ranges_table + ranges_table_in_use, 0,
7466 RANGES_TABLE_INCREMENT * sizeof (struct dw_ranges_struct));
7469 ranges_table[in_use].block_num = (block ? BLOCK_NUMBER (block) : 0);
7470 ranges_table_in_use = in_use + 1;
7472 return in_use * 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
7475 static void
7476 output_ranges (void)
7478 unsigned i;
7479 static const char *const start_fmt = "Offset 0x%x";
7480 const char *fmt = start_fmt;
7482 for (i = 0; i < ranges_table_in_use; i++)
7484 int block_num = ranges_table[i].block_num;
7486 if (block_num)
7488 char blabel[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
7489 char elabel[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
7491 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (blabel, BLOCK_BEGIN_LABEL, block_num);
7492 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (elabel, BLOCK_END_LABEL, block_num);
7494 /* If all code is in the text section, then the compilation
7495 unit base address defaults to DW_AT_low_pc, which is the
7496 base of the text section. */
7497 if (!have_multiple_function_sections)
7499 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, blabel,
7500 text_section_label,
7501 fmt, i * 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE);
7502 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, elabel,
7503 text_section_label, NULL);
7506 /* Otherwise, we add a DW_AT_entry_pc attribute to force the
7507 compilation unit base address to zero, which allows us to
7508 use absolute addresses, and not worry about whether the
7509 target supports cross-section arithmetic. */
7510 else
7512 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, blabel,
7513 fmt, i * 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE);
7514 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, elabel, NULL);
7517 fmt = NULL;
7519 else
7521 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, 0, NULL);
7522 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, 0, NULL);
7523 fmt = start_fmt;
7528 /* Data structure containing information about input files. */
7529 struct file_info
7531 char *path; /* Complete file name. */
7532 char *fname; /* File name part. */
7533 int length; /* Length of entire string. */
7534 int file_idx; /* Index in input file table. */
7535 int dir_idx; /* Index in directory table. */
7538 /* Data structure containing information about directories with source
7539 files. */
7540 struct dir_info
7542 char *path; /* Path including directory name. */
7543 int length; /* Path length. */
7544 int prefix; /* Index of directory entry which is a prefix. */
7545 int count; /* Number of files in this directory. */
7546 int dir_idx; /* Index of directory used as base. */
7547 int used; /* Used in the end? */
7550 /* Callback function for file_info comparison. We sort by looking at
7551 the directories in the path. */
7553 static int
7554 file_info_cmp (const void *p1, const void *p2)
7556 const struct file_info *s1 = p1;
7557 const struct file_info *s2 = p2;
7558 unsigned char *cp1;
7559 unsigned char *cp2;
7561 /* Take care of file names without directories. We need to make sure that
7562 we return consistent values to qsort since some will get confused if
7563 we return the same value when identical operands are passed in opposite
7564 orders. So if neither has a directory, return 0 and otherwise return
7565 1 or -1 depending on which one has the directory. */
7566 if ((s1->path == s1->fname || s2->path == s2->fname))
7567 return (s2->path == s2->fname) - (s1->path == s1->fname);
7569 cp1 = (unsigned char *) s1->path;
7570 cp2 = (unsigned char *) s2->path;
7572 while (1)
7574 ++cp1;
7575 ++cp2;
7576 /* Reached the end of the first path? If so, handle like above. */
7577 if ((cp1 == (unsigned char *) s1->fname)
7578 || (cp2 == (unsigned char *) s2->fname))
7579 return ((cp2 == (unsigned char *) s2->fname)
7580 - (cp1 == (unsigned char *) s1->fname));
7582 /* Character of current path component the same? */
7583 else if (*cp1 != *cp2)
7584 return *cp1 - *cp2;
7588 /* Output the directory table and the file name table. We try to minimize
7589 the total amount of memory needed. A heuristic is used to avoid large
7590 slowdowns with many input files. */
7592 static void
7593 output_file_names (void)
7595 struct file_info *files;
7596 struct dir_info *dirs;
7597 int *saved;
7598 int *savehere;
7599 int *backmap;
7600 size_t ndirs;
7601 int idx_offset;
7602 size_t i;
7603 int idx;
7605 /* Handle the case where file_table is empty. */
7606 if (VARRAY_ACTIVE_SIZE (file_table) <= 1)
7608 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "End directory table");
7609 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "End file name table");
7610 return;
7613 /* Allocate the various arrays we need. */
7614 files = alloca (VARRAY_ACTIVE_SIZE (file_table) * sizeof (struct file_info));
7615 dirs = alloca (VARRAY_ACTIVE_SIZE (file_table) * sizeof (struct dir_info));
7617 /* Sort the file names. */
7618 for (i = 1; i < VARRAY_ACTIVE_SIZE (file_table); i++)
7620 char *f;
7622 /* Skip all leading "./". */
7623 f = VARRAY_CHAR_PTR (file_table, i);
7624 while (f[0] == '.' && f[1] == '/')
7625 f += 2;
7627 /* Create a new array entry. */
7628 files[i].path = f;
7629 files[i].length = strlen (f);
7630 files[i].file_idx = i;
7632 /* Search for the file name part. */
7633 f = strrchr (f, '/');
7634 files[i].fname = f == NULL ? files[i].path : f + 1;
7637 qsort (files + 1, VARRAY_ACTIVE_SIZE (file_table) - 1,
7638 sizeof (files[0]), file_info_cmp);
7640 /* Find all the different directories used. */
7641 dirs[0].path = files[1].path;
7642 dirs[0].length = files[1].fname - files[1].path;
7643 dirs[0].prefix = -1;
7644 dirs[0].count = 1;
7645 dirs[0].dir_idx = 0;
7646 dirs[0].used = 0;
7647 files[1].dir_idx = 0;
7648 ndirs = 1;
7650 for (i = 2; i < VARRAY_ACTIVE_SIZE (file_table); i++)
7651 if (files[i].fname - files[i].path == dirs[ndirs - 1].length
7652 && memcmp (dirs[ndirs - 1].path, files[i].path,
7653 dirs[ndirs - 1].length) == 0)
7655 /* Same directory as last entry. */
7656 files[i].dir_idx = ndirs - 1;
7657 ++dirs[ndirs - 1].count;
7659 else
7661 size_t j;
7663 /* This is a new directory. */
7664 dirs[ndirs].path = files[i].path;
7665 dirs[ndirs].length = files[i].fname - files[i].path;
7666 dirs[ndirs].count = 1;
7667 dirs[ndirs].dir_idx = ndirs;
7668 dirs[ndirs].used = 0;
7669 files[i].dir_idx = ndirs;
7671 /* Search for a prefix. */
7672 dirs[ndirs].prefix = -1;
7673 for (j = 0; j < ndirs; j++)
7674 if (dirs[j].length < dirs[ndirs].length
7675 && dirs[j].length > 1
7676 && (dirs[ndirs].prefix == -1
7677 || dirs[j].length > dirs[dirs[ndirs].prefix].length)
7678 && memcmp (dirs[j].path, dirs[ndirs].path, dirs[j].length) == 0)
7679 dirs[ndirs].prefix = j;
7681 ++ndirs;
7684 /* Now to the actual work. We have to find a subset of the directories which
7685 allow expressing the file name using references to the directory table
7686 with the least amount of characters. We do not do an exhaustive search
7687 where we would have to check out every combination of every single
7688 possible prefix. Instead we use a heuristic which provides nearly optimal
7689 results in most cases and never is much off. */
7690 saved = alloca (ndirs * sizeof (int));
7691 savehere = alloca (ndirs * sizeof (int));
7693 memset (saved, '\0', ndirs * sizeof (saved[0]));
7694 for (i = 0; i < ndirs; i++)
7696 size_t j;
7697 int total;
7699 /* We can always save some space for the current directory. But this
7700 does not mean it will be enough to justify adding the directory. */
7701 savehere[i] = dirs[i].length;
7702 total = (savehere[i] - saved[i]) * dirs[i].count;
7704 for (j = i + 1; j < ndirs; j++)
7706 savehere[j] = 0;
7707 if (saved[j] < dirs[i].length)
7709 /* Determine whether the dirs[i] path is a prefix of the
7710 dirs[j] path. */
7711 int k;
7713 k = dirs[j].prefix;
7714 while (k != -1 && k != (int) i)
7715 k = dirs[k].prefix;
7717 if (k == (int) i)
7719 /* Yes it is. We can possibly safe some memory but
7720 writing the filenames in dirs[j] relative to
7721 dirs[i]. */
7722 savehere[j] = dirs[i].length;
7723 total += (savehere[j] - saved[j]) * dirs[j].count;
7728 /* Check whether we can safe enough to justify adding the dirs[i]
7729 directory. */
7730 if (total > dirs[i].length + 1)
7732 /* It's worthwhile adding. */
7733 for (j = i; j < ndirs; j++)
7734 if (savehere[j] > 0)
7736 /* Remember how much we saved for this directory so far. */
7737 saved[j] = savehere[j];
7739 /* Remember the prefix directory. */
7740 dirs[j].dir_idx = i;
7745 /* We have to emit them in the order they appear in the file_table array
7746 since the index is used in the debug info generation. To do this
7747 efficiently we generate a back-mapping of the indices first. */
7748 backmap = alloca (VARRAY_ACTIVE_SIZE (file_table) * sizeof (int));
7749 for (i = 1; i < VARRAY_ACTIVE_SIZE (file_table); i++)
7751 backmap[files[i].file_idx] = i;
7753 /* Mark this directory as used. */
7754 dirs[dirs[files[i].dir_idx].dir_idx].used = 1;
7757 /* That was it. We are ready to emit the information. First emit the
7758 directory name table. We have to make sure the first actually emitted
7759 directory name has index one; zero is reserved for the current working
7760 directory. Make sure we do not confuse these indices with the one for the
7761 constructed table (even though most of the time they are identical). */
7762 idx = 1;
7763 idx_offset = dirs[0].length > 0 ? 1 : 0;
7764 for (i = 1 - idx_offset; i < ndirs; i++)
7765 if (dirs[i].used != 0)
7767 dirs[i].used = idx++;
7768 dw2_asm_output_nstring (dirs[i].path, dirs[i].length - 1,
7769 "Directory Entry: 0x%x", dirs[i].used);
7772 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "End directory table");
7774 /* Correct the index for the current working directory entry if it
7775 exists. */
7776 if (idx_offset == 0)
7777 dirs[0].used = 0;
7779 /* Now write all the file names. */
7780 for (i = 1; i < VARRAY_ACTIVE_SIZE (file_table); i++)
7782 int file_idx = backmap[i];
7783 int dir_idx = dirs[files[file_idx].dir_idx].dir_idx;
7785 dw2_asm_output_nstring (files[file_idx].path + dirs[dir_idx].length, -1,
7786 "File Entry: 0x%lx", (unsigned long) i);
7788 /* Include directory index. */
7789 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (dirs[dir_idx].used, NULL);
7791 /* Modification time. */
7792 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (0, NULL);
7794 /* File length in bytes. */
7795 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (0, NULL);
7798 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "End file name table");
7802 /* Output the source line number correspondence information. This
7803 information goes into the .debug_line section. */
7805 static void
7806 output_line_info (void)
7808 char l1[20], l2[20], p1[20], p2[20];
7809 char line_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
7810 char prev_line_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
7811 unsigned opc;
7812 unsigned n_op_args;
7813 unsigned long lt_index;
7814 unsigned long current_line;
7815 long line_offset;
7816 long line_delta;
7817 unsigned long current_file;
7818 unsigned long function;
7820 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l1, LINE_NUMBER_BEGIN_LABEL, 0);
7821 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l2, LINE_NUMBER_END_LABEL, 0);
7822 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (p1, LN_PROLOG_AS_LABEL, 0);
7823 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (p2, LN_PROLOG_END_LABEL, 0);
7825 if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4)
7826 dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff,
7827 "Initial length escape value indicating 64-bit DWARF extension");
7828 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, l2, l1,
7829 "Length of Source Line Info");
7830 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l1);
7832 dw2_asm_output_data (2, DWARF_VERSION, "DWARF Version");
7833 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, p2, p1, "Prolog Length");
7834 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, p1);
7836 /* Define the architecture-dependent minimum instruction length (in
7837 bytes). In this implementation of DWARF, this field is used for
7838 information purposes only. Since GCC generates assembly language,
7839 we have no a priori knowledge of how many instruction bytes are
7840 generated for each source line, and therefore can use only the
7841 DW_LNE_set_address and DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc line information
7842 commands. Accordingly, we fix this as `1', which is "correct
7843 enough" for all architectures, and don't let the target override. */
7844 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 1,
7845 "Minimum Instruction Length");
7847 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_DEFAULT_IS_STMT_START,
7848 "Default is_stmt_start flag");
7849 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_BASE,
7850 "Line Base Value (Special Opcodes)");
7851 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_RANGE,
7852 "Line Range Value (Special Opcodes)");
7853 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_OPCODE_BASE,
7854 "Special Opcode Base");
7856 for (opc = 1; opc < DWARF_LINE_OPCODE_BASE; opc++)
7858 switch (opc)
7860 case DW_LNS_advance_pc:
7861 case DW_LNS_advance_line:
7862 case DW_LNS_set_file:
7863 case DW_LNS_set_column:
7864 case DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc:
7865 n_op_args = 1;
7866 break;
7867 default:
7868 n_op_args = 0;
7869 break;
7872 dw2_asm_output_data (1, n_op_args, "opcode: 0x%x has %d args",
7873 opc, n_op_args);
7876 /* Write out the information about the files we use. */
7877 output_file_names ();
7878 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, p2);
7880 /* We used to set the address register to the first location in the text
7881 section here, but that didn't accomplish anything since we already
7882 have a line note for the opening brace of the first function. */
7884 /* Generate the line number to PC correspondence table, encoded as
7885 a series of state machine operations. */
7886 current_file = 1;
7887 current_line = 1;
7889 if (cfun && in_cold_section_p)
7890 strcpy (prev_line_label, cfun->cold_section_label);
7891 else
7892 strcpy (prev_line_label, text_section_label);
7893 for (lt_index = 1; lt_index < line_info_table_in_use; ++lt_index)
7895 dw_line_info_ref line_info = &line_info_table[lt_index];
7897 #if 0
7898 /* Disable this optimization for now; GDB wants to see two line notes
7899 at the beginning of a function so it can find the end of the
7900 prologue. */
7902 /* Don't emit anything for redundant notes. Just updating the
7903 address doesn't accomplish anything, because we already assume
7904 that anything after the last address is this line. */
7905 if (line_info->dw_line_num == current_line
7906 && line_info->dw_file_num == current_file)
7907 continue;
7908 #endif
7910 /* Emit debug info for the address of the current line.
7912 Unfortunately, we have little choice here currently, and must always
7913 use the most general form. GCC does not know the address delta
7914 itself, so we can't use DW_LNS_advance_pc. Many ports do have length
7915 attributes which will give an upper bound on the address range. We
7916 could perhaps use length attributes to determine when it is safe to
7917 use DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc. */
7919 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (line_label, LINE_CODE_LABEL, lt_index);
7920 if (0)
7922 /* This can handle deltas up to 0xffff. This takes 3 bytes. */
7923 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc,
7924 "DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc");
7925 dw2_asm_output_delta (2, line_label, prev_line_label, NULL);
7927 else
7929 /* This can handle any delta. This takes
7930 4+DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE bytes. */
7931 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "DW_LNE_set_address");
7932 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1 + DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, NULL);
7933 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNE_set_address, NULL);
7934 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, line_label, NULL);
7937 strcpy (prev_line_label, line_label);
7939 /* Emit debug info for the source file of the current line, if
7940 different from the previous line. */
7941 if (line_info->dw_file_num != current_file)
7943 current_file = line_info->dw_file_num;
7944 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_set_file, "DW_LNS_set_file");
7945 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (current_file, "(\"%s\")",
7946 VARRAY_CHAR_PTR (file_table,
7947 current_file));
7950 /* Emit debug info for the current line number, choosing the encoding
7951 that uses the least amount of space. */
7952 if (line_info->dw_line_num != current_line)
7954 line_offset = line_info->dw_line_num - current_line;
7955 line_delta = line_offset - DWARF_LINE_BASE;
7956 current_line = line_info->dw_line_num;
7957 if (line_delta >= 0 && line_delta < (DWARF_LINE_RANGE - 1))
7958 /* This can handle deltas from -10 to 234, using the current
7959 definitions of DWARF_LINE_BASE and DWARF_LINE_RANGE. This
7960 takes 1 byte. */
7961 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_OPCODE_BASE + line_delta,
7962 "line %lu", current_line);
7963 else
7965 /* This can handle any delta. This takes at least 4 bytes,
7966 depending on the value being encoded. */
7967 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_advance_line,
7968 "advance to line %lu", current_line);
7969 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (line_offset, NULL);
7970 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_copy, "DW_LNS_copy");
7973 else
7974 /* We still need to start a new row, so output a copy insn. */
7975 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_copy, "DW_LNS_copy");
7978 /* Emit debug info for the address of the end of the function. */
7979 if (0)
7981 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc,
7982 "DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc");
7983 dw2_asm_output_delta (2, text_end_label, prev_line_label, NULL);
7985 else
7987 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "DW_LNE_set_address");
7988 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1 + DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, NULL);
7989 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNE_set_address, NULL);
7990 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, text_end_label, NULL);
7993 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "DW_LNE_end_sequence");
7994 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1, NULL);
7995 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNE_end_sequence, NULL);
7997 function = 0;
7998 current_file = 1;
7999 current_line = 1;
8000 for (lt_index = 0; lt_index < separate_line_info_table_in_use;)
8002 dw_separate_line_info_ref line_info
8003 = &separate_line_info_table[lt_index];
8005 #if 0
8006 /* Don't emit anything for redundant notes. */
8007 if (line_info->dw_line_num == current_line
8008 && line_info->dw_file_num == current_file
8009 && line_info->function == function)
8010 goto cont;
8011 #endif
8013 /* Emit debug info for the address of the current line. If this is
8014 a new function, or the first line of a function, then we need
8015 to handle it differently. */
8016 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (line_label, SEPARATE_LINE_CODE_LABEL,
8017 lt_index);
8018 if (function != line_info->function)
8020 function = line_info->function;
8022 /* Set the address register to the first line in the function. */
8023 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "DW_LNE_set_address");
8024 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1 + DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, NULL);
8025 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNE_set_address, NULL);
8026 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, line_label, NULL);
8028 else
8030 /* ??? See the DW_LNS_advance_pc comment above. */
8031 if (0)
8033 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc,
8034 "DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc");
8035 dw2_asm_output_delta (2, line_label, prev_line_label, NULL);
8037 else
8039 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "DW_LNE_set_address");
8040 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1 + DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, NULL);
8041 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNE_set_address, NULL);
8042 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, line_label, NULL);
8046 strcpy (prev_line_label, line_label);
8048 /* Emit debug info for the source file of the current line, if
8049 different from the previous line. */
8050 if (line_info->dw_file_num != current_file)
8052 current_file = line_info->dw_file_num;
8053 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_set_file, "DW_LNS_set_file");
8054 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (current_file, "(\"%s\")",
8055 VARRAY_CHAR_PTR (file_table,
8056 current_file));
8059 /* Emit debug info for the current line number, choosing the encoding
8060 that uses the least amount of space. */
8061 if (line_info->dw_line_num != current_line)
8063 line_offset = line_info->dw_line_num - current_line;
8064 line_delta = line_offset - DWARF_LINE_BASE;
8065 current_line = line_info->dw_line_num;
8066 if (line_delta >= 0 && line_delta < (DWARF_LINE_RANGE - 1))
8067 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_OPCODE_BASE + line_delta,
8068 "line %lu", current_line);
8069 else
8071 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_advance_line,
8072 "advance to line %lu", current_line);
8073 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (line_offset, NULL);
8074 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_copy, "DW_LNS_copy");
8077 else
8078 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_copy, "DW_LNS_copy");
8080 #if 0
8081 cont:
8082 #endif
8084 lt_index++;
8086 /* If we're done with a function, end its sequence. */
8087 if (lt_index == separate_line_info_table_in_use
8088 || separate_line_info_table[lt_index].function != function)
8090 current_file = 1;
8091 current_line = 1;
8093 /* Emit debug info for the address of the end of the function. */
8094 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (line_label, FUNC_END_LABEL, function);
8095 if (0)
8097 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc,
8098 "DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc");
8099 dw2_asm_output_delta (2, line_label, prev_line_label, NULL);
8101 else
8103 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "DW_LNE_set_address");
8104 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1 + DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, NULL);
8105 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNE_set_address, NULL);
8106 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, line_label, NULL);
8109 /* Output the marker for the end of this sequence. */
8110 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "DW_LNE_end_sequence");
8111 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1, NULL);
8112 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNE_end_sequence, NULL);
8116 /* Output the marker for the end of the line number info. */
8117 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l2);
8120 /* Given a pointer to a tree node for some base type, return a pointer to
8121 a DIE that describes the given type.
8123 This routine must only be called for GCC type nodes that correspond to
8124 Dwarf base (fundamental) types. */
8126 static dw_die_ref
8127 base_type_die (tree type)
8129 dw_die_ref base_type_result;
8130 enum dwarf_type encoding;
8132 if (TREE_CODE (type) == ERROR_MARK || TREE_CODE (type) == VOID_TYPE)
8133 return 0;
8135 switch (TREE_CODE (type))
8137 case INTEGER_TYPE:
8138 if (TYPE_STRING_FLAG (type))
8140 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (type))
8141 encoding = DW_ATE_unsigned_char;
8142 else
8143 encoding = DW_ATE_signed_char;
8145 else if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (type))
8146 encoding = DW_ATE_unsigned;
8147 else
8148 encoding = DW_ATE_signed;
8149 break;
8151 case REAL_TYPE:
8152 if (DECIMAL_FLOAT_MODE_P (TYPE_MODE (type)))
8153 encoding = DW_ATE_decimal_float;
8154 else
8155 encoding = DW_ATE_float;
8156 break;
8158 /* Dwarf2 doesn't know anything about complex ints, so use
8159 a user defined type for it. */
8160 case COMPLEX_TYPE:
8161 if (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (type)) == REAL_TYPE)
8162 encoding = DW_ATE_complex_float;
8163 else
8164 encoding = DW_ATE_lo_user;
8165 break;
8167 case BOOLEAN_TYPE:
8168 /* GNU FORTRAN/Ada/C++ BOOLEAN type. */
8169 encoding = DW_ATE_boolean;
8170 break;
8172 default:
8173 /* No other TREE_CODEs are Dwarf fundamental types. */
8174 gcc_unreachable ();
8177 base_type_result = new_die (DW_TAG_base_type, comp_unit_die, type);
8179 /* This probably indicates a bug. */
8180 if (! TYPE_NAME (type))
8181 add_name_attribute (base_type_result, "__unknown__");
8183 add_AT_unsigned (base_type_result, DW_AT_byte_size,
8184 int_size_in_bytes (type));
8185 add_AT_unsigned (base_type_result, DW_AT_encoding, encoding);
8187 return base_type_result;
8190 /* Given a pointer to an arbitrary ..._TYPE tree node, return a pointer to
8191 the Dwarf "root" type for the given input type. The Dwarf "root" type of
8192 a given type is generally the same as the given type, except that if the
8193 given type is a pointer or reference type, then the root type of the given
8194 type is the root type of the "basis" type for the pointer or reference
8195 type. (This definition of the "root" type is recursive.) Also, the root
8196 type of a `const' qualified type or a `volatile' qualified type is the
8197 root type of the given type without the qualifiers. */
8199 static tree
8200 root_type (tree type)
8202 if (TREE_CODE (type) == ERROR_MARK)
8203 return error_mark_node;
8205 switch (TREE_CODE (type))
8207 case ERROR_MARK:
8208 return error_mark_node;
8210 case POINTER_TYPE:
8211 case REFERENCE_TYPE:
8212 return type_main_variant (root_type (TREE_TYPE (type)));
8214 default:
8215 return type_main_variant (type);
8219 /* Given a pointer to an arbitrary ..._TYPE tree node, return nonzero if the
8220 given input type is a Dwarf "fundamental" type. Otherwise return null. */
8222 static inline int
8223 is_base_type (tree type)
8225 switch (TREE_CODE (type))
8227 case ERROR_MARK:
8228 case VOID_TYPE:
8229 case INTEGER_TYPE:
8230 case REAL_TYPE:
8231 case COMPLEX_TYPE:
8232 case BOOLEAN_TYPE:
8233 return 1;
8235 case ARRAY_TYPE:
8236 case RECORD_TYPE:
8237 case UNION_TYPE:
8238 case QUAL_UNION_TYPE:
8239 case ENUMERAL_TYPE:
8240 case FUNCTION_TYPE:
8241 case METHOD_TYPE:
8242 case POINTER_TYPE:
8243 case REFERENCE_TYPE:
8244 case OFFSET_TYPE:
8245 case LANG_TYPE:
8246 case VECTOR_TYPE:
8247 return 0;
8249 default:
8250 gcc_unreachable ();
8253 return 0;
8256 /* Given a pointer to a tree node, assumed to be some kind of a ..._TYPE
8257 node, return the size in bits for the type if it is a constant, or else
8258 return the alignment for the type if the type's size is not constant, or
8259 else return BITS_PER_WORD if the type actually turns out to be an
8260 ERROR_MARK node. */
8262 static inline unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT
8263 simple_type_size_in_bits (tree type)
8265 if (TREE_CODE (type) == ERROR_MARK)
8266 return BITS_PER_WORD;
8267 else if (TYPE_SIZE (type) == NULL_TREE)
8268 return 0;
8269 else if (host_integerp (TYPE_SIZE (type), 1))
8270 return tree_low_cst (TYPE_SIZE (type), 1);
8271 else
8272 return TYPE_ALIGN (type);
8275 /* Return true if the debug information for the given type should be
8276 emitted as a subrange type. */
8278 static inline bool
8279 is_subrange_type (tree type)
8281 tree subtype = TREE_TYPE (type);
8283 /* Subrange types are identified by the fact that they are integer
8284 types, and that they have a subtype which is either an integer type
8285 or an enumeral type. */
8287 if (TREE_CODE (type) != INTEGER_TYPE
8288 || subtype == NULL_TREE)
8289 return false;
8291 if (TREE_CODE (subtype) != INTEGER_TYPE
8292 && TREE_CODE (subtype) != ENUMERAL_TYPE)
8293 return false;
8295 if (TREE_CODE (type) == TREE_CODE (subtype)
8296 && int_size_in_bytes (type) == int_size_in_bytes (subtype)
8297 && TYPE_MIN_VALUE (type) != NULL
8298 && TYPE_MIN_VALUE (subtype) != NULL
8299 && tree_int_cst_equal (TYPE_MIN_VALUE (type), TYPE_MIN_VALUE (subtype))
8300 && TYPE_MAX_VALUE (type) != NULL
8301 && TYPE_MAX_VALUE (subtype) != NULL
8302 && tree_int_cst_equal (TYPE_MAX_VALUE (type), TYPE_MAX_VALUE (subtype)))
8304 /* The type and its subtype have the same representation. If in
8305 addition the two types also have the same name, then the given
8306 type is not a subrange type, but rather a plain base type. */
8307 /* FIXME: brobecker/2004-03-22:
8308 Sizetype INTEGER_CSTs nodes are canonicalized. It should
8309 therefore be sufficient to check the TYPE_SIZE node pointers
8310 rather than checking the actual size. Unfortunately, we have
8311 found some cases, such as in the Ada "integer" type, where
8312 this is not the case. Until this problem is solved, we need to
8313 keep checking the actual size. */
8314 tree type_name = TYPE_NAME (type);
8315 tree subtype_name = TYPE_NAME (subtype);
8317 if (type_name != NULL && TREE_CODE (type_name) == TYPE_DECL)
8318 type_name = DECL_NAME (type_name);
8320 if (subtype_name != NULL && TREE_CODE (subtype_name) == TYPE_DECL)
8321 subtype_name = DECL_NAME (subtype_name);
8323 if (type_name == subtype_name)
8324 return false;
8327 return true;
8330 /* Given a pointer to a tree node for a subrange type, return a pointer
8331 to a DIE that describes the given type. */
8333 static dw_die_ref
8334 subrange_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
8336 dw_die_ref subrange_die;
8337 const HOST_WIDE_INT size_in_bytes = int_size_in_bytes (type);
8339 if (context_die == NULL)
8340 context_die = comp_unit_die;
8342 subrange_die = new_die (DW_TAG_subrange_type, context_die, type);
8344 if (int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (type)) != size_in_bytes)
8346 /* The size of the subrange type and its base type do not match,
8347 so we need to generate a size attribute for the subrange type. */
8348 add_AT_unsigned (subrange_die, DW_AT_byte_size, size_in_bytes);
8351 if (TYPE_MIN_VALUE (type) != NULL)
8352 add_bound_info (subrange_die, DW_AT_lower_bound,
8353 TYPE_MIN_VALUE (type));
8354 if (TYPE_MAX_VALUE (type) != NULL)
8355 add_bound_info (subrange_die, DW_AT_upper_bound,
8356 TYPE_MAX_VALUE (type));
8358 return subrange_die;
8361 /* Given a pointer to an arbitrary ..._TYPE tree node, return a debugging
8362 entry that chains various modifiers in front of the given type. */
8364 static dw_die_ref
8365 modified_type_die (tree type, int is_const_type, int is_volatile_type,
8366 dw_die_ref context_die)
8368 enum tree_code code = TREE_CODE (type);
8369 dw_die_ref mod_type_die;
8370 dw_die_ref sub_die = NULL;
8371 tree item_type = NULL;
8372 tree qualified_type;
8373 tree name;
8375 if (code == ERROR_MARK)
8376 return NULL;
8378 /* See if we already have the appropriately qualified variant of
8379 this type. */
8380 qualified_type
8381 = get_qualified_type (type,
8382 ((is_const_type ? TYPE_QUAL_CONST : 0)
8383 | (is_volatile_type ? TYPE_QUAL_VOLATILE : 0)));
8385 /* If we do, then we can just use its DIE, if it exists. */
8386 if (qualified_type)
8388 mod_type_die = lookup_type_die (qualified_type);
8389 if (mod_type_die)
8390 return mod_type_die;
8393 name = qualified_type ? TYPE_NAME (qualified_type) : NULL;
8395 /* Handle C typedef types. */
8396 if (name && TREE_CODE (name) == TYPE_DECL && DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (name))
8398 tree dtype = TREE_TYPE (name);
8400 if (qualified_type == dtype)
8402 /* For a named type, use the typedef. */
8403 gen_type_die (qualified_type, context_die);
8404 return lookup_type_die (qualified_type);
8406 else if (DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (name)
8407 && (is_const_type < TYPE_READONLY (dtype)
8408 || is_volatile_type < TYPE_VOLATILE (dtype)))
8409 /* cv-unqualified version of named type. Just use the unnamed
8410 type to which it refers. */
8411 return modified_type_die (DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (name),
8412 is_const_type, is_volatile_type,
8413 context_die);
8414 /* Else cv-qualified version of named type; fall through. */
8417 if (is_const_type)
8419 mod_type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_const_type, comp_unit_die, type);
8420 sub_die = modified_type_die (type, 0, is_volatile_type, context_die);
8422 else if (is_volatile_type)
8424 mod_type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_volatile_type, comp_unit_die, type);
8425 sub_die = modified_type_die (type, 0, 0, context_die);
8427 else if (code == POINTER_TYPE)
8429 mod_type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_pointer_type, comp_unit_die, type);
8430 add_AT_unsigned (mod_type_die, DW_AT_byte_size,
8431 simple_type_size_in_bits (type) / BITS_PER_UNIT);
8432 item_type = TREE_TYPE (type);
8434 else if (code == REFERENCE_TYPE)
8436 mod_type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_reference_type, comp_unit_die, type);
8437 add_AT_unsigned (mod_type_die, DW_AT_byte_size,
8438 simple_type_size_in_bits (type) / BITS_PER_UNIT);
8439 item_type = TREE_TYPE (type);
8441 else if (is_subrange_type (type))
8443 mod_type_die = subrange_type_die (type, context_die);
8444 item_type = TREE_TYPE (type);
8446 else if (is_base_type (type))
8447 mod_type_die = base_type_die (type);
8448 else
8450 gen_type_die (type, context_die);
8452 /* We have to get the type_main_variant here (and pass that to the
8453 `lookup_type_die' routine) because the ..._TYPE node we have
8454 might simply be a *copy* of some original type node (where the
8455 copy was created to help us keep track of typedef names) and
8456 that copy might have a different TYPE_UID from the original
8457 ..._TYPE node. */
8458 if (TREE_CODE (type) != VECTOR_TYPE)
8459 return lookup_type_die (type_main_variant (type));
8460 else
8461 /* Vectors have the debugging information in the type,
8462 not the main variant. */
8463 return lookup_type_die (type);
8466 /* Builtin types don't have a DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE. For those,
8467 don't output a DW_TAG_typedef, since there isn't one in the
8468 user's program; just attach a DW_AT_name to the type. */
8469 if (name
8470 && (TREE_CODE (name) != TYPE_DECL || TREE_TYPE (name) == qualified_type))
8472 if (TREE_CODE (name) == TYPE_DECL)
8473 /* Could just call add_name_and_src_coords_attributes here,
8474 but since this is a builtin type it doesn't have any
8475 useful source coordinates anyway. */
8476 name = DECL_NAME (name);
8477 add_name_attribute (mod_type_die, IDENTIFIER_POINTER (name));
8480 if (qualified_type)
8481 equate_type_number_to_die (qualified_type, mod_type_die);
8483 if (item_type)
8484 /* We must do this after the equate_type_number_to_die call, in case
8485 this is a recursive type. This ensures that the modified_type_die
8486 recursion will terminate even if the type is recursive. Recursive
8487 types are possible in Ada. */
8488 sub_die = modified_type_die (item_type,
8489 TYPE_READONLY (item_type),
8490 TYPE_VOLATILE (item_type),
8491 context_die);
8493 if (sub_die != NULL)
8494 add_AT_die_ref (mod_type_die, DW_AT_type, sub_die);
8496 return mod_type_die;
8499 /* Given a pointer to an arbitrary ..._TYPE tree node, return true if it is
8500 an enumerated type. */
8502 static inline int
8503 type_is_enum (tree type)
8505 return TREE_CODE (type) == ENUMERAL_TYPE;
8508 /* Return the DBX register number described by a given RTL node. */
8510 static unsigned int
8511 dbx_reg_number (rtx rtl)
8513 unsigned regno = REGNO (rtl);
8515 gcc_assert (regno < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER);
8517 #ifdef LEAF_REG_REMAP
8518 regno = LEAF_REG_REMAP (regno);
8519 #endif
8521 return DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (regno);
8524 /* Optionally add a DW_OP_piece term to a location description expression.
8525 DW_OP_piece is only added if the location description expression already
8526 doesn't end with DW_OP_piece. */
8528 static void
8529 add_loc_descr_op_piece (dw_loc_descr_ref *list_head, int size)
8531 dw_loc_descr_ref loc;
8533 if (*list_head != NULL)
8535 /* Find the end of the chain. */
8536 for (loc = *list_head; loc->dw_loc_next != NULL; loc = loc->dw_loc_next)
8539 if (loc->dw_loc_opc != DW_OP_piece)
8540 loc->dw_loc_next = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_piece, size, 0);
8544 /* Return a location descriptor that designates a machine register or
8545 zero if there is none. */
8547 static dw_loc_descr_ref
8548 reg_loc_descriptor (rtx rtl)
8550 rtx regs;
8552 if (REGNO (rtl) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
8553 return 0;
8555 regs = targetm.dwarf_register_span (rtl);
8557 if (hard_regno_nregs[REGNO (rtl)][GET_MODE (rtl)] > 1 || regs)
8558 return multiple_reg_loc_descriptor (rtl, regs);
8559 else
8560 return one_reg_loc_descriptor (dbx_reg_number (rtl));
8563 /* Return a location descriptor that designates a machine register for
8564 a given hard register number. */
8566 static dw_loc_descr_ref
8567 one_reg_loc_descriptor (unsigned int regno)
8569 if (regno <= 31)
8570 return new_loc_descr (DW_OP_reg0 + regno, 0, 0);
8571 else
8572 return new_loc_descr (DW_OP_regx, regno, 0);
8575 /* Given an RTL of a register, return a location descriptor that
8576 designates a value that spans more than one register. */
8578 static dw_loc_descr_ref
8579 multiple_reg_loc_descriptor (rtx rtl, rtx regs)
8581 int nregs, size, i;
8582 unsigned reg;
8583 dw_loc_descr_ref loc_result = NULL;
8585 reg = REGNO (rtl);
8586 #ifdef LEAF_REG_REMAP
8587 reg = LEAF_REG_REMAP (reg);
8588 #endif
8589 gcc_assert ((unsigned) DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (reg) == dbx_reg_number (rtl));
8590 nregs = hard_regno_nregs[REGNO (rtl)][GET_MODE (rtl)];
8592 /* Simple, contiguous registers. */
8593 if (regs == NULL_RTX)
8595 size = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (rtl)) / nregs;
8597 loc_result = NULL;
8598 while (nregs--)
8600 dw_loc_descr_ref t;
8602 t = one_reg_loc_descriptor (DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (reg));
8603 add_loc_descr (&loc_result, t);
8604 add_loc_descr_op_piece (&loc_result, size);
8605 ++reg;
8607 return loc_result;
8610 /* Now onto stupid register sets in non contiguous locations. */
8612 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (regs) == PARALLEL);
8614 size = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (XVECEXP (regs, 0, 0)));
8615 loc_result = NULL;
8617 for (i = 0; i < XVECLEN (regs, 0); ++i)
8619 dw_loc_descr_ref t;
8621 t = one_reg_loc_descriptor (REGNO (XVECEXP (regs, 0, i)));
8622 add_loc_descr (&loc_result, t);
8623 size = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (XVECEXP (regs, 0, 0)));
8624 add_loc_descr_op_piece (&loc_result, size);
8626 return loc_result;
8629 /* Return a location descriptor that designates a constant. */
8631 static dw_loc_descr_ref
8632 int_loc_descriptor (HOST_WIDE_INT i)
8634 enum dwarf_location_atom op;
8636 /* Pick the smallest representation of a constant, rather than just
8637 defaulting to the LEB encoding. */
8638 if (i >= 0)
8640 if (i <= 31)
8641 op = DW_OP_lit0 + i;
8642 else if (i <= 0xff)
8643 op = DW_OP_const1u;
8644 else if (i <= 0xffff)
8645 op = DW_OP_const2u;
8646 else if (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT == 32
8647 || i <= 0xffffffff)
8648 op = DW_OP_const4u;
8649 else
8650 op = DW_OP_constu;
8652 else
8654 if (i >= -0x80)
8655 op = DW_OP_const1s;
8656 else if (i >= -0x8000)
8657 op = DW_OP_const2s;
8658 else if (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT == 32
8659 || i >= -0x80000000)
8660 op = DW_OP_const4s;
8661 else
8662 op = DW_OP_consts;
8665 return new_loc_descr (op, i, 0);
8668 /* Return a location descriptor that designates a base+offset location. */
8670 static dw_loc_descr_ref
8671 based_loc_descr (rtx reg, HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
8673 unsigned int regno;
8675 /* We only use "frame base" when we're sure we're talking about the
8676 post-prologue local stack frame. We do this by *not* running
8677 register elimination until this point, and recognizing the special
8678 argument pointer and soft frame pointer rtx's. */
8679 if (reg == arg_pointer_rtx || reg == frame_pointer_rtx)
8681 rtx elim = eliminate_regs (reg, VOIDmode, NULL_RTX);
8683 if (elim != reg)
8685 if (GET_CODE (elim) == PLUS)
8687 offset += INTVAL (XEXP (elim, 1));
8688 elim = XEXP (elim, 0);
8690 gcc_assert (elim == (frame_pointer_needed ? hard_frame_pointer_rtx
8691 : stack_pointer_rtx));
8692 offset += frame_pointer_fb_offset;
8694 return new_loc_descr (DW_OP_fbreg, offset, 0);
8698 regno = dbx_reg_number (reg);
8699 if (regno <= 31)
8700 return new_loc_descr (DW_OP_breg0 + regno, offset, 0);
8701 else
8702 return new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bregx, regno, offset);
8705 /* Return true if this RTL expression describes a base+offset calculation. */
8707 static inline int
8708 is_based_loc (rtx rtl)
8710 return (GET_CODE (rtl) == PLUS
8711 && ((REG_P (XEXP (rtl, 0))
8712 && REGNO (XEXP (rtl, 0)) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
8713 && GET_CODE (XEXP (rtl, 1)) == CONST_INT)));
8716 /* The following routine converts the RTL for a variable or parameter
8717 (resident in memory) into an equivalent Dwarf representation of a
8718 mechanism for getting the address of that same variable onto the top of a
8719 hypothetical "address evaluation" stack.
8721 When creating memory location descriptors, we are effectively transforming
8722 the RTL for a memory-resident object into its Dwarf postfix expression
8723 equivalent. This routine recursively descends an RTL tree, turning
8724 it into Dwarf postfix code as it goes.
8726 MODE is the mode of the memory reference, needed to handle some
8727 autoincrement addressing modes.
8729 CAN_USE_FBREG is a flag whether we can use DW_AT_frame_base in the
8730 location list for RTL.
8732 Return 0 if we can't represent the location. */
8734 static dw_loc_descr_ref
8735 mem_loc_descriptor (rtx rtl, enum machine_mode mode)
8737 dw_loc_descr_ref mem_loc_result = NULL;
8738 enum dwarf_location_atom op;
8740 /* Note that for a dynamically sized array, the location we will generate a
8741 description of here will be the lowest numbered location which is
8742 actually within the array. That's *not* necessarily the same as the
8743 zeroth element of the array. */
8745 rtl = targetm.delegitimize_address (rtl);
8747 switch (GET_CODE (rtl))
8749 case POST_INC:
8750 case POST_DEC:
8751 case POST_MODIFY:
8752 /* POST_INC and POST_DEC can be handled just like a SUBREG. So we
8753 just fall into the SUBREG code. */
8755 /* ... fall through ... */
8757 case SUBREG:
8758 /* The case of a subreg may arise when we have a local (register)
8759 variable or a formal (register) parameter which doesn't quite fill
8760 up an entire register. For now, just assume that it is
8761 legitimate to make the Dwarf info refer to the whole register which
8762 contains the given subreg. */
8763 rtl = XEXP (rtl, 0);
8765 /* ... fall through ... */
8767 case REG:
8768 /* Whenever a register number forms a part of the description of the
8769 method for calculating the (dynamic) address of a memory resident
8770 object, DWARF rules require the register number be referred to as
8771 a "base register". This distinction is not based in any way upon
8772 what category of register the hardware believes the given register
8773 belongs to. This is strictly DWARF terminology we're dealing with
8774 here. Note that in cases where the location of a memory-resident
8775 data object could be expressed as: OP_ADD (OP_BASEREG (basereg),
8776 OP_CONST (0)) the actual DWARF location descriptor that we generate
8777 may just be OP_BASEREG (basereg). This may look deceptively like
8778 the object in question was allocated to a register (rather than in
8779 memory) so DWARF consumers need to be aware of the subtle
8780 distinction between OP_REG and OP_BASEREG. */
8781 if (REGNO (rtl) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
8782 mem_loc_result = based_loc_descr (rtl, 0);
8783 break;
8785 case MEM:
8786 mem_loc_result = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), GET_MODE (rtl));
8787 if (mem_loc_result != 0)
8788 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_deref, 0, 0));
8789 break;
8791 case LO_SUM:
8792 rtl = XEXP (rtl, 1);
8794 /* ... fall through ... */
8796 case LABEL_REF:
8797 /* Some ports can transform a symbol ref into a label ref, because
8798 the symbol ref is too far away and has to be dumped into a constant
8799 pool. */
8800 case CONST:
8801 case SYMBOL_REF:
8802 /* Alternatively, the symbol in the constant pool might be referenced
8803 by a different symbol. */
8804 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == SYMBOL_REF && CONSTANT_POOL_ADDRESS_P (rtl))
8806 bool marked;
8807 rtx tmp = get_pool_constant_mark (rtl, &marked);
8809 if (GET_CODE (tmp) == SYMBOL_REF)
8811 rtl = tmp;
8812 if (CONSTANT_POOL_ADDRESS_P (tmp))
8813 get_pool_constant_mark (tmp, &marked);
8814 else
8815 marked = true;
8818 /* If all references to this pool constant were optimized away,
8819 it was not output and thus we can't represent it.
8820 FIXME: might try to use DW_OP_const_value here, though
8821 DW_OP_piece complicates it. */
8822 if (!marked)
8823 return 0;
8826 mem_loc_result = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_addr, 0, 0);
8827 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_addr;
8828 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr = rtl;
8829 VEC_safe_push (rtx, gc, used_rtx_array, rtl);
8830 break;
8832 case PRE_MODIFY:
8833 /* Extract the PLUS expression nested inside and fall into
8834 PLUS code below. */
8835 rtl = XEXP (rtl, 1);
8836 goto plus;
8838 case PRE_INC:
8839 case PRE_DEC:
8840 /* Turn these into a PLUS expression and fall into the PLUS code
8841 below. */
8842 rtl = gen_rtx_PLUS (word_mode, XEXP (rtl, 0),
8843 GEN_INT (GET_CODE (rtl) == PRE_INC
8844 ? GET_MODE_UNIT_SIZE (mode)
8845 : -GET_MODE_UNIT_SIZE (mode)));
8847 /* ... fall through ... */
8849 case PLUS:
8850 plus:
8851 if (is_based_loc (rtl))
8852 mem_loc_result = based_loc_descr (XEXP (rtl, 0),
8853 INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1)));
8854 else
8856 mem_loc_result = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode);
8857 if (mem_loc_result == 0)
8858 break;
8860 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (rtl, 1)) == CONST_INT
8861 && INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1)) >= 0)
8862 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result,
8863 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst,
8864 INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1)), 0));
8865 else
8867 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result,
8868 mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 1), mode));
8869 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result,
8870 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus, 0, 0));
8873 break;
8875 /* If a pseudo-reg is optimized away, it is possible for it to
8876 be replaced with a MEM containing a multiply or shift. */
8877 case MULT:
8878 op = DW_OP_mul;
8879 goto do_binop;
8881 case ASHIFT:
8882 op = DW_OP_shl;
8883 goto do_binop;
8885 case ASHIFTRT:
8886 op = DW_OP_shra;
8887 goto do_binop;
8889 case LSHIFTRT:
8890 op = DW_OP_shr;
8891 goto do_binop;
8893 do_binop:
8895 dw_loc_descr_ref op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode);
8896 dw_loc_descr_ref op1 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 1), mode);
8898 if (op0 == 0 || op1 == 0)
8899 break;
8901 mem_loc_result = op0;
8902 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, op1);
8903 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
8904 break;
8907 case CONST_INT:
8908 mem_loc_result = int_loc_descriptor (INTVAL (rtl));
8909 break;
8911 default:
8912 gcc_unreachable ();
8915 return mem_loc_result;
8918 /* Return a descriptor that describes the concatenation of two locations.
8919 This is typically a complex variable. */
8921 static dw_loc_descr_ref
8922 concat_loc_descriptor (rtx x0, rtx x1)
8924 dw_loc_descr_ref cc_loc_result = NULL;
8925 dw_loc_descr_ref x0_ref = loc_descriptor (x0);
8926 dw_loc_descr_ref x1_ref = loc_descriptor (x1);
8928 if (x0_ref == 0 || x1_ref == 0)
8929 return 0;
8931 cc_loc_result = x0_ref;
8932 add_loc_descr_op_piece (&cc_loc_result, GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (x0)));
8934 add_loc_descr (&cc_loc_result, x1_ref);
8935 add_loc_descr_op_piece (&cc_loc_result, GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (x1)));
8937 return cc_loc_result;
8940 /* Output a proper Dwarf location descriptor for a variable or parameter
8941 which is either allocated in a register or in a memory location. For a
8942 register, we just generate an OP_REG and the register number. For a
8943 memory location we provide a Dwarf postfix expression describing how to
8944 generate the (dynamic) address of the object onto the address stack.
8946 If we don't know how to describe it, return 0. */
8948 static dw_loc_descr_ref
8949 loc_descriptor (rtx rtl)
8951 dw_loc_descr_ref loc_result = NULL;
8953 switch (GET_CODE (rtl))
8955 case SUBREG:
8956 /* The case of a subreg may arise when we have a local (register)
8957 variable or a formal (register) parameter which doesn't quite fill
8958 up an entire register. For now, just assume that it is
8959 legitimate to make the Dwarf info refer to the whole register which
8960 contains the given subreg. */
8961 rtl = SUBREG_REG (rtl);
8963 /* ... fall through ... */
8965 case REG:
8966 loc_result = reg_loc_descriptor (rtl);
8967 break;
8969 case MEM:
8970 loc_result = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), GET_MODE (rtl));
8971 break;
8973 case CONCAT:
8974 loc_result = concat_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), XEXP (rtl, 1));
8975 break;
8977 case VAR_LOCATION:
8978 /* Single part. */
8979 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (rtl, 1)) != PARALLEL)
8981 loc_result = loc_descriptor (XEXP (XEXP (rtl, 1), 0));
8982 break;
8985 rtl = XEXP (rtl, 1);
8986 /* FALLTHRU */
8988 case PARALLEL:
8990 rtvec par_elems = XVEC (rtl, 0);
8991 int num_elem = GET_NUM_ELEM (par_elems);
8992 enum machine_mode mode;
8993 int i;
8995 /* Create the first one, so we have something to add to. */
8996 loc_result = loc_descriptor (XEXP (RTVEC_ELT (par_elems, 0), 0));
8997 mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (RTVEC_ELT (par_elems, 0), 0));
8998 add_loc_descr_op_piece (&loc_result, GET_MODE_SIZE (mode));
8999 for (i = 1; i < num_elem; i++)
9001 dw_loc_descr_ref temp;
9003 temp = loc_descriptor (XEXP (RTVEC_ELT (par_elems, i), 0));
9004 add_loc_descr (&loc_result, temp);
9005 mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (RTVEC_ELT (par_elems, i), 0));
9006 add_loc_descr_op_piece (&loc_result, GET_MODE_SIZE (mode));
9009 break;
9011 default:
9012 gcc_unreachable ();
9015 return loc_result;
9018 /* Similar, but generate the descriptor from trees instead of rtl. This comes
9019 up particularly with variable length arrays. WANT_ADDRESS is 2 if this is
9020 a top-level invocation of loc_descriptor_from_tree; is 1 if this is not a
9021 top-level invocation, and we require the address of LOC; is 0 if we require
9022 the value of LOC. */
9024 static dw_loc_descr_ref
9025 loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (tree loc, int want_address)
9027 dw_loc_descr_ref ret, ret1;
9028 int have_address = 0;
9029 enum dwarf_location_atom op;
9031 /* ??? Most of the time we do not take proper care for sign/zero
9032 extending the values properly. Hopefully this won't be a real
9033 problem... */
9035 switch (TREE_CODE (loc))
9037 case ERROR_MARK:
9038 return 0;
9040 case PLACEHOLDER_EXPR:
9041 /* This case involves extracting fields from an object to determine the
9042 position of other fields. We don't try to encode this here. The
9043 only user of this is Ada, which encodes the needed information using
9044 the names of types. */
9045 return 0;
9047 case CALL_EXPR:
9048 return 0;
9050 case PREINCREMENT_EXPR:
9051 case PREDECREMENT_EXPR:
9052 case POSTINCREMENT_EXPR:
9053 case POSTDECREMENT_EXPR:
9054 /* There are no opcodes for these operations. */
9055 return 0;
9057 case ADDR_EXPR:
9058 /* If we already want an address, there's nothing we can do. */
9059 if (want_address)
9060 return 0;
9062 /* Otherwise, process the argument and look for the address. */
9063 return loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 1);
9065 case VAR_DECL:
9066 if (DECL_THREAD_LOCAL_P (loc))
9068 rtx rtl;
9070 /* If this is not defined, we have no way to emit the data. */
9071 if (!targetm.asm_out.output_dwarf_dtprel)
9072 return 0;
9074 /* The way DW_OP_GNU_push_tls_address is specified, we can only
9075 look up addresses of objects in the current module. */
9076 if (DECL_EXTERNAL (loc))
9077 return 0;
9079 rtl = rtl_for_decl_location (loc);
9080 if (rtl == NULL_RTX)
9081 return 0;
9083 if (!MEM_P (rtl))
9084 return 0;
9085 rtl = XEXP (rtl, 0);
9086 if (! CONSTANT_P (rtl))
9087 return 0;
9089 ret = new_loc_descr (INTERNAL_DW_OP_tls_addr, 0, 0);
9090 ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_addr;
9091 ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr = rtl;
9093 ret1 = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_push_tls_address, 0, 0);
9094 add_loc_descr (&ret, ret1);
9096 have_address = 1;
9097 break;
9099 /* FALLTHRU */
9101 case PARM_DECL:
9102 if (DECL_HAS_VALUE_EXPR_P (loc))
9103 return loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (DECL_VALUE_EXPR (loc),
9104 want_address);
9105 /* FALLTHRU */
9107 case RESULT_DECL:
9109 rtx rtl = rtl_for_decl_location (loc);
9111 if (rtl == NULL_RTX)
9112 return 0;
9113 else if (GET_CODE (rtl) == CONST_INT)
9115 HOST_WIDE_INT val = INTVAL (rtl);
9116 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (loc)))
9117 val &= GET_MODE_MASK (DECL_MODE (loc));
9118 ret = int_loc_descriptor (val);
9120 else if (GET_CODE (rtl) == CONST_STRING)
9121 return 0;
9122 else if (CONSTANT_P (rtl))
9124 ret = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_addr, 0, 0);
9125 ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_addr;
9126 ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr = rtl;
9128 else
9130 enum machine_mode mode;
9132 /* Certain constructs can only be represented at top-level. */
9133 if (want_address == 2)
9134 return loc_descriptor (rtl);
9136 mode = GET_MODE (rtl);
9137 if (MEM_P (rtl))
9139 rtl = XEXP (rtl, 0);
9140 have_address = 1;
9142 ret = mem_loc_descriptor (rtl, mode);
9145 break;
9147 case INDIRECT_REF:
9148 ret = loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 0);
9149 have_address = 1;
9150 break;
9152 case COMPOUND_EXPR:
9153 return loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1), want_address);
9155 case NOP_EXPR:
9156 case CONVERT_EXPR:
9157 case NON_LVALUE_EXPR:
9158 case VIEW_CONVERT_EXPR:
9159 case SAVE_EXPR:
9160 case MODIFY_EXPR:
9161 return loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), want_address);
9163 case COMPONENT_REF:
9164 case BIT_FIELD_REF:
9165 case ARRAY_REF:
9166 case ARRAY_RANGE_REF:
9168 tree obj, offset;
9169 HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize, bitpos, bytepos;
9170 enum machine_mode mode;
9171 int volatilep;
9172 int unsignedp = TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (loc));
9174 obj = get_inner_reference (loc, &bitsize, &bitpos, &offset, &mode,
9175 &unsignedp, &volatilep, false);
9177 if (obj == loc)
9178 return 0;
9180 ret = loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (obj, 1);
9181 if (ret == 0
9182 || bitpos % BITS_PER_UNIT != 0 || bitsize % BITS_PER_UNIT != 0)
9183 return 0;
9185 if (offset != NULL_TREE)
9187 /* Variable offset. */
9188 add_loc_descr (&ret, loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (offset, 0));
9189 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus, 0, 0));
9192 bytepos = bitpos / BITS_PER_UNIT;
9193 if (bytepos > 0)
9194 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst, bytepos, 0));
9195 else if (bytepos < 0)
9197 add_loc_descr (&ret, int_loc_descriptor (bytepos));
9198 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus, 0, 0));
9201 have_address = 1;
9202 break;
9205 case INTEGER_CST:
9206 if (host_integerp (loc, 0))
9207 ret = int_loc_descriptor (tree_low_cst (loc, 0));
9208 else
9209 return 0;
9210 break;
9212 case CONSTRUCTOR:
9214 /* Get an RTL for this, if something has been emitted. */
9215 rtx rtl = lookup_constant_def (loc);
9216 enum machine_mode mode;
9218 if (!rtl || !MEM_P (rtl))
9219 return 0;
9220 mode = GET_MODE (rtl);
9221 rtl = XEXP (rtl, 0);
9222 ret = mem_loc_descriptor (rtl, mode);
9223 have_address = 1;
9224 break;
9227 case TRUTH_AND_EXPR:
9228 case TRUTH_ANDIF_EXPR:
9229 case BIT_AND_EXPR:
9230 op = DW_OP_and;
9231 goto do_binop;
9233 case TRUTH_XOR_EXPR:
9234 case BIT_XOR_EXPR:
9235 op = DW_OP_xor;
9236 goto do_binop;
9238 case TRUTH_OR_EXPR:
9239 case TRUTH_ORIF_EXPR:
9240 case BIT_IOR_EXPR:
9241 op = DW_OP_or;
9242 goto do_binop;
9244 case FLOOR_DIV_EXPR:
9245 case CEIL_DIV_EXPR:
9246 case ROUND_DIV_EXPR:
9247 case TRUNC_DIV_EXPR:
9248 op = DW_OP_div;
9249 goto do_binop;
9251 case MINUS_EXPR:
9252 op = DW_OP_minus;
9253 goto do_binop;
9255 case FLOOR_MOD_EXPR:
9256 case CEIL_MOD_EXPR:
9257 case ROUND_MOD_EXPR:
9258 case TRUNC_MOD_EXPR:
9259 op = DW_OP_mod;
9260 goto do_binop;
9262 case MULT_EXPR:
9263 op = DW_OP_mul;
9264 goto do_binop;
9266 case LSHIFT_EXPR:
9267 op = DW_OP_shl;
9268 goto do_binop;
9270 case RSHIFT_EXPR:
9271 op = (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (loc)) ? DW_OP_shr : DW_OP_shra);
9272 goto do_binop;
9274 case PLUS_EXPR:
9275 if (TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1)) == INTEGER_CST
9276 && host_integerp (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1), 0))
9278 ret = loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 0);
9279 if (ret == 0)
9280 return 0;
9282 add_loc_descr (&ret,
9283 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst,
9284 tree_low_cst (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1),
9286 0));
9287 break;
9290 op = DW_OP_plus;
9291 goto do_binop;
9293 case LE_EXPR:
9294 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0))))
9295 return 0;
9297 op = DW_OP_le;
9298 goto do_binop;
9300 case GE_EXPR:
9301 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0))))
9302 return 0;
9304 op = DW_OP_ge;
9305 goto do_binop;
9307 case LT_EXPR:
9308 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0))))
9309 return 0;
9311 op = DW_OP_lt;
9312 goto do_binop;
9314 case GT_EXPR:
9315 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0))))
9316 return 0;
9318 op = DW_OP_gt;
9319 goto do_binop;
9321 case EQ_EXPR:
9322 op = DW_OP_eq;
9323 goto do_binop;
9325 case NE_EXPR:
9326 op = DW_OP_ne;
9327 goto do_binop;
9329 do_binop:
9330 ret = loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 0);
9331 ret1 = loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1), 0);
9332 if (ret == 0 || ret1 == 0)
9333 return 0;
9335 add_loc_descr (&ret, ret1);
9336 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
9337 break;
9339 case TRUTH_NOT_EXPR:
9340 case BIT_NOT_EXPR:
9341 op = DW_OP_not;
9342 goto do_unop;
9344 case ABS_EXPR:
9345 op = DW_OP_abs;
9346 goto do_unop;
9348 case NEGATE_EXPR:
9349 op = DW_OP_neg;
9350 goto do_unop;
9352 do_unop:
9353 ret = loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 0);
9354 if (ret == 0)
9355 return 0;
9357 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
9358 break;
9360 case MIN_EXPR:
9361 case MAX_EXPR:
9363 const enum tree_code code =
9364 TREE_CODE (loc) == MIN_EXPR ? GT_EXPR : LT_EXPR;
9366 loc = build3 (COND_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (loc),
9367 build2 (code, integer_type_node,
9368 TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1)),
9369 TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1), TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0));
9372 /* ... fall through ... */
9374 case COND_EXPR:
9376 dw_loc_descr_ref lhs
9377 = loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1), 0);
9378 dw_loc_descr_ref rhs
9379 = loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 2), 0);
9380 dw_loc_descr_ref bra_node, jump_node, tmp;
9382 ret = loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 0);
9383 if (ret == 0 || lhs == 0 || rhs == 0)
9384 return 0;
9386 bra_node = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bra, 0, 0);
9387 add_loc_descr (&ret, bra_node);
9389 add_loc_descr (&ret, rhs);
9390 jump_node = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_skip, 0, 0);
9391 add_loc_descr (&ret, jump_node);
9393 add_loc_descr (&ret, lhs);
9394 bra_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
9395 bra_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = lhs;
9397 /* ??? Need a node to point the skip at. Use a nop. */
9398 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_nop, 0, 0);
9399 add_loc_descr (&ret, tmp);
9400 jump_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
9401 jump_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = tmp;
9403 break;
9405 case FIX_TRUNC_EXPR:
9406 case FIX_CEIL_EXPR:
9407 case FIX_FLOOR_EXPR:
9408 case FIX_ROUND_EXPR:
9409 return 0;
9411 default:
9412 /* Leave front-end specific codes as simply unknown. This comes
9413 up, for instance, with the C STMT_EXPR. */
9414 if ((unsigned int) TREE_CODE (loc)
9415 >= (unsigned int) LAST_AND_UNUSED_TREE_CODE)
9416 return 0;
9418 #ifdef ENABLE_CHECKING
9419 /* Otherwise this is a generic code; we should just lists all of
9420 these explicitly. We forgot one. */
9421 gcc_unreachable ();
9422 #else
9423 /* In a release build, we want to degrade gracefully: better to
9424 generate incomplete debugging information than to crash. */
9425 return NULL;
9426 #endif
9429 /* Show if we can't fill the request for an address. */
9430 if (want_address && !have_address)
9431 return 0;
9433 /* If we've got an address and don't want one, dereference. */
9434 if (!want_address && have_address && ret)
9436 HOST_WIDE_INT size = int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (loc));
9438 if (size > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE || size == -1)
9439 return 0;
9440 else if (size == DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
9441 op = DW_OP_deref;
9442 else
9443 op = DW_OP_deref_size;
9445 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (op, size, 0));
9448 return ret;
9451 static inline dw_loc_descr_ref
9452 loc_descriptor_from_tree (tree loc)
9454 return loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (loc, 2);
9457 /* Given a value, round it up to the lowest multiple of `boundary'
9458 which is not less than the value itself. */
9460 static inline HOST_WIDE_INT
9461 ceiling (HOST_WIDE_INT value, unsigned int boundary)
9463 return (((value + boundary - 1) / boundary) * boundary);
9466 /* Given a pointer to what is assumed to be a FIELD_DECL node, return a
9467 pointer to the declared type for the relevant field variable, or return
9468 `integer_type_node' if the given node turns out to be an
9469 ERROR_MARK node. */
9471 static inline tree
9472 field_type (tree decl)
9474 tree type;
9476 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == ERROR_MARK)
9477 return integer_type_node;
9479 type = DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (decl);
9480 if (type == NULL_TREE)
9481 type = TREE_TYPE (decl);
9483 return type;
9486 /* Given a pointer to a tree node, return the alignment in bits for
9487 it, or else return BITS_PER_WORD if the node actually turns out to
9488 be an ERROR_MARK node. */
9490 static inline unsigned
9491 simple_type_align_in_bits (tree type)
9493 return (TREE_CODE (type) != ERROR_MARK) ? TYPE_ALIGN (type) : BITS_PER_WORD;
9496 static inline unsigned
9497 simple_decl_align_in_bits (tree decl)
9499 return (TREE_CODE (decl) != ERROR_MARK) ? DECL_ALIGN (decl) : BITS_PER_WORD;
9502 /* Given a pointer to a FIELD_DECL, compute and return the byte offset of the
9503 lowest addressed byte of the "containing object" for the given FIELD_DECL,
9504 or return 0 if we are unable to determine what that offset is, either
9505 because the argument turns out to be a pointer to an ERROR_MARK node, or
9506 because the offset is actually variable. (We can't handle the latter case
9507 just yet). */
9509 static HOST_WIDE_INT
9510 field_byte_offset (tree decl)
9512 unsigned int type_align_in_bits;
9513 unsigned int decl_align_in_bits;
9514 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT type_size_in_bits;
9515 HOST_WIDE_INT object_offset_in_bits;
9516 tree type;
9517 tree field_size_tree;
9518 HOST_WIDE_INT bitpos_int;
9519 HOST_WIDE_INT deepest_bitpos;
9520 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT field_size_in_bits;
9522 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == ERROR_MARK)
9523 return 0;
9525 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (decl) == FIELD_DECL);
9527 type = field_type (decl);
9528 field_size_tree = DECL_SIZE (decl);
9530 /* The size could be unspecified if there was an error, or for
9531 a flexible array member. */
9532 if (! field_size_tree)
9533 field_size_tree = bitsize_zero_node;
9535 /* We cannot yet cope with fields whose positions are variable, so
9536 for now, when we see such things, we simply return 0. Someday, we may
9537 be able to handle such cases, but it will be damn difficult. */
9538 if (! host_integerp (bit_position (decl), 0))
9539 return 0;
9541 bitpos_int = int_bit_position (decl);
9543 /* If we don't know the size of the field, pretend it's a full word. */
9544 if (host_integerp (field_size_tree, 1))
9545 field_size_in_bits = tree_low_cst (field_size_tree, 1);
9546 else
9547 field_size_in_bits = BITS_PER_WORD;
9549 type_size_in_bits = simple_type_size_in_bits (type);
9550 type_align_in_bits = simple_type_align_in_bits (type);
9551 decl_align_in_bits = simple_decl_align_in_bits (decl);
9553 /* The GCC front-end doesn't make any attempt to keep track of the starting
9554 bit offset (relative to the start of the containing structure type) of the
9555 hypothetical "containing object" for a bit-field. Thus, when computing
9556 the byte offset value for the start of the "containing object" of a
9557 bit-field, we must deduce this information on our own. This can be rather
9558 tricky to do in some cases. For example, handling the following structure
9559 type definition when compiling for an i386/i486 target (which only aligns
9560 long long's to 32-bit boundaries) can be very tricky:
9562 struct S { int field1; long long field2:31; };
9564 Fortunately, there is a simple rule-of-thumb which can be used in such
9565 cases. When compiling for an i386/i486, GCC will allocate 8 bytes for the
9566 structure shown above. It decides to do this based upon one simple rule
9567 for bit-field allocation. GCC allocates each "containing object" for each
9568 bit-field at the first (i.e. lowest addressed) legitimate alignment
9569 boundary (based upon the required minimum alignment for the declared type
9570 of the field) which it can possibly use, subject to the condition that
9571 there is still enough available space remaining in the containing object
9572 (when allocated at the selected point) to fully accommodate all of the
9573 bits of the bit-field itself.
9575 This simple rule makes it obvious why GCC allocates 8 bytes for each
9576 object of the structure type shown above. When looking for a place to
9577 allocate the "containing object" for `field2', the compiler simply tries
9578 to allocate a 64-bit "containing object" at each successive 32-bit
9579 boundary (starting at zero) until it finds a place to allocate that 64-
9580 bit field such that at least 31 contiguous (and previously unallocated)
9581 bits remain within that selected 64 bit field. (As it turns out, for the
9582 example above, the compiler finds it is OK to allocate the "containing
9583 object" 64-bit field at bit-offset zero within the structure type.)
9585 Here we attempt to work backwards from the limited set of facts we're
9586 given, and we try to deduce from those facts, where GCC must have believed
9587 that the containing object started (within the structure type). The value
9588 we deduce is then used (by the callers of this routine) to generate
9589 DW_AT_location and DW_AT_bit_offset attributes for fields (both bit-fields
9590 and, in the case of DW_AT_location, regular fields as well). */
9592 /* Figure out the bit-distance from the start of the structure to the
9593 "deepest" bit of the bit-field. */
9594 deepest_bitpos = bitpos_int + field_size_in_bits;
9596 /* This is the tricky part. Use some fancy footwork to deduce where the
9597 lowest addressed bit of the containing object must be. */
9598 object_offset_in_bits = deepest_bitpos - type_size_in_bits;
9600 /* Round up to type_align by default. This works best for bitfields. */
9601 object_offset_in_bits += type_align_in_bits - 1;
9602 object_offset_in_bits /= type_align_in_bits;
9603 object_offset_in_bits *= type_align_in_bits;
9605 if (object_offset_in_bits > bitpos_int)
9607 /* Sigh, the decl must be packed. */
9608 object_offset_in_bits = deepest_bitpos - type_size_in_bits;
9610 /* Round up to decl_align instead. */
9611 object_offset_in_bits += decl_align_in_bits - 1;
9612 object_offset_in_bits /= decl_align_in_bits;
9613 object_offset_in_bits *= decl_align_in_bits;
9616 return object_offset_in_bits / BITS_PER_UNIT;
9619 /* The following routines define various Dwarf attributes and any data
9620 associated with them. */
9622 /* Add a location description attribute value to a DIE.
9624 This emits location attributes suitable for whole variables and
9625 whole parameters. Note that the location attributes for struct fields are
9626 generated by the routine `data_member_location_attribute' below. */
9628 static inline void
9629 add_AT_location_description (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
9630 dw_loc_descr_ref descr)
9632 if (descr != 0)
9633 add_AT_loc (die, attr_kind, descr);
9636 /* Attach the specialized form of location attribute used for data members of
9637 struct and union types. In the special case of a FIELD_DECL node which
9638 represents a bit-field, the "offset" part of this special location
9639 descriptor must indicate the distance in bytes from the lowest-addressed
9640 byte of the containing struct or union type to the lowest-addressed byte of
9641 the "containing object" for the bit-field. (See the `field_byte_offset'
9642 function above).
9644 For any given bit-field, the "containing object" is a hypothetical object
9645 (of some integral or enum type) within which the given bit-field lives. The
9646 type of this hypothetical "containing object" is always the same as the
9647 declared type of the individual bit-field itself (for GCC anyway... the
9648 DWARF spec doesn't actually mandate this). Note that it is the size (in
9649 bytes) of the hypothetical "containing object" which will be given in the
9650 DW_AT_byte_size attribute for this bit-field. (See the
9651 `byte_size_attribute' function below.) It is also used when calculating the
9652 value of the DW_AT_bit_offset attribute. (See the `bit_offset_attribute'
9653 function below.) */
9655 static void
9656 add_data_member_location_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree decl)
9658 HOST_WIDE_INT offset;
9659 dw_loc_descr_ref loc_descr = 0;
9661 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == TREE_BINFO)
9663 /* We're working on the TAG_inheritance for a base class. */
9664 if (BINFO_VIRTUAL_P (decl) && is_cxx ())
9666 /* For C++ virtual bases we can't just use BINFO_OFFSET, as they
9667 aren't at a fixed offset from all (sub)objects of the same
9668 type. We need to extract the appropriate offset from our
9669 vtable. The following dwarf expression means
9671 BaseAddr = ObAddr + *((*ObAddr) - Offset)
9673 This is specific to the V3 ABI, of course. */
9675 dw_loc_descr_ref tmp;
9677 /* Make a copy of the object address. */
9678 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_dup, 0, 0);
9679 add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, tmp);
9681 /* Extract the vtable address. */
9682 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_deref, 0, 0);
9683 add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, tmp);
9685 /* Calculate the address of the offset. */
9686 offset = tree_low_cst (BINFO_VPTR_FIELD (decl), 0);
9687 gcc_assert (offset < 0);
9689 tmp = int_loc_descriptor (-offset);
9690 add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, tmp);
9691 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_minus, 0, 0);
9692 add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, tmp);
9694 /* Extract the offset. */
9695 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_deref, 0, 0);
9696 add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, tmp);
9698 /* Add it to the object address. */
9699 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus, 0, 0);
9700 add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, tmp);
9702 else
9703 offset = tree_low_cst (BINFO_OFFSET (decl), 0);
9705 else
9706 offset = field_byte_offset (decl);
9708 if (! loc_descr)
9710 enum dwarf_location_atom op;
9712 /* The DWARF2 standard says that we should assume that the structure
9713 address is already on the stack, so we can specify a structure field
9714 address by using DW_OP_plus_uconst. */
9716 #ifdef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
9717 /* ??? The SGI dwarf reader does not handle the DW_OP_plus_uconst
9718 operator correctly. It works only if we leave the offset on the
9719 stack. */
9720 op = DW_OP_constu;
9721 #else
9722 op = DW_OP_plus_uconst;
9723 #endif
9725 loc_descr = new_loc_descr (op, offset, 0);
9728 add_AT_loc (die, DW_AT_data_member_location, loc_descr);
9731 /* Writes integer values to dw_vec_const array. */
9733 static void
9734 insert_int (HOST_WIDE_INT val, unsigned int size, unsigned char *dest)
9736 while (size != 0)
9738 *dest++ = val & 0xff;
9739 val >>= 8;
9740 --size;
9744 /* Reads integers from dw_vec_const array. Inverse of insert_int. */
9746 static HOST_WIDE_INT
9747 extract_int (const unsigned char *src, unsigned int size)
9749 HOST_WIDE_INT val = 0;
9751 src += size;
9752 while (size != 0)
9754 val <<= 8;
9755 val |= *--src & 0xff;
9756 --size;
9758 return val;
9761 /* Writes floating point values to dw_vec_const array. */
9763 static void
9764 insert_float (rtx rtl, unsigned char *array)
9766 REAL_VALUE_TYPE rv;
9767 long val[4];
9768 int i;
9770 REAL_VALUE_FROM_CONST_DOUBLE (rv, rtl);
9771 real_to_target (val, &rv, GET_MODE (rtl));
9773 /* real_to_target puts 32-bit pieces in each long. Pack them. */
9774 for (i = 0; i < GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (rtl)) / 4; i++)
9776 insert_int (val[i], 4, array);
9777 array += 4;
9781 /* Attach a DW_AT_const_value attribute for a variable or a parameter which
9782 does not have a "location" either in memory or in a register. These
9783 things can arise in GNU C when a constant is passed as an actual parameter
9784 to an inlined function. They can also arise in C++ where declared
9785 constants do not necessarily get memory "homes". */
9787 static void
9788 add_const_value_attribute (dw_die_ref die, rtx rtl)
9790 switch (GET_CODE (rtl))
9792 case CONST_INT:
9794 HOST_WIDE_INT val = INTVAL (rtl);
9796 if (val < 0)
9797 add_AT_int (die, DW_AT_const_value, val);
9798 else
9799 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_const_value, (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) val);
9801 break;
9803 case CONST_DOUBLE:
9804 /* Note that a CONST_DOUBLE rtx could represent either an integer or a
9805 floating-point constant. A CONST_DOUBLE is used whenever the
9806 constant requires more than one word in order to be adequately
9807 represented. We output CONST_DOUBLEs as blocks. */
9809 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (rtl);
9811 if (SCALAR_FLOAT_MODE_P (mode))
9813 unsigned int length = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
9814 unsigned char *array = ggc_alloc (length);
9816 insert_float (rtl, array);
9817 add_AT_vec (die, DW_AT_const_value, length / 4, 4, array);
9819 else
9821 /* ??? We really should be using HOST_WIDE_INT throughout. */
9822 gcc_assert (HOST_BITS_PER_LONG == HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT);
9824 add_AT_long_long (die, DW_AT_const_value,
9825 CONST_DOUBLE_HIGH (rtl), CONST_DOUBLE_LOW (rtl));
9828 break;
9830 case CONST_VECTOR:
9832 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (rtl);
9833 unsigned int elt_size = GET_MODE_UNIT_SIZE (mode);
9834 unsigned int length = CONST_VECTOR_NUNITS (rtl);
9835 unsigned char *array = ggc_alloc (length * elt_size);
9836 unsigned int i;
9837 unsigned char *p;
9839 switch (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode))
9841 case MODE_VECTOR_INT:
9842 for (i = 0, p = array; i < length; i++, p += elt_size)
9844 rtx elt = CONST_VECTOR_ELT (rtl, i);
9845 HOST_WIDE_INT lo, hi;
9847 switch (GET_CODE (elt))
9849 case CONST_INT:
9850 lo = INTVAL (elt);
9851 hi = -(lo < 0);
9852 break;
9854 case CONST_DOUBLE:
9855 lo = CONST_DOUBLE_LOW (elt);
9856 hi = CONST_DOUBLE_HIGH (elt);
9857 break;
9859 default:
9860 gcc_unreachable ();
9863 if (elt_size <= sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT))
9864 insert_int (lo, elt_size, p);
9865 else
9867 unsigned char *p0 = p;
9868 unsigned char *p1 = p + sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT);
9870 gcc_assert (elt_size == 2 * sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT));
9871 if (WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN)
9873 p0 = p1;
9874 p1 = p;
9876 insert_int (lo, sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT), p0);
9877 insert_int (hi, sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT), p1);
9880 break;
9882 case MODE_VECTOR_FLOAT:
9883 for (i = 0, p = array; i < length; i++, p += elt_size)
9885 rtx elt = CONST_VECTOR_ELT (rtl, i);
9886 insert_float (elt, p);
9888 break;
9890 default:
9891 gcc_unreachable ();
9894 add_AT_vec (die, DW_AT_const_value, length, elt_size, array);
9896 break;
9898 case CONST_STRING:
9899 add_AT_string (die, DW_AT_const_value, XSTR (rtl, 0));
9900 break;
9902 case SYMBOL_REF:
9903 case LABEL_REF:
9904 case CONST:
9905 add_AT_addr (die, DW_AT_const_value, rtl);
9906 VEC_safe_push (rtx, gc, used_rtx_array, rtl);
9907 break;
9909 case PLUS:
9910 /* In cases where an inlined instance of an inline function is passed
9911 the address of an `auto' variable (which is local to the caller) we
9912 can get a situation where the DECL_RTL of the artificial local
9913 variable (for the inlining) which acts as a stand-in for the
9914 corresponding formal parameter (of the inline function) will look
9915 like (plus:SI (reg:SI FRAME_PTR) (const_int ...)). This is not
9916 exactly a compile-time constant expression, but it isn't the address
9917 of the (artificial) local variable either. Rather, it represents the
9918 *value* which the artificial local variable always has during its
9919 lifetime. We currently have no way to represent such quasi-constant
9920 values in Dwarf, so for now we just punt and generate nothing. */
9921 break;
9923 default:
9924 /* No other kinds of rtx should be possible here. */
9925 gcc_unreachable ();
9930 /* Generate an RTL constant from a decl initializer INIT with decl type TYPE,
9931 for use in a later add_const_value_attribute call. */
9933 static rtx
9934 rtl_for_decl_init (tree init, tree type)
9936 rtx rtl = NULL_RTX;
9938 /* If a variable is initialized with a string constant without embedded
9939 zeros, build CONST_STRING. */
9940 if (TREE_CODE (init) == STRING_CST && TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE)
9942 tree enttype = TREE_TYPE (type);
9943 tree domain = TYPE_DOMAIN (type);
9944 enum machine_mode mode = TYPE_MODE (enttype);
9946 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT && GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) == 1
9947 && domain
9948 && integer_zerop (TYPE_MIN_VALUE (domain))
9949 && compare_tree_int (TYPE_MAX_VALUE (domain),
9950 TREE_STRING_LENGTH (init) - 1) == 0
9951 && ((size_t) TREE_STRING_LENGTH (init)
9952 == strlen (TREE_STRING_POINTER (init)) + 1))
9953 rtl = gen_rtx_CONST_STRING (VOIDmode,
9954 ggc_strdup (TREE_STRING_POINTER (init)));
9956 /* If the initializer is something that we know will expand into an
9957 immediate RTL constant, expand it now. Expanding anything else
9958 tends to produce unresolved symbols; see debug/5770 and c++/6381. */
9959 /* Aggregate, vector, and complex types may contain constructors that may
9960 result in code being generated when expand_expr is called, so we can't
9961 handle them here. Integer and float are useful and safe types to handle
9962 here. */
9963 else if ((INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (type) || SCALAR_FLOAT_TYPE_P (type))
9964 && initializer_constant_valid_p (init, type) == null_pointer_node)
9966 rtl = expand_expr (init, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, EXPAND_INITIALIZER);
9968 /* If expand_expr returns a MEM, it wasn't immediate. */
9969 gcc_assert (!rtl || !MEM_P (rtl));
9972 return rtl;
9975 /* Generate RTL for the variable DECL to represent its location. */
9977 static rtx
9978 rtl_for_decl_location (tree decl)
9980 rtx rtl;
9982 /* Here we have to decide where we are going to say the parameter "lives"
9983 (as far as the debugger is concerned). We only have a couple of
9984 choices. GCC provides us with DECL_RTL and with DECL_INCOMING_RTL.
9986 DECL_RTL normally indicates where the parameter lives during most of the
9987 activation of the function. If optimization is enabled however, this
9988 could be either NULL or else a pseudo-reg. Both of those cases indicate
9989 that the parameter doesn't really live anywhere (as far as the code
9990 generation parts of GCC are concerned) during most of the function's
9991 activation. That will happen (for example) if the parameter is never
9992 referenced within the function.
9994 We could just generate a location descriptor here for all non-NULL
9995 non-pseudo values of DECL_RTL and ignore all of the rest, but we can be
9996 a little nicer than that if we also consider DECL_INCOMING_RTL in cases
9997 where DECL_RTL is NULL or is a pseudo-reg.
9999 Note however that we can only get away with using DECL_INCOMING_RTL as
10000 a backup substitute for DECL_RTL in certain limited cases. In cases
10001 where DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) indicates the same type as TREE_TYPE (decl),
10002 we can be sure that the parameter was passed using the same type as it is
10003 declared to have within the function, and that its DECL_INCOMING_RTL
10004 points us to a place where a value of that type is passed.
10006 In cases where DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) and TREE_TYPE (decl) are different,
10007 we cannot (in general) use DECL_INCOMING_RTL as a substitute for DECL_RTL
10008 because in these cases DECL_INCOMING_RTL points us to a value of some
10009 type which is *different* from the type of the parameter itself. Thus,
10010 if we tried to use DECL_INCOMING_RTL to generate a location attribute in
10011 such cases, the debugger would end up (for example) trying to fetch a
10012 `float' from a place which actually contains the first part of a
10013 `double'. That would lead to really incorrect and confusing
10014 output at debug-time.
10016 So, in general, we *do not* use DECL_INCOMING_RTL as a backup for DECL_RTL
10017 in cases where DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) != TREE_TYPE (decl). There
10018 are a couple of exceptions however. On little-endian machines we can
10019 get away with using DECL_INCOMING_RTL even when DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) is
10020 not the same as TREE_TYPE (decl), but only when DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) is
10021 an integral type that is smaller than TREE_TYPE (decl). These cases arise
10022 when (on a little-endian machine) a non-prototyped function has a
10023 parameter declared to be of type `short' or `char'. In such cases,
10024 TREE_TYPE (decl) will be `short' or `char', DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) will
10025 be `int', and DECL_INCOMING_RTL will point to the lowest-order byte of the
10026 passed `int' value. If the debugger then uses that address to fetch
10027 a `short' or a `char' (on a little-endian machine) the result will be
10028 the correct data, so we allow for such exceptional cases below.
10030 Note that our goal here is to describe the place where the given formal
10031 parameter lives during most of the function's activation (i.e. between the
10032 end of the prologue and the start of the epilogue). We'll do that as best
10033 as we can. Note however that if the given formal parameter is modified
10034 sometime during the execution of the function, then a stack backtrace (at
10035 debug-time) will show the function as having been called with the *new*
10036 value rather than the value which was originally passed in. This happens
10037 rarely enough that it is not a major problem, but it *is* a problem, and
10038 I'd like to fix it.
10040 A future version of dwarf2out.c may generate two additional attributes for
10041 any given DW_TAG_formal_parameter DIE which will describe the "passed
10042 type" and the "passed location" for the given formal parameter in addition
10043 to the attributes we now generate to indicate the "declared type" and the
10044 "active location" for each parameter. This additional set of attributes
10045 could be used by debuggers for stack backtraces. Separately, note that
10046 sometimes DECL_RTL can be NULL and DECL_INCOMING_RTL can be NULL also.
10047 This happens (for example) for inlined-instances of inline function formal
10048 parameters which are never referenced. This really shouldn't be
10049 happening. All PARM_DECL nodes should get valid non-NULL
10050 DECL_INCOMING_RTL values. FIXME. */
10052 /* Use DECL_RTL as the "location" unless we find something better. */
10053 rtl = DECL_RTL_IF_SET (decl);
10055 /* When generating abstract instances, ignore everything except
10056 constants, symbols living in memory, and symbols living in
10057 fixed registers. */
10058 if (! reload_completed)
10060 if (rtl
10061 && (CONSTANT_P (rtl)
10062 || (MEM_P (rtl)
10063 && CONSTANT_P (XEXP (rtl, 0)))
10064 || (REG_P (rtl)
10065 && TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL
10066 && TREE_STATIC (decl))))
10068 rtl = targetm.delegitimize_address (rtl);
10069 return rtl;
10071 rtl = NULL_RTX;
10073 else if (TREE_CODE (decl) == PARM_DECL)
10075 if (rtl == NULL_RTX || is_pseudo_reg (rtl))
10077 tree declared_type = TREE_TYPE (decl);
10078 tree passed_type = DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl);
10079 enum machine_mode dmode = TYPE_MODE (declared_type);
10080 enum machine_mode pmode = TYPE_MODE (passed_type);
10082 /* This decl represents a formal parameter which was optimized out.
10083 Note that DECL_INCOMING_RTL may be NULL in here, but we handle
10084 all cases where (rtl == NULL_RTX) just below. */
10085 if (dmode == pmode)
10086 rtl = DECL_INCOMING_RTL (decl);
10087 else if (SCALAR_INT_MODE_P (dmode)
10088 && GET_MODE_SIZE (dmode) <= GET_MODE_SIZE (pmode)
10089 && DECL_INCOMING_RTL (decl))
10091 rtx inc = DECL_INCOMING_RTL (decl);
10092 if (REG_P (inc))
10093 rtl = inc;
10094 else if (MEM_P (inc))
10096 if (BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN)
10097 rtl = adjust_address_nv (inc, dmode,
10098 GET_MODE_SIZE (pmode)
10099 - GET_MODE_SIZE (dmode));
10100 else
10101 rtl = inc;
10106 /* If the parm was passed in registers, but lives on the stack, then
10107 make a big endian correction if the mode of the type of the
10108 parameter is not the same as the mode of the rtl. */
10109 /* ??? This is the same series of checks that are made in dbxout.c before
10110 we reach the big endian correction code there. It isn't clear if all
10111 of these checks are necessary here, but keeping them all is the safe
10112 thing to do. */
10113 else if (MEM_P (rtl)
10114 && XEXP (rtl, 0) != const0_rtx
10115 && ! CONSTANT_P (XEXP (rtl, 0))
10116 /* Not passed in memory. */
10117 && !MEM_P (DECL_INCOMING_RTL (decl))
10118 /* Not passed by invisible reference. */
10119 && (!REG_P (XEXP (rtl, 0))
10120 || REGNO (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
10121 || REGNO (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
10122 #if ARG_POINTER_REGNUM != HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
10123 || REGNO (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == ARG_POINTER_REGNUM
10124 #endif
10126 /* Big endian correction check. */
10127 && BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
10128 && TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)) != GET_MODE (rtl)
10129 && (GET_MODE_SIZE (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)))
10130 < UNITS_PER_WORD))
10132 int offset = (UNITS_PER_WORD
10133 - GET_MODE_SIZE (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl))));
10135 rtl = gen_rtx_MEM (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)),
10136 plus_constant (XEXP (rtl, 0), offset));
10139 else if (TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL
10140 && rtl
10141 && MEM_P (rtl)
10142 && GET_MODE (rtl) != TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl))
10143 && BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN)
10145 int rsize = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (rtl));
10146 int dsize = GET_MODE_SIZE (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)));
10148 /* If a variable is declared "register" yet is smaller than
10149 a register, then if we store the variable to memory, it
10150 looks like we're storing a register-sized value, when in
10151 fact we are not. We need to adjust the offset of the
10152 storage location to reflect the actual value's bytes,
10153 else gdb will not be able to display it. */
10154 if (rsize > dsize)
10155 rtl = gen_rtx_MEM (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)),
10156 plus_constant (XEXP (rtl, 0), rsize-dsize));
10159 /* A variable with no DECL_RTL but a DECL_INITIAL is a compile-time constant,
10160 and will have been substituted directly into all expressions that use it.
10161 C does not have such a concept, but C++ and other languages do. */
10162 if (!rtl && TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL && DECL_INITIAL (decl))
10163 rtl = rtl_for_decl_init (DECL_INITIAL (decl), TREE_TYPE (decl));
10165 if (rtl)
10166 rtl = targetm.delegitimize_address (rtl);
10168 /* If we don't look past the constant pool, we risk emitting a
10169 reference to a constant pool entry that isn't referenced from
10170 code, and thus is not emitted. */
10171 if (rtl)
10172 rtl = avoid_constant_pool_reference (rtl);
10174 return rtl;
10177 /* We need to figure out what section we should use as the base for the
10178 address ranges where a given location is valid.
10179 1. If this particular DECL has a section associated with it, use that.
10180 2. If this function has a section associated with it, use that.
10181 3. Otherwise, use the text section.
10182 XXX: If you split a variable across multiple sections, we won't notice. */
10184 static const char *
10185 secname_for_decl (tree decl)
10187 const char *secname;
10189 if (VAR_OR_FUNCTION_DECL_P (decl) && DECL_SECTION_NAME (decl))
10191 tree sectree = DECL_SECTION_NAME (decl);
10192 secname = TREE_STRING_POINTER (sectree);
10194 else if (current_function_decl && DECL_SECTION_NAME (current_function_decl))
10196 tree sectree = DECL_SECTION_NAME (current_function_decl);
10197 secname = TREE_STRING_POINTER (sectree);
10199 else if (cfun && in_cold_section_p)
10200 secname = cfun->cold_section_label;
10201 else
10202 secname = text_section_label;
10204 return secname;
10207 /* Generate *either* a DW_AT_location attribute or else a DW_AT_const_value
10208 data attribute for a variable or a parameter. We generate the
10209 DW_AT_const_value attribute only in those cases where the given variable
10210 or parameter does not have a true "location" either in memory or in a
10211 register. This can happen (for example) when a constant is passed as an
10212 actual argument in a call to an inline function. (It's possible that
10213 these things can crop up in other ways also.) Note that one type of
10214 constant value which can be passed into an inlined function is a constant
10215 pointer. This can happen for example if an actual argument in an inlined
10216 function call evaluates to a compile-time constant address. */
10218 static void
10219 add_location_or_const_value_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree decl,
10220 enum dwarf_attribute attr)
10222 rtx rtl;
10223 dw_loc_descr_ref descr;
10224 var_loc_list *loc_list;
10225 struct var_loc_node *node;
10226 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == ERROR_MARK)
10227 return;
10229 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL || TREE_CODE (decl) == PARM_DECL
10230 || TREE_CODE (decl) == RESULT_DECL);
10232 /* See if we possibly have multiple locations for this variable. */
10233 loc_list = lookup_decl_loc (decl);
10235 /* If it truly has multiple locations, the first and last node will
10236 differ. */
10237 if (loc_list && loc_list->first != loc_list->last)
10239 const char *endname, *secname;
10240 dw_loc_list_ref list;
10241 rtx varloc;
10243 /* Now that we know what section we are using for a base,
10244 actually construct the list of locations.
10245 The first location information is what is passed to the
10246 function that creates the location list, and the remaining
10247 locations just get added on to that list.
10248 Note that we only know the start address for a location
10249 (IE location changes), so to build the range, we use
10250 the range [current location start, next location start].
10251 This means we have to special case the last node, and generate
10252 a range of [last location start, end of function label]. */
10254 node = loc_list->first;
10255 varloc = NOTE_VAR_LOCATION (node->var_loc_note);
10256 secname = secname_for_decl (decl);
10258 list = new_loc_list (loc_descriptor (varloc),
10259 node->label, node->next->label, secname, 1);
10260 node = node->next;
10262 for (; node->next; node = node->next)
10263 if (NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (node->var_loc_note) != NULL_RTX)
10265 /* The variable has a location between NODE->LABEL and
10266 NODE->NEXT->LABEL. */
10267 varloc = NOTE_VAR_LOCATION (node->var_loc_note);
10268 add_loc_descr_to_loc_list (&list, loc_descriptor (varloc),
10269 node->label, node->next->label, secname);
10272 /* If the variable has a location at the last label
10273 it keeps its location until the end of function. */
10274 if (NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (node->var_loc_note) != NULL_RTX)
10276 char label_id[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
10278 varloc = NOTE_VAR_LOCATION (node->var_loc_note);
10279 if (!current_function_decl)
10280 endname = text_end_label;
10281 else
10283 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label_id, FUNC_END_LABEL,
10284 current_function_funcdef_no);
10285 endname = ggc_strdup (label_id);
10287 add_loc_descr_to_loc_list (&list, loc_descriptor (varloc),
10288 node->label, endname, secname);
10291 /* Finally, add the location list to the DIE, and we are done. */
10292 add_AT_loc_list (die, attr, list);
10293 return;
10296 /* Try to get some constant RTL for this decl, and use that as the value of
10297 the location. */
10299 rtl = rtl_for_decl_location (decl);
10300 if (rtl && (CONSTANT_P (rtl) || GET_CODE (rtl) == CONST_STRING))
10302 add_const_value_attribute (die, rtl);
10303 return;
10306 /* If we have tried to generate the location otherwise, and it
10307 didn't work out (we wouldn't be here if we did), and we have a one entry
10308 location list, try generating a location from that. */
10309 if (loc_list && loc_list->first)
10311 node = loc_list->first;
10312 descr = loc_descriptor (NOTE_VAR_LOCATION (node->var_loc_note));
10313 if (descr)
10315 add_AT_location_description (die, attr, descr);
10316 return;
10320 /* We couldn't get any rtl, so try directly generating the location
10321 description from the tree. */
10322 descr = loc_descriptor_from_tree (decl);
10323 if (descr)
10325 add_AT_location_description (die, attr, descr);
10326 return;
10330 /* If we don't have a copy of this variable in memory for some reason (such
10331 as a C++ member constant that doesn't have an out-of-line definition),
10332 we should tell the debugger about the constant value. */
10334 static void
10335 tree_add_const_value_attribute (dw_die_ref var_die, tree decl)
10337 tree init = DECL_INITIAL (decl);
10338 tree type = TREE_TYPE (decl);
10339 rtx rtl;
10341 if (TREE_READONLY (decl) && ! TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (decl) && init)
10342 /* OK */;
10343 else
10344 return;
10346 rtl = rtl_for_decl_init (init, type);
10347 if (rtl)
10348 add_const_value_attribute (var_die, rtl);
10351 /* Convert the CFI instructions for the current function into a
10352 location list. This is used for DW_AT_frame_base when we targeting
10353 a dwarf2 consumer that does not support the dwarf3
10354 DW_OP_call_frame_cfa. OFFSET is a constant to be added to all CFA
10355 expressions. */
10357 static dw_loc_list_ref
10358 convert_cfa_to_fb_loc_list (HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
10360 dw_fde_ref fde;
10361 dw_loc_list_ref list, *list_tail;
10362 dw_cfi_ref cfi;
10363 dw_cfa_location last_cfa, next_cfa;
10364 const char *start_label, *last_label, *section;
10366 fde = &fde_table[fde_table_in_use - 1];
10368 section = secname_for_decl (current_function_decl);
10369 list_tail = &list;
10370 list = NULL;
10372 next_cfa.reg = INVALID_REGNUM;
10373 next_cfa.offset = 0;
10374 next_cfa.indirect = 0;
10375 next_cfa.base_offset = 0;
10377 start_label = fde->dw_fde_begin;
10379 /* ??? Bald assumption that the CIE opcode list does not contain
10380 advance opcodes. */
10381 for (cfi = cie_cfi_head; cfi; cfi = cfi->dw_cfi_next)
10382 lookup_cfa_1 (cfi, &next_cfa);
10384 last_cfa = next_cfa;
10385 last_label = start_label;
10387 for (cfi = fde->dw_fde_cfi; cfi; cfi = cfi->dw_cfi_next)
10388 switch (cfi->dw_cfi_opc)
10390 case DW_CFA_advance_loc1:
10391 case DW_CFA_advance_loc2:
10392 case DW_CFA_advance_loc4:
10393 if (!cfa_equal_p (&last_cfa, &next_cfa))
10395 *list_tail = new_loc_list (build_cfa_loc (&last_cfa, offset),
10396 start_label, last_label, section,
10397 list == NULL);
10399 list_tail = &(*list_tail)->dw_loc_next;
10400 last_cfa = next_cfa;
10401 start_label = last_label;
10403 last_label = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr;
10404 break;
10406 case DW_CFA_advance_loc:
10407 /* The encoding is complex enough that we should never emit this. */
10408 case DW_CFA_remember_state:
10409 case DW_CFA_restore_state:
10410 /* We don't handle these two in this function. It would be possible
10411 if it were to be required. */
10412 gcc_unreachable ();
10414 default:
10415 lookup_cfa_1 (cfi, &next_cfa);
10416 break;
10419 if (!cfa_equal_p (&last_cfa, &next_cfa))
10421 *list_tail = new_loc_list (build_cfa_loc (&last_cfa, offset),
10422 start_label, last_label, section,
10423 list == NULL);
10424 list_tail = &(*list_tail)->dw_loc_next;
10425 start_label = last_label;
10427 *list_tail = new_loc_list (build_cfa_loc (&next_cfa, offset),
10428 start_label, fde->dw_fde_end, section,
10429 list == NULL);
10431 return list;
10434 /* Compute a displacement from the "steady-state frame pointer" to the
10435 frame base (often the same as the CFA), and store it in
10436 frame_pointer_fb_offset. OFFSET is added to the displacement
10437 before the latter is negated. */
10439 static void
10440 compute_frame_pointer_to_fb_displacement (HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
10442 rtx reg, elim;
10444 #ifdef FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET
10445 reg = frame_pointer_rtx;
10446 offset += FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET (current_function_decl);
10447 #else
10448 reg = arg_pointer_rtx;
10449 offset += ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET (current_function_decl);
10450 #endif
10452 elim = eliminate_regs (reg, VOIDmode, NULL_RTX);
10453 if (GET_CODE (elim) == PLUS)
10455 offset += INTVAL (XEXP (elim, 1));
10456 elim = XEXP (elim, 0);
10458 gcc_assert (elim == (frame_pointer_needed ? hard_frame_pointer_rtx
10459 : stack_pointer_rtx));
10461 frame_pointer_fb_offset = -offset;
10464 /* Generate a DW_AT_name attribute given some string value to be included as
10465 the value of the attribute. */
10467 static void
10468 add_name_attribute (dw_die_ref die, const char *name_string)
10470 if (name_string != NULL && *name_string != 0)
10472 if (demangle_name_func)
10473 name_string = (*demangle_name_func) (name_string);
10475 add_AT_string (die, DW_AT_name, name_string);
10479 /* Generate a DW_AT_comp_dir attribute for DIE. */
10481 static void
10482 add_comp_dir_attribute (dw_die_ref die)
10484 const char *wd = get_src_pwd ();
10485 if (wd != NULL)
10486 add_AT_string (die, DW_AT_comp_dir, wd);
10489 /* Given a tree node describing an array bound (either lower or upper) output
10490 a representation for that bound. */
10492 static void
10493 add_bound_info (dw_die_ref subrange_die, enum dwarf_attribute bound_attr, tree bound)
10495 switch (TREE_CODE (bound))
10497 case ERROR_MARK:
10498 return;
10500 /* All fixed-bounds are represented by INTEGER_CST nodes. */
10501 case INTEGER_CST:
10502 if (! host_integerp (bound, 0)
10503 || (bound_attr == DW_AT_lower_bound
10504 && (((is_c_family () || is_java ()) && integer_zerop (bound))
10505 || (is_fortran () && integer_onep (bound)))))
10506 /* Use the default. */
10508 else
10509 add_AT_unsigned (subrange_die, bound_attr, tree_low_cst (bound, 0));
10510 break;
10512 case CONVERT_EXPR:
10513 case NOP_EXPR:
10514 case NON_LVALUE_EXPR:
10515 case VIEW_CONVERT_EXPR:
10516 add_bound_info (subrange_die, bound_attr, TREE_OPERAND (bound, 0));
10517 break;
10519 case SAVE_EXPR:
10520 break;
10522 case VAR_DECL:
10523 case PARM_DECL:
10524 case RESULT_DECL:
10526 dw_die_ref decl_die = lookup_decl_die (bound);
10528 /* ??? Can this happen, or should the variable have been bound
10529 first? Probably it can, since I imagine that we try to create
10530 the types of parameters in the order in which they exist in
10531 the list, and won't have created a forward reference to a
10532 later parameter. */
10533 if (decl_die != NULL)
10534 add_AT_die_ref (subrange_die, bound_attr, decl_die);
10535 break;
10538 default:
10540 /* Otherwise try to create a stack operation procedure to
10541 evaluate the value of the array bound. */
10543 dw_die_ref ctx, decl_die;
10544 dw_loc_descr_ref loc;
10546 loc = loc_descriptor_from_tree (bound);
10547 if (loc == NULL)
10548 break;
10550 if (current_function_decl == 0)
10551 ctx = comp_unit_die;
10552 else
10553 ctx = lookup_decl_die (current_function_decl);
10555 decl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_variable, ctx, bound);
10556 add_AT_flag (decl_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
10557 add_type_attribute (decl_die, TREE_TYPE (bound), 1, 0, ctx);
10558 add_AT_loc (decl_die, DW_AT_location, loc);
10560 add_AT_die_ref (subrange_die, bound_attr, decl_die);
10561 break;
10566 /* Note that the block of subscript information for an array type also
10567 includes information about the element type of type given array type. */
10569 static void
10570 add_subscript_info (dw_die_ref type_die, tree type)
10572 #ifndef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
10573 unsigned dimension_number;
10574 #endif
10575 tree lower, upper;
10576 dw_die_ref subrange_die;
10578 /* The GNU compilers represent multidimensional array types as sequences of
10579 one dimensional array types whose element types are themselves array
10580 types. Here we squish that down, so that each multidimensional array
10581 type gets only one array_type DIE in the Dwarf debugging info. The draft
10582 Dwarf specification say that we are allowed to do this kind of
10583 compression in C (because there is no difference between an array or
10584 arrays and a multidimensional array in C) but for other source languages
10585 (e.g. Ada) we probably shouldn't do this. */
10587 /* ??? The SGI dwarf reader fails for multidimensional arrays with a
10588 const enum type. E.g. const enum machine_mode insn_operand_mode[2][10].
10589 We work around this by disabling this feature. See also
10590 gen_array_type_die. */
10591 #ifndef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
10592 for (dimension_number = 0;
10593 TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE;
10594 type = TREE_TYPE (type), dimension_number++)
10595 #endif
10597 tree domain = TYPE_DOMAIN (type);
10599 /* Arrays come in three flavors: Unspecified bounds, fixed bounds,
10600 and (in GNU C only) variable bounds. Handle all three forms
10601 here. */
10602 subrange_die = new_die (DW_TAG_subrange_type, type_die, NULL);
10603 if (domain)
10605 /* We have an array type with specified bounds. */
10606 lower = TYPE_MIN_VALUE (domain);
10607 upper = TYPE_MAX_VALUE (domain);
10609 /* Define the index type. */
10610 if (TREE_TYPE (domain))
10612 /* ??? This is probably an Ada unnamed subrange type. Ignore the
10613 TREE_TYPE field. We can't emit debug info for this
10614 because it is an unnamed integral type. */
10615 if (TREE_CODE (domain) == INTEGER_TYPE
10616 && TYPE_NAME (domain) == NULL_TREE
10617 && TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (domain)) == INTEGER_TYPE
10618 && TYPE_NAME (TREE_TYPE (domain)) == NULL_TREE)
10620 else
10621 add_type_attribute (subrange_die, TREE_TYPE (domain), 0, 0,
10622 type_die);
10625 /* ??? If upper is NULL, the array has unspecified length,
10626 but it does have a lower bound. This happens with Fortran
10627 dimension arr(N:*)
10628 Since the debugger is definitely going to need to know N
10629 to produce useful results, go ahead and output the lower
10630 bound solo, and hope the debugger can cope. */
10632 add_bound_info (subrange_die, DW_AT_lower_bound, lower);
10633 if (upper)
10634 add_bound_info (subrange_die, DW_AT_upper_bound, upper);
10637 /* Otherwise we have an array type with an unspecified length. The
10638 DWARF-2 spec does not say how to handle this; let's just leave out the
10639 bounds. */
10643 static void
10644 add_byte_size_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree tree_node)
10646 unsigned size;
10648 switch (TREE_CODE (tree_node))
10650 case ERROR_MARK:
10651 size = 0;
10652 break;
10653 case ENUMERAL_TYPE:
10654 case RECORD_TYPE:
10655 case UNION_TYPE:
10656 case QUAL_UNION_TYPE:
10657 size = int_size_in_bytes (tree_node);
10658 break;
10659 case FIELD_DECL:
10660 /* For a data member of a struct or union, the DW_AT_byte_size is
10661 generally given as the number of bytes normally allocated for an
10662 object of the *declared* type of the member itself. This is true
10663 even for bit-fields. */
10664 size = simple_type_size_in_bits (field_type (tree_node)) / BITS_PER_UNIT;
10665 break;
10666 default:
10667 gcc_unreachable ();
10670 /* Note that `size' might be -1 when we get to this point. If it is, that
10671 indicates that the byte size of the entity in question is variable. We
10672 have no good way of expressing this fact in Dwarf at the present time,
10673 so just let the -1 pass on through. */
10674 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_byte_size, size);
10677 /* For a FIELD_DECL node which represents a bit-field, output an attribute
10678 which specifies the distance in bits from the highest order bit of the
10679 "containing object" for the bit-field to the highest order bit of the
10680 bit-field itself.
10682 For any given bit-field, the "containing object" is a hypothetical object
10683 (of some integral or enum type) within which the given bit-field lives. The
10684 type of this hypothetical "containing object" is always the same as the
10685 declared type of the individual bit-field itself. The determination of the
10686 exact location of the "containing object" for a bit-field is rather
10687 complicated. It's handled by the `field_byte_offset' function (above).
10689 Note that it is the size (in bytes) of the hypothetical "containing object"
10690 which will be given in the DW_AT_byte_size attribute for this bit-field.
10691 (See `byte_size_attribute' above). */
10693 static inline void
10694 add_bit_offset_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree decl)
10696 HOST_WIDE_INT object_offset_in_bytes = field_byte_offset (decl);
10697 tree type = DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (decl);
10698 HOST_WIDE_INT bitpos_int;
10699 HOST_WIDE_INT highest_order_object_bit_offset;
10700 HOST_WIDE_INT highest_order_field_bit_offset;
10701 HOST_WIDE_INT unsigned bit_offset;
10703 /* Must be a field and a bit field. */
10704 gcc_assert (type && TREE_CODE (decl) == FIELD_DECL);
10706 /* We can't yet handle bit-fields whose offsets are variable, so if we
10707 encounter such things, just return without generating any attribute
10708 whatsoever. Likewise for variable or too large size. */
10709 if (! host_integerp (bit_position (decl), 0)
10710 || ! host_integerp (DECL_SIZE (decl), 1))
10711 return;
10713 bitpos_int = int_bit_position (decl);
10715 /* Note that the bit offset is always the distance (in bits) from the
10716 highest-order bit of the "containing object" to the highest-order bit of
10717 the bit-field itself. Since the "high-order end" of any object or field
10718 is different on big-endian and little-endian machines, the computation
10719 below must take account of these differences. */
10720 highest_order_object_bit_offset = object_offset_in_bytes * BITS_PER_UNIT;
10721 highest_order_field_bit_offset = bitpos_int;
10723 if (! BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN)
10725 highest_order_field_bit_offset += tree_low_cst (DECL_SIZE (decl), 0);
10726 highest_order_object_bit_offset += simple_type_size_in_bits (type);
10729 bit_offset
10730 = (! BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
10731 ? highest_order_object_bit_offset - highest_order_field_bit_offset
10732 : highest_order_field_bit_offset - highest_order_object_bit_offset);
10734 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_bit_offset, bit_offset);
10737 /* For a FIELD_DECL node which represents a bit field, output an attribute
10738 which specifies the length in bits of the given field. */
10740 static inline void
10741 add_bit_size_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree decl)
10743 /* Must be a field and a bit field. */
10744 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (decl) == FIELD_DECL
10745 && DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (decl));
10747 if (host_integerp (DECL_SIZE (decl), 1))
10748 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_bit_size, tree_low_cst (DECL_SIZE (decl), 1));
10751 /* If the compiled language is ANSI C, then add a 'prototyped'
10752 attribute, if arg types are given for the parameters of a function. */
10754 static inline void
10755 add_prototyped_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree func_type)
10757 if (get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_language) == DW_LANG_C89
10758 && TYPE_ARG_TYPES (func_type) != NULL)
10759 add_AT_flag (die, DW_AT_prototyped, 1);
10762 /* Add an 'abstract_origin' attribute below a given DIE. The DIE is found
10763 by looking in either the type declaration or object declaration
10764 equate table. */
10766 static inline void
10767 add_abstract_origin_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree origin)
10769 dw_die_ref origin_die = NULL;
10771 if (TREE_CODE (origin) != FUNCTION_DECL)
10773 /* We may have gotten separated from the block for the inlined
10774 function, if we're in an exception handler or some such; make
10775 sure that the abstract function has been written out.
10777 Doing this for nested functions is wrong, however; functions are
10778 distinct units, and our context might not even be inline. */
10779 tree fn = origin;
10781 if (TYPE_P (fn))
10782 fn = TYPE_STUB_DECL (fn);
10784 fn = decl_function_context (fn);
10785 if (fn)
10786 dwarf2out_abstract_function (fn);
10789 if (DECL_P (origin))
10790 origin_die = lookup_decl_die (origin);
10791 else if (TYPE_P (origin))
10792 origin_die = lookup_type_die (origin);
10794 /* XXX: Functions that are never lowered don't always have correct block
10795 trees (in the case of java, they simply have no block tree, in some other
10796 languages). For these functions, there is nothing we can really do to
10797 output correct debug info for inlined functions in all cases. Rather
10798 than die, we'll just produce deficient debug info now, in that we will
10799 have variables without a proper abstract origin. In the future, when all
10800 functions are lowered, we should re-add a gcc_assert (origin_die)
10801 here. */
10803 if (origin_die)
10804 add_AT_die_ref (die, DW_AT_abstract_origin, origin_die);
10807 /* We do not currently support the pure_virtual attribute. */
10809 static inline void
10810 add_pure_or_virtual_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree func_decl)
10812 if (DECL_VINDEX (func_decl))
10814 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_virtuality, DW_VIRTUALITY_virtual);
10816 if (host_integerp (DECL_VINDEX (func_decl), 0))
10817 add_AT_loc (die, DW_AT_vtable_elem_location,
10818 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_constu,
10819 tree_low_cst (DECL_VINDEX (func_decl), 0),
10820 0));
10822 /* GNU extension: Record what type this method came from originally. */
10823 if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
10824 add_AT_die_ref (die, DW_AT_containing_type,
10825 lookup_type_die (DECL_CONTEXT (func_decl)));
10829 /* Add source coordinate attributes for the given decl. */
10831 static void
10832 add_src_coords_attributes (dw_die_ref die, tree decl)
10834 expanded_location s = expand_location (DECL_SOURCE_LOCATION (decl));
10835 unsigned file_index = lookup_filename (s.file);
10837 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_decl_file, file_index);
10838 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_decl_line, s.line);
10841 /* Add a DW_AT_name attribute and source coordinate attribute for the
10842 given decl, but only if it actually has a name. */
10844 static void
10845 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (dw_die_ref die, tree decl)
10847 tree decl_name;
10849 decl_name = DECL_NAME (decl);
10850 if (decl_name != NULL && IDENTIFIER_POINTER (decl_name) != NULL)
10852 add_name_attribute (die, dwarf2_name (decl, 0));
10853 if (! DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl))
10854 add_src_coords_attributes (die, decl);
10856 if ((TREE_CODE (decl) == FUNCTION_DECL || TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL)
10857 && TREE_PUBLIC (decl)
10858 && DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME (decl) != DECL_NAME (decl)
10859 && !DECL_ABSTRACT (decl)
10860 && !(TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL && DECL_REGISTER (decl)))
10861 add_AT_string (die, DW_AT_MIPS_linkage_name,
10862 IDENTIFIER_POINTER (DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME (decl)));
10865 #ifdef VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
10866 /* Get the function's name, as described by its RTL. This may be different
10867 from the DECL_NAME name used in the source file. */
10868 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == FUNCTION_DECL && TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (decl))
10870 add_AT_addr (die, DW_AT_VMS_rtnbeg_pd_address,
10871 XEXP (DECL_RTL (decl), 0));
10872 VEC_safe_push (tree, gc, used_rtx_array, XEXP (DECL_RTL (decl), 0));
10874 #endif
10877 /* Push a new declaration scope. */
10879 static void
10880 push_decl_scope (tree scope)
10882 VEC_safe_push (tree, gc, decl_scope_table, scope);
10885 /* Pop a declaration scope. */
10887 static inline void
10888 pop_decl_scope (void)
10890 VEC_pop (tree, decl_scope_table);
10893 /* Return the DIE for the scope that immediately contains this type.
10894 Non-named types get global scope. Named types nested in other
10895 types get their containing scope if it's open, or global scope
10896 otherwise. All other types (i.e. function-local named types) get
10897 the current active scope. */
10899 static dw_die_ref
10900 scope_die_for (tree t, dw_die_ref context_die)
10902 dw_die_ref scope_die = NULL;
10903 tree containing_scope;
10904 int i;
10906 /* Non-types always go in the current scope. */
10907 gcc_assert (TYPE_P (t));
10909 containing_scope = TYPE_CONTEXT (t);
10911 /* Use the containing namespace if it was passed in (for a declaration). */
10912 if (containing_scope && TREE_CODE (containing_scope) == NAMESPACE_DECL)
10914 if (context_die == lookup_decl_die (containing_scope))
10915 /* OK */;
10916 else
10917 containing_scope = NULL_TREE;
10920 /* Ignore function type "scopes" from the C frontend. They mean that
10921 a tagged type is local to a parmlist of a function declarator, but
10922 that isn't useful to DWARF. */
10923 if (containing_scope && TREE_CODE (containing_scope) == FUNCTION_TYPE)
10924 containing_scope = NULL_TREE;
10926 if (containing_scope == NULL_TREE)
10927 scope_die = comp_unit_die;
10928 else if (TYPE_P (containing_scope))
10930 /* For types, we can just look up the appropriate DIE. But
10931 first we check to see if we're in the middle of emitting it
10932 so we know where the new DIE should go. */
10933 for (i = VEC_length (tree, decl_scope_table) - 1; i >= 0; --i)
10934 if (VEC_index (tree, decl_scope_table, i) == containing_scope)
10935 break;
10937 if (i < 0)
10939 gcc_assert (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE
10940 || TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (containing_scope));
10942 /* If none of the current dies are suitable, we get file scope. */
10943 scope_die = comp_unit_die;
10945 else
10946 scope_die = lookup_type_die (containing_scope);
10948 else
10949 scope_die = context_die;
10951 return scope_die;
10954 /* Returns nonzero if CONTEXT_DIE is internal to a function. */
10956 static inline int
10957 local_scope_p (dw_die_ref context_die)
10959 for (; context_die; context_die = context_die->die_parent)
10960 if (context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_inlined_subroutine
10961 || context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_subprogram)
10962 return 1;
10964 return 0;
10967 /* Returns nonzero if CONTEXT_DIE is a class or namespace, for deciding
10968 whether or not to treat a DIE in this context as a declaration. */
10970 static inline int
10971 class_or_namespace_scope_p (dw_die_ref context_die)
10973 return (context_die
10974 && (context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_structure_type
10975 || context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_union_type
10976 || context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_namespace));
10979 /* Many forms of DIEs require a "type description" attribute. This
10980 routine locates the proper "type descriptor" die for the type given
10981 by 'type', and adds a DW_AT_type attribute below the given die. */
10983 static void
10984 add_type_attribute (dw_die_ref object_die, tree type, int decl_const,
10985 int decl_volatile, dw_die_ref context_die)
10987 enum tree_code code = TREE_CODE (type);
10988 dw_die_ref type_die = NULL;
10990 /* ??? If this type is an unnamed subrange type of an integral or
10991 floating-point type, use the inner type. This is because we have no
10992 support for unnamed types in base_type_die. This can happen if this is
10993 an Ada subrange type. Correct solution is emit a subrange type die. */
10994 if ((code == INTEGER_TYPE || code == REAL_TYPE)
10995 && TREE_TYPE (type) != 0 && TYPE_NAME (type) == 0)
10996 type = TREE_TYPE (type), code = TREE_CODE (type);
10998 if (code == ERROR_MARK
10999 /* Handle a special case. For functions whose return type is void, we
11000 generate *no* type attribute. (Note that no object may have type
11001 `void', so this only applies to function return types). */
11002 || code == VOID_TYPE)
11003 return;
11005 type_die = modified_type_die (type,
11006 decl_const || TYPE_READONLY (type),
11007 decl_volatile || TYPE_VOLATILE (type),
11008 context_die);
11010 if (type_die != NULL)
11011 add_AT_die_ref (object_die, DW_AT_type, type_die);
11014 /* Given an object die, add the calling convention attribute for the
11015 function call type. */
11016 static void
11017 add_calling_convention_attribute (dw_die_ref subr_die, tree type)
11019 enum dwarf_calling_convention value = DW_CC_normal;
11021 value = targetm.dwarf_calling_convention (type);
11023 /* Only add the attribute if the backend requests it, and
11024 is not DW_CC_normal. */
11025 if (value && (value != DW_CC_normal))
11026 add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_calling_convention, value);
11029 /* Given a tree pointer to a struct, class, union, or enum type node, return
11030 a pointer to the (string) tag name for the given type, or zero if the type
11031 was declared without a tag. */
11033 static const char *
11034 type_tag (tree type)
11036 const char *name = 0;
11038 if (TYPE_NAME (type) != 0)
11040 tree t = 0;
11042 /* Find the IDENTIFIER_NODE for the type name. */
11043 if (TREE_CODE (TYPE_NAME (type)) == IDENTIFIER_NODE)
11044 t = TYPE_NAME (type);
11046 /* The g++ front end makes the TYPE_NAME of *each* tagged type point to
11047 a TYPE_DECL node, regardless of whether or not a `typedef' was
11048 involved. */
11049 else if (TREE_CODE (TYPE_NAME (type)) == TYPE_DECL
11050 && ! DECL_IGNORED_P (TYPE_NAME (type)))
11051 t = DECL_NAME (TYPE_NAME (type));
11053 /* Now get the name as a string, or invent one. */
11054 if (t != 0)
11055 name = IDENTIFIER_POINTER (t);
11058 return (name == 0 || *name == '\0') ? 0 : name;
11061 /* Return the type associated with a data member, make a special check
11062 for bit field types. */
11064 static inline tree
11065 member_declared_type (tree member)
11067 return (DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (member)
11068 ? DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (member) : TREE_TYPE (member));
11071 /* Get the decl's label, as described by its RTL. This may be different
11072 from the DECL_NAME name used in the source file. */
11074 #if 0
11075 static const char *
11076 decl_start_label (tree decl)
11078 rtx x;
11079 const char *fnname;
11081 x = DECL_RTL (decl);
11082 gcc_assert (MEM_P (x));
11084 x = XEXP (x, 0);
11085 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (x) == SYMBOL_REF);
11087 fnname = XSTR (x, 0);
11088 return fnname;
11090 #endif
11092 /* These routines generate the internal representation of the DIE's for
11093 the compilation unit. Debugging information is collected by walking
11094 the declaration trees passed in from dwarf2out_decl(). */
11096 static void
11097 gen_array_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
11099 dw_die_ref scope_die = scope_die_for (type, context_die);
11100 dw_die_ref array_die;
11101 tree element_type;
11103 /* ??? The SGI dwarf reader fails for array of array of enum types unless
11104 the inner array type comes before the outer array type. Thus we must
11105 call gen_type_die before we call new_die. See below also. */
11106 #ifdef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
11107 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (type), context_die);
11108 #endif
11110 array_die = new_die (DW_TAG_array_type, scope_die, type);
11111 add_name_attribute (array_die, type_tag (type));
11112 equate_type_number_to_die (type, array_die);
11114 if (TREE_CODE (type) == VECTOR_TYPE)
11116 /* The frontend feeds us a representation for the vector as a struct
11117 containing an array. Pull out the array type. */
11118 type = TREE_TYPE (TYPE_FIELDS (TYPE_DEBUG_REPRESENTATION_TYPE (type)));
11119 add_AT_flag (array_die, DW_AT_GNU_vector, 1);
11122 #if 0
11123 /* We default the array ordering. SDB will probably do
11124 the right things even if DW_AT_ordering is not present. It's not even
11125 an issue until we start to get into multidimensional arrays anyway. If
11126 SDB is ever caught doing the Wrong Thing for multi-dimensional arrays,
11127 then we'll have to put the DW_AT_ordering attribute back in. (But if
11128 and when we find out that we need to put these in, we will only do so
11129 for multidimensional arrays. */
11130 add_AT_unsigned (array_die, DW_AT_ordering, DW_ORD_row_major);
11131 #endif
11133 #ifdef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
11134 /* The SGI compilers handle arrays of unknown bound by setting
11135 AT_declaration and not emitting any subrange DIEs. */
11136 if (! TYPE_DOMAIN (type))
11137 add_AT_flag (array_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
11138 else
11139 #endif
11140 add_subscript_info (array_die, type);
11142 /* Add representation of the type of the elements of this array type. */
11143 element_type = TREE_TYPE (type);
11145 /* ??? The SGI dwarf reader fails for multidimensional arrays with a
11146 const enum type. E.g. const enum machine_mode insn_operand_mode[2][10].
11147 We work around this by disabling this feature. See also
11148 add_subscript_info. */
11149 #ifndef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
11150 while (TREE_CODE (element_type) == ARRAY_TYPE)
11151 element_type = TREE_TYPE (element_type);
11153 gen_type_die (element_type, context_die);
11154 #endif
11156 add_type_attribute (array_die, element_type, 0, 0, context_die);
11159 #if 0
11160 static void
11161 gen_entry_point_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref context_die)
11163 tree origin = decl_ultimate_origin (decl);
11164 dw_die_ref decl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_entry_point, context_die, decl);
11166 if (origin != NULL)
11167 add_abstract_origin_attribute (decl_die, origin);
11168 else
11170 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (decl_die, decl);
11171 add_type_attribute (decl_die, TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (decl)),
11172 0, 0, context_die);
11175 if (DECL_ABSTRACT (decl))
11176 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, decl_die);
11177 else
11178 add_AT_lbl_id (decl_die, DW_AT_low_pc, decl_start_label (decl));
11180 #endif
11182 /* Walk through the list of incomplete types again, trying once more to
11183 emit full debugging info for them. */
11185 static void
11186 retry_incomplete_types (void)
11188 int i;
11190 for (i = VEC_length (tree, incomplete_types) - 1; i >= 0; i--)
11191 gen_type_die (VEC_index (tree, incomplete_types, i), comp_unit_die);
11194 /* Generate a DIE to represent an inlined instance of an enumeration type. */
11196 static void
11197 gen_inlined_enumeration_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
11199 dw_die_ref type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_enumeration_type, context_die, type);
11201 /* We do not check for TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) being set, as the type may
11202 be incomplete and such types are not marked. */
11203 add_abstract_origin_attribute (type_die, type);
11206 /* Generate a DIE to represent an inlined instance of a structure type. */
11208 static void
11209 gen_inlined_structure_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
11211 dw_die_ref type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_structure_type, context_die, type);
11213 /* We do not check for TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) being set, as the type may
11214 be incomplete and such types are not marked. */
11215 add_abstract_origin_attribute (type_die, type);
11218 /* Generate a DIE to represent an inlined instance of a union type. */
11220 static void
11221 gen_inlined_union_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
11223 dw_die_ref type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_union_type, context_die, type);
11225 /* We do not check for TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) being set, as the type may
11226 be incomplete and such types are not marked. */
11227 add_abstract_origin_attribute (type_die, type);
11230 /* Generate a DIE to represent an enumeration type. Note that these DIEs
11231 include all of the information about the enumeration values also. Each
11232 enumerated type name/value is listed as a child of the enumerated type
11233 DIE. */
11235 static dw_die_ref
11236 gen_enumeration_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
11238 dw_die_ref type_die = lookup_type_die (type);
11240 if (type_die == NULL)
11242 type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_enumeration_type,
11243 scope_die_for (type, context_die), type);
11244 equate_type_number_to_die (type, type_die);
11245 add_name_attribute (type_die, type_tag (type));
11247 else if (! TYPE_SIZE (type))
11248 return type_die;
11249 else
11250 remove_AT (type_die, DW_AT_declaration);
11252 /* Handle a GNU C/C++ extension, i.e. incomplete enum types. If the
11253 given enum type is incomplete, do not generate the DW_AT_byte_size
11254 attribute or the DW_AT_element_list attribute. */
11255 if (TYPE_SIZE (type))
11257 tree link;
11259 TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) = 1;
11260 add_byte_size_attribute (type_die, type);
11261 if (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type) != NULL_TREE)
11262 add_src_coords_attributes (type_die, TYPE_STUB_DECL (type));
11264 /* If the first reference to this type was as the return type of an
11265 inline function, then it may not have a parent. Fix this now. */
11266 if (type_die->die_parent == NULL)
11267 add_child_die (scope_die_for (type, context_die), type_die);
11269 for (link = TYPE_VALUES (type);
11270 link != NULL; link = TREE_CHAIN (link))
11272 dw_die_ref enum_die = new_die (DW_TAG_enumerator, type_die, link);
11273 tree value = TREE_VALUE (link);
11275 add_name_attribute (enum_die,
11276 IDENTIFIER_POINTER (TREE_PURPOSE (link)));
11278 if (host_integerp (value, TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (value))))
11279 /* DWARF2 does not provide a way of indicating whether or
11280 not enumeration constants are signed or unsigned. GDB
11281 always assumes the values are signed, so we output all
11282 values as if they were signed. That means that
11283 enumeration constants with very large unsigned values
11284 will appear to have negative values in the debugger. */
11285 add_AT_int (enum_die, DW_AT_const_value,
11286 tree_low_cst (value, tree_int_cst_sgn (value) > 0));
11289 else
11290 add_AT_flag (type_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
11292 return type_die;
11295 /* Generate a DIE to represent either a real live formal parameter decl or to
11296 represent just the type of some formal parameter position in some function
11297 type.
11299 Note that this routine is a bit unusual because its argument may be a
11300 ..._DECL node (i.e. either a PARM_DECL or perhaps a VAR_DECL which
11301 represents an inlining of some PARM_DECL) or else some sort of a ..._TYPE
11302 node. If it's the former then this function is being called to output a
11303 DIE to represent a formal parameter object (or some inlining thereof). If
11304 it's the latter, then this function is only being called to output a
11305 DW_TAG_formal_parameter DIE to stand as a placeholder for some formal
11306 argument type of some subprogram type. */
11308 static dw_die_ref
11309 gen_formal_parameter_die (tree node, dw_die_ref context_die)
11311 dw_die_ref parm_die
11312 = new_die (DW_TAG_formal_parameter, context_die, node);
11313 tree origin;
11315 switch (TREE_CODE_CLASS (TREE_CODE (node)))
11317 case tcc_declaration:
11318 origin = decl_ultimate_origin (node);
11319 if (origin != NULL)
11320 add_abstract_origin_attribute (parm_die, origin);
11321 else
11323 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (parm_die, node);
11324 add_type_attribute (parm_die, TREE_TYPE (node),
11325 TREE_READONLY (node),
11326 TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (node),
11327 context_die);
11328 if (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (node))
11329 add_AT_flag (parm_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
11332 equate_decl_number_to_die (node, parm_die);
11333 if (! DECL_ABSTRACT (node))
11334 add_location_or_const_value_attribute (parm_die, node, DW_AT_location);
11336 break;
11338 case tcc_type:
11339 /* We were called with some kind of a ..._TYPE node. */
11340 add_type_attribute (parm_die, node, 0, 0, context_die);
11341 break;
11343 default:
11344 gcc_unreachable ();
11347 return parm_die;
11350 /* Generate a special type of DIE used as a stand-in for a trailing ellipsis
11351 at the end of an (ANSI prototyped) formal parameters list. */
11353 static void
11354 gen_unspecified_parameters_die (tree decl_or_type, dw_die_ref context_die)
11356 new_die (DW_TAG_unspecified_parameters, context_die, decl_or_type);
11359 /* Generate a list of nameless DW_TAG_formal_parameter DIEs (and perhaps a
11360 DW_TAG_unspecified_parameters DIE) to represent the types of the formal
11361 parameters as specified in some function type specification (except for
11362 those which appear as part of a function *definition*). */
11364 static void
11365 gen_formal_types_die (tree function_or_method_type, dw_die_ref context_die)
11367 tree link;
11368 tree formal_type = NULL;
11369 tree first_parm_type;
11370 tree arg;
11372 if (TREE_CODE (function_or_method_type) == FUNCTION_DECL)
11374 arg = DECL_ARGUMENTS (function_or_method_type);
11375 function_or_method_type = TREE_TYPE (function_or_method_type);
11377 else
11378 arg = NULL_TREE;
11380 first_parm_type = TYPE_ARG_TYPES (function_or_method_type);
11382 /* Make our first pass over the list of formal parameter types and output a
11383 DW_TAG_formal_parameter DIE for each one. */
11384 for (link = first_parm_type; link; )
11386 dw_die_ref parm_die;
11388 formal_type = TREE_VALUE (link);
11389 if (formal_type == void_type_node)
11390 break;
11392 /* Output a (nameless) DIE to represent the formal parameter itself. */
11393 parm_die = gen_formal_parameter_die (formal_type, context_die);
11394 if ((TREE_CODE (function_or_method_type) == METHOD_TYPE
11395 && link == first_parm_type)
11396 || (arg && DECL_ARTIFICIAL (arg)))
11397 add_AT_flag (parm_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
11399 link = TREE_CHAIN (link);
11400 if (arg)
11401 arg = TREE_CHAIN (arg);
11404 /* If this function type has an ellipsis, add a
11405 DW_TAG_unspecified_parameters DIE to the end of the parameter list. */
11406 if (formal_type != void_type_node)
11407 gen_unspecified_parameters_die (function_or_method_type, context_die);
11409 /* Make our second (and final) pass over the list of formal parameter types
11410 and output DIEs to represent those types (as necessary). */
11411 for (link = TYPE_ARG_TYPES (function_or_method_type);
11412 link && TREE_VALUE (link);
11413 link = TREE_CHAIN (link))
11414 gen_type_die (TREE_VALUE (link), context_die);
11417 /* We want to generate the DIE for TYPE so that we can generate the
11418 die for MEMBER, which has been defined; we will need to refer back
11419 to the member declaration nested within TYPE. If we're trying to
11420 generate minimal debug info for TYPE, processing TYPE won't do the
11421 trick; we need to attach the member declaration by hand. */
11423 static void
11424 gen_type_die_for_member (tree type, tree member, dw_die_ref context_die)
11426 gen_type_die (type, context_die);
11428 /* If we're trying to avoid duplicate debug info, we may not have
11429 emitted the member decl for this function. Emit it now. */
11430 if (TYPE_DECL_SUPPRESS_DEBUG (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type))
11431 && ! lookup_decl_die (member))
11433 dw_die_ref type_die;
11434 gcc_assert (!decl_ultimate_origin (member));
11436 push_decl_scope (type);
11437 type_die = lookup_type_die (type);
11438 if (TREE_CODE (member) == FUNCTION_DECL)
11439 gen_subprogram_die (member, type_die);
11440 else if (TREE_CODE (member) == FIELD_DECL)
11442 /* Ignore the nameless fields that are used to skip bits but handle
11443 C++ anonymous unions and structs. */
11444 if (DECL_NAME (member) != NULL_TREE
11445 || TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (member)) == UNION_TYPE
11446 || TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (member)) == RECORD_TYPE)
11448 gen_type_die (member_declared_type (member), type_die);
11449 gen_field_die (member, type_die);
11452 else
11453 gen_variable_die (member, type_die);
11455 pop_decl_scope ();
11459 /* Generate the DWARF2 info for the "abstract" instance of a function which we
11460 may later generate inlined and/or out-of-line instances of. */
11462 static void
11463 dwarf2out_abstract_function (tree decl)
11465 dw_die_ref old_die;
11466 tree save_fn;
11467 tree context;
11468 int was_abstract = DECL_ABSTRACT (decl);
11470 /* Make sure we have the actual abstract inline, not a clone. */
11471 decl = DECL_ORIGIN (decl);
11473 old_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
11474 if (old_die && get_AT (old_die, DW_AT_inline))
11475 /* We've already generated the abstract instance. */
11476 return;
11478 /* Be sure we've emitted the in-class declaration DIE (if any) first, so
11479 we don't get confused by DECL_ABSTRACT. */
11480 if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
11482 context = decl_class_context (decl);
11483 if (context)
11484 gen_type_die_for_member
11485 (context, decl, decl_function_context (decl) ? NULL : comp_unit_die);
11488 /* Pretend we've just finished compiling this function. */
11489 save_fn = current_function_decl;
11490 current_function_decl = decl;
11492 set_decl_abstract_flags (decl, 1);
11493 dwarf2out_decl (decl);
11494 if (! was_abstract)
11495 set_decl_abstract_flags (decl, 0);
11497 current_function_decl = save_fn;
11500 /* Generate a DIE to represent a declared function (either file-scope or
11501 block-local). */
11503 static void
11504 gen_subprogram_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref context_die)
11506 char label_id[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
11507 tree origin = decl_ultimate_origin (decl);
11508 dw_die_ref subr_die;
11509 tree fn_arg_types;
11510 tree outer_scope;
11511 dw_die_ref old_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
11512 int declaration = (current_function_decl != decl
11513 || class_or_namespace_scope_p (context_die));
11515 /* It is possible to have both DECL_ABSTRACT and DECLARATION be true if we
11516 started to generate the abstract instance of an inline, decided to output
11517 its containing class, and proceeded to emit the declaration of the inline
11518 from the member list for the class. If so, DECLARATION takes priority;
11519 we'll get back to the abstract instance when done with the class. */
11521 /* The class-scope declaration DIE must be the primary DIE. */
11522 if (origin && declaration && class_or_namespace_scope_p (context_die))
11524 origin = NULL;
11525 gcc_assert (!old_die);
11528 /* Now that the C++ front end lazily declares artificial member fns, we
11529 might need to retrofit the declaration into its class. */
11530 if (!declaration && !origin && !old_die
11531 && DECL_CONTEXT (decl) && TYPE_P (DECL_CONTEXT (decl))
11532 && !class_or_namespace_scope_p (context_die)
11533 && debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
11534 old_die = force_decl_die (decl);
11536 if (origin != NULL)
11538 gcc_assert (!declaration || local_scope_p (context_die));
11540 /* Fixup die_parent for the abstract instance of a nested
11541 inline function. */
11542 if (old_die && old_die->die_parent == NULL)
11543 add_child_die (context_die, old_die);
11545 subr_die = new_die (DW_TAG_subprogram, context_die, decl);
11546 add_abstract_origin_attribute (subr_die, origin);
11548 else if (old_die)
11550 expanded_location s = expand_location (DECL_SOURCE_LOCATION (decl));
11551 unsigned file_index = lookup_filename (s.file);
11553 if (!get_AT_flag (old_die, DW_AT_declaration)
11554 /* We can have a normal definition following an inline one in the
11555 case of redefinition of GNU C extern inlines.
11556 It seems reasonable to use AT_specification in this case. */
11557 && !get_AT (old_die, DW_AT_inline))
11559 /* Detect and ignore this case, where we are trying to output
11560 something we have already output. */
11561 return;
11564 /* If the definition comes from the same place as the declaration,
11565 maybe use the old DIE. We always want the DIE for this function
11566 that has the *_pc attributes to be under comp_unit_die so the
11567 debugger can find it. We also need to do this for abstract
11568 instances of inlines, since the spec requires the out-of-line copy
11569 to have the same parent. For local class methods, this doesn't
11570 apply; we just use the old DIE. */
11571 if ((old_die->die_parent == comp_unit_die || context_die == NULL)
11572 && (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl)
11573 || (get_AT_unsigned (old_die, DW_AT_decl_file) == file_index
11574 && (get_AT_unsigned (old_die, DW_AT_decl_line)
11575 == (unsigned) s.line))))
11577 subr_die = old_die;
11579 /* Clear out the declaration attribute and the formal parameters.
11580 Do not remove all children, because it is possible that this
11581 declaration die was forced using force_decl_die(). In such
11582 cases die that forced declaration die (e.g. TAG_imported_module)
11583 is one of the children that we do not want to remove. */
11584 remove_AT (subr_die, DW_AT_declaration);
11585 remove_child_TAG (subr_die, DW_TAG_formal_parameter);
11587 else
11589 subr_die = new_die (DW_TAG_subprogram, context_die, decl);
11590 add_AT_specification (subr_die, old_die);
11591 if (get_AT_unsigned (old_die, DW_AT_decl_file) != file_index)
11592 add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_decl_file, file_index);
11593 if (get_AT_unsigned (old_die, DW_AT_decl_line)
11594 != (unsigned) s.line)
11595 add_AT_unsigned
11596 (subr_die, DW_AT_decl_line, s.line);
11599 else
11601 subr_die = new_die (DW_TAG_subprogram, context_die, decl);
11603 if (TREE_PUBLIC (decl))
11604 add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_external, 1);
11606 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (subr_die, decl);
11607 if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
11609 add_prototyped_attribute (subr_die, TREE_TYPE (decl));
11610 add_type_attribute (subr_die, TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (decl)),
11611 0, 0, context_die);
11614 add_pure_or_virtual_attribute (subr_die, decl);
11615 if (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl))
11616 add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
11618 if (TREE_PROTECTED (decl))
11619 add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_protected);
11620 else if (TREE_PRIVATE (decl))
11621 add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_private);
11624 if (declaration)
11626 if (!old_die || !get_AT (old_die, DW_AT_inline))
11628 add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
11630 /* The first time we see a member function, it is in the context of
11631 the class to which it belongs. We make sure of this by emitting
11632 the class first. The next time is the definition, which is
11633 handled above. The two may come from the same source text.
11635 Note that force_decl_die() forces function declaration die. It is
11636 later reused to represent definition. */
11637 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, subr_die);
11640 else if (DECL_ABSTRACT (decl))
11642 if (DECL_DECLARED_INLINE_P (decl))
11644 if (cgraph_function_possibly_inlined_p (decl))
11645 add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_inline, DW_INL_declared_inlined);
11646 else
11647 add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_inline, DW_INL_declared_not_inlined);
11649 else
11651 if (cgraph_function_possibly_inlined_p (decl))
11652 add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_inline, DW_INL_inlined);
11653 else
11654 add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_inline, DW_INL_not_inlined);
11657 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, subr_die);
11659 else if (!DECL_EXTERNAL (decl))
11661 HOST_WIDE_INT cfa_fb_offset;
11663 if (!old_die || !get_AT (old_die, DW_AT_inline))
11664 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, subr_die);
11666 if (!flag_reorder_blocks_and_partition)
11668 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label_id, FUNC_BEGIN_LABEL,
11669 current_function_funcdef_no);
11670 add_AT_lbl_id (subr_die, DW_AT_low_pc, label_id);
11671 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label_id, FUNC_END_LABEL,
11672 current_function_funcdef_no);
11673 add_AT_lbl_id (subr_die, DW_AT_high_pc, label_id);
11675 add_pubname (decl, subr_die);
11676 add_arange (decl, subr_die);
11678 else
11679 { /* Do nothing for now; maybe need to duplicate die, one for
11680 hot section and ond for cold section, then use the hot/cold
11681 section begin/end labels to generate the aranges... */
11683 add_AT_lbl_id (subr_die, DW_AT_low_pc, hot_section_label);
11684 add_AT_lbl_id (subr_die, DW_AT_high_pc, hot_section_end_label);
11685 add_AT_lbl_id (subr_die, DW_AT_lo_user, unlikely_section_label);
11686 add_AT_lbl_id (subr_die, DW_AT_hi_user, cold_section_end_label);
11688 add_pubname (decl, subr_die);
11689 add_arange (decl, subr_die);
11690 add_arange (decl, subr_die);
11694 #ifdef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
11695 /* Add a reference to the FDE for this routine. */
11696 add_AT_fde_ref (subr_die, DW_AT_MIPS_fde, current_funcdef_fde);
11697 #endif
11699 cfa_fb_offset = CFA_FRAME_BASE_OFFSET (decl);
11701 /* We define the "frame base" as the function's CFA. This is more
11702 convenient for several reasons: (1) It's stable across the prologue
11703 and epilogue, which makes it better than just a frame pointer,
11704 (2) With dwarf3, there exists a one-byte encoding that allows us
11705 to reference the .debug_frame data by proxy, but failing that,
11706 (3) We can at least reuse the code inspection and interpretation
11707 code that determines the CFA position at various points in the
11708 function. */
11709 /* ??? Use some command-line or configury switch to enable the use
11710 of dwarf3 DW_OP_call_frame_cfa. At present there are no dwarf
11711 consumers that understand it; fall back to "pure" dwarf2 and
11712 convert the CFA data into a location list. */
11714 dw_loc_list_ref list = convert_cfa_to_fb_loc_list (cfa_fb_offset);
11715 if (list->dw_loc_next)
11716 add_AT_loc_list (subr_die, DW_AT_frame_base, list);
11717 else
11718 add_AT_loc (subr_die, DW_AT_frame_base, list->expr);
11721 /* Compute a displacement from the "steady-state frame pointer" to
11722 the CFA. The former is what all stack slots and argument slots
11723 will reference in the rtl; the later is what we've told the
11724 debugger about. We'll need to adjust all frame_base references
11725 by this displacement. */
11726 compute_frame_pointer_to_fb_displacement (cfa_fb_offset);
11728 if (cfun->static_chain_decl)
11729 add_AT_location_description (subr_die, DW_AT_static_link,
11730 loc_descriptor_from_tree (cfun->static_chain_decl));
11733 /* Now output descriptions of the arguments for this function. This gets
11734 (unnecessarily?) complex because of the fact that the DECL_ARGUMENT list
11735 for a FUNCTION_DECL doesn't indicate cases where there was a trailing
11736 `...' at the end of the formal parameter list. In order to find out if
11737 there was a trailing ellipsis or not, we must instead look at the type
11738 associated with the FUNCTION_DECL. This will be a node of type
11739 FUNCTION_TYPE. If the chain of type nodes hanging off of this
11740 FUNCTION_TYPE node ends with a void_type_node then there should *not* be
11741 an ellipsis at the end. */
11743 /* In the case where we are describing a mere function declaration, all we
11744 need to do here (and all we *can* do here) is to describe the *types* of
11745 its formal parameters. */
11746 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
11748 else if (declaration)
11749 gen_formal_types_die (decl, subr_die);
11750 else
11752 /* Generate DIEs to represent all known formal parameters. */
11753 tree arg_decls = DECL_ARGUMENTS (decl);
11754 tree parm;
11756 /* When generating DIEs, generate the unspecified_parameters DIE
11757 instead if we come across the arg "__builtin_va_alist" */
11758 for (parm = arg_decls; parm; parm = TREE_CHAIN (parm))
11759 if (TREE_CODE (parm) == PARM_DECL)
11761 if (DECL_NAME (parm)
11762 && !strcmp (IDENTIFIER_POINTER (DECL_NAME (parm)),
11763 "__builtin_va_alist"))
11764 gen_unspecified_parameters_die (parm, subr_die);
11765 else
11766 gen_decl_die (parm, subr_die);
11769 /* Decide whether we need an unspecified_parameters DIE at the end.
11770 There are 2 more cases to do this for: 1) the ansi ... declaration -
11771 this is detectable when the end of the arg list is not a
11772 void_type_node 2) an unprototyped function declaration (not a
11773 definition). This just means that we have no info about the
11774 parameters at all. */
11775 fn_arg_types = TYPE_ARG_TYPES (TREE_TYPE (decl));
11776 if (fn_arg_types != NULL)
11778 /* This is the prototyped case, check for.... */
11779 if (TREE_VALUE (tree_last (fn_arg_types)) != void_type_node)
11780 gen_unspecified_parameters_die (decl, subr_die);
11782 else if (DECL_INITIAL (decl) == NULL_TREE)
11783 gen_unspecified_parameters_die (decl, subr_die);
11786 /* Output Dwarf info for all of the stuff within the body of the function
11787 (if it has one - it may be just a declaration). */
11788 outer_scope = DECL_INITIAL (decl);
11790 /* OUTER_SCOPE is a pointer to the outermost BLOCK node created to represent
11791 a function. This BLOCK actually represents the outermost binding contour
11792 for the function, i.e. the contour in which the function's formal
11793 parameters and labels get declared. Curiously, it appears that the front
11794 end doesn't actually put the PARM_DECL nodes for the current function onto
11795 the BLOCK_VARS list for this outer scope, but are strung off of the
11796 DECL_ARGUMENTS list for the function instead.
11798 The BLOCK_VARS list for the `outer_scope' does provide us with a list of
11799 the LABEL_DECL nodes for the function however, and we output DWARF info
11800 for those in decls_for_scope. Just within the `outer_scope' there will be
11801 a BLOCK node representing the function's outermost pair of curly braces,
11802 and any blocks used for the base and member initializers of a C++
11803 constructor function. */
11804 if (! declaration && TREE_CODE (outer_scope) != ERROR_MARK)
11806 /* Emit a DW_TAG_variable DIE for a named return value. */
11807 if (DECL_NAME (DECL_RESULT (decl)))
11808 gen_decl_die (DECL_RESULT (decl), subr_die);
11810 current_function_has_inlines = 0;
11811 decls_for_scope (outer_scope, subr_die, 0);
11813 #if 0 && defined (MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO)
11814 if (current_function_has_inlines)
11816 add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_MIPS_has_inlines, 1);
11817 if (! comp_unit_has_inlines)
11819 add_AT_flag (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_MIPS_has_inlines, 1);
11820 comp_unit_has_inlines = 1;
11823 #endif
11825 /* Add the calling convention attribute if requested. */
11826 add_calling_convention_attribute (subr_die, TREE_TYPE (decl));
11830 /* Generate a DIE to represent a declared data object. */
11832 static void
11833 gen_variable_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref context_die)
11835 tree origin = decl_ultimate_origin (decl);
11836 dw_die_ref var_die = new_die (DW_TAG_variable, context_die, decl);
11838 dw_die_ref old_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
11839 int declaration = (DECL_EXTERNAL (decl)
11840 /* If DECL is COMDAT and has not actually been
11841 emitted, we cannot take its address; there
11842 might end up being no definition anywhere in
11843 the program. For example, consider the C++
11844 test case:
11846 template <class T>
11847 struct S { static const int i = 7; };
11849 template <class T>
11850 const int S<T>::i;
11852 int f() { return S<int>::i; }
11854 Here, S<int>::i is not DECL_EXTERNAL, but no
11855 definition is required, so the compiler will
11856 not emit a definition. */
11857 || (TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL
11858 && DECL_COMDAT (decl) && !TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (decl))
11859 || class_or_namespace_scope_p (context_die));
11861 if (origin != NULL)
11862 add_abstract_origin_attribute (var_die, origin);
11864 /* Loop unrolling can create multiple blocks that refer to the same
11865 static variable, so we must test for the DW_AT_declaration flag.
11867 ??? Loop unrolling/reorder_blocks should perhaps be rewritten to
11868 copy decls and set the DECL_ABSTRACT flag on them instead of
11869 sharing them.
11871 ??? Duplicated blocks have been rewritten to use .debug_ranges.
11873 ??? The declare_in_namespace support causes us to get two DIEs for one
11874 variable, both of which are declarations. We want to avoid considering
11875 one to be a specification, so we must test that this DIE is not a
11876 declaration. */
11877 else if (old_die && TREE_STATIC (decl) && ! declaration
11878 && get_AT_flag (old_die, DW_AT_declaration) == 1)
11880 /* This is a definition of a C++ class level static. */
11881 add_AT_specification (var_die, old_die);
11882 if (DECL_NAME (decl))
11884 expanded_location s = expand_location (DECL_SOURCE_LOCATION (decl));
11885 unsigned file_index = lookup_filename (s.file);
11887 if (get_AT_unsigned (old_die, DW_AT_decl_file) != file_index)
11888 add_AT_unsigned (var_die, DW_AT_decl_file, file_index);
11890 if (get_AT_unsigned (old_die, DW_AT_decl_line)
11891 != (unsigned) s.line)
11893 add_AT_unsigned (var_die, DW_AT_decl_line, s.line);
11896 else
11898 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (var_die, decl);
11899 add_type_attribute (var_die, TREE_TYPE (decl), TREE_READONLY (decl),
11900 TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (decl), context_die);
11902 if (TREE_PUBLIC (decl))
11903 add_AT_flag (var_die, DW_AT_external, 1);
11905 if (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl))
11906 add_AT_flag (var_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
11908 if (TREE_PROTECTED (decl))
11909 add_AT_unsigned (var_die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_protected);
11910 else if (TREE_PRIVATE (decl))
11911 add_AT_unsigned (var_die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_private);
11914 if (declaration)
11915 add_AT_flag (var_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
11917 if (DECL_ABSTRACT (decl) || declaration)
11918 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, var_die);
11920 if (! declaration && ! DECL_ABSTRACT (decl))
11922 add_location_or_const_value_attribute (var_die, decl, DW_AT_location);
11923 add_pubname (decl, var_die);
11925 else
11926 tree_add_const_value_attribute (var_die, decl);
11929 /* Generate a DIE to represent a label identifier. */
11931 static void
11932 gen_label_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref context_die)
11934 tree origin = decl_ultimate_origin (decl);
11935 dw_die_ref lbl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_label, context_die, decl);
11936 rtx insn;
11937 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
11939 if (origin != NULL)
11940 add_abstract_origin_attribute (lbl_die, origin);
11941 else
11942 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (lbl_die, decl);
11944 if (DECL_ABSTRACT (decl))
11945 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, lbl_die);
11946 else
11948 insn = DECL_RTL_IF_SET (decl);
11950 /* Deleted labels are programmer specified labels which have been
11951 eliminated because of various optimizations. We still emit them
11952 here so that it is possible to put breakpoints on them. */
11953 if (insn
11954 && (LABEL_P (insn)
11955 || ((NOTE_P (insn)
11956 && NOTE_LINE_NUMBER (insn) == NOTE_INSN_DELETED_LABEL))))
11958 /* When optimization is enabled (via -O) some parts of the compiler
11959 (e.g. jump.c and cse.c) may try to delete CODE_LABEL insns which
11960 represent source-level labels which were explicitly declared by
11961 the user. This really shouldn't be happening though, so catch
11962 it if it ever does happen. */
11963 gcc_assert (!INSN_DELETED_P (insn));
11965 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, "L", CODE_LABEL_NUMBER (insn));
11966 add_AT_lbl_id (lbl_die, DW_AT_low_pc, label);
11971 /* A helper function for gen_inlined_subroutine_die. Add source coordinate
11972 attributes to the DIE for a block STMT, to describe where the inlined
11973 function was called from. This is similar to add_src_coords_attributes. */
11975 static inline void
11976 add_call_src_coords_attributes (tree stmt, dw_die_ref die)
11978 expanded_location s = expand_location (BLOCK_SOURCE_LOCATION (stmt));
11979 unsigned file_index = lookup_filename (s.file);
11981 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_call_file, file_index);
11982 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_call_line, s.line);
11985 /* A helper function for gen_lexical_block_die and gen_inlined_subroutine_die.
11986 Add low_pc and high_pc attributes to the DIE for a block STMT. */
11988 static inline void
11989 add_high_low_attributes (tree stmt, dw_die_ref die)
11991 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
11993 if (BLOCK_FRAGMENT_CHAIN (stmt))
11995 tree chain;
11997 add_AT_range_list (die, DW_AT_ranges, add_ranges (stmt));
11999 chain = BLOCK_FRAGMENT_CHAIN (stmt);
12002 add_ranges (chain);
12003 chain = BLOCK_FRAGMENT_CHAIN (chain);
12005 while (chain);
12006 add_ranges (NULL);
12008 else
12010 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, BLOCK_BEGIN_LABEL,
12011 BLOCK_NUMBER (stmt));
12012 add_AT_lbl_id (die, DW_AT_low_pc, label);
12013 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, BLOCK_END_LABEL,
12014 BLOCK_NUMBER (stmt));
12015 add_AT_lbl_id (die, DW_AT_high_pc, label);
12019 /* Generate a DIE for a lexical block. */
12021 static void
12022 gen_lexical_block_die (tree stmt, dw_die_ref context_die, int depth)
12024 dw_die_ref stmt_die = new_die (DW_TAG_lexical_block, context_die, stmt);
12026 if (! BLOCK_ABSTRACT (stmt))
12027 add_high_low_attributes (stmt, stmt_die);
12029 decls_for_scope (stmt, stmt_die, depth);
12032 /* Generate a DIE for an inlined subprogram. */
12034 static void
12035 gen_inlined_subroutine_die (tree stmt, dw_die_ref context_die, int depth)
12037 tree decl = block_ultimate_origin (stmt);
12039 /* Emit info for the abstract instance first, if we haven't yet. We
12040 must emit this even if the block is abstract, otherwise when we
12041 emit the block below (or elsewhere), we may end up trying to emit
12042 a die whose origin die hasn't been emitted, and crashing. */
12043 dwarf2out_abstract_function (decl);
12045 if (! BLOCK_ABSTRACT (stmt))
12047 dw_die_ref subr_die
12048 = new_die (DW_TAG_inlined_subroutine, context_die, stmt);
12050 add_abstract_origin_attribute (subr_die, decl);
12051 add_high_low_attributes (stmt, subr_die);
12052 add_call_src_coords_attributes (stmt, subr_die);
12054 decls_for_scope (stmt, subr_die, depth);
12055 current_function_has_inlines = 1;
12057 else
12058 /* We may get here if we're the outer block of function A that was
12059 inlined into function B that was inlined into function C. When
12060 generating debugging info for C, dwarf2out_abstract_function(B)
12061 would mark all inlined blocks as abstract, including this one.
12062 So, we wouldn't (and shouldn't) expect labels to be generated
12063 for this one. Instead, just emit debugging info for
12064 declarations within the block. This is particularly important
12065 in the case of initializers of arguments passed from B to us:
12066 if they're statement expressions containing declarations, we
12067 wouldn't generate dies for their abstract variables, and then,
12068 when generating dies for the real variables, we'd die (pun
12069 intended :-) */
12070 gen_lexical_block_die (stmt, context_die, depth);
12073 /* Generate a DIE for a field in a record, or structure. */
12075 static void
12076 gen_field_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref context_die)
12078 dw_die_ref decl_die;
12080 if (TREE_TYPE (decl) == error_mark_node)
12081 return;
12083 decl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_member, context_die, decl);
12084 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (decl_die, decl);
12085 add_type_attribute (decl_die, member_declared_type (decl),
12086 TREE_READONLY (decl), TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (decl),
12087 context_die);
12089 if (DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (decl))
12091 add_byte_size_attribute (decl_die, decl);
12092 add_bit_size_attribute (decl_die, decl);
12093 add_bit_offset_attribute (decl_die, decl);
12096 if (TREE_CODE (DECL_FIELD_CONTEXT (decl)) != UNION_TYPE)
12097 add_data_member_location_attribute (decl_die, decl);
12099 if (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl))
12100 add_AT_flag (decl_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
12102 if (TREE_PROTECTED (decl))
12103 add_AT_unsigned (decl_die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_protected);
12104 else if (TREE_PRIVATE (decl))
12105 add_AT_unsigned (decl_die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_private);
12107 /* Equate decl number to die, so that we can look up this decl later on. */
12108 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, decl_die);
12111 #if 0
12112 /* Don't generate either pointer_type DIEs or reference_type DIEs here.
12113 Use modified_type_die instead.
12114 We keep this code here just in case these types of DIEs may be needed to
12115 represent certain things in other languages (e.g. Pascal) someday. */
12117 static void
12118 gen_pointer_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
12120 dw_die_ref ptr_die
12121 = new_die (DW_TAG_pointer_type, scope_die_for (type, context_die), type);
12123 equate_type_number_to_die (type, ptr_die);
12124 add_type_attribute (ptr_die, TREE_TYPE (type), 0, 0, context_die);
12125 add_AT_unsigned (mod_type_die, DW_AT_byte_size, PTR_SIZE);
12128 /* Don't generate either pointer_type DIEs or reference_type DIEs here.
12129 Use modified_type_die instead.
12130 We keep this code here just in case these types of DIEs may be needed to
12131 represent certain things in other languages (e.g. Pascal) someday. */
12133 static void
12134 gen_reference_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
12136 dw_die_ref ref_die
12137 = new_die (DW_TAG_reference_type, scope_die_for (type, context_die), type);
12139 equate_type_number_to_die (type, ref_die);
12140 add_type_attribute (ref_die, TREE_TYPE (type), 0, 0, context_die);
12141 add_AT_unsigned (mod_type_die, DW_AT_byte_size, PTR_SIZE);
12143 #endif
12145 /* Generate a DIE for a pointer to a member type. */
12147 static void
12148 gen_ptr_to_mbr_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
12150 dw_die_ref ptr_die
12151 = new_die (DW_TAG_ptr_to_member_type,
12152 scope_die_for (type, context_die), type);
12154 equate_type_number_to_die (type, ptr_die);
12155 add_AT_die_ref (ptr_die, DW_AT_containing_type,
12156 lookup_type_die (TYPE_OFFSET_BASETYPE (type)));
12157 add_type_attribute (ptr_die, TREE_TYPE (type), 0, 0, context_die);
12160 /* Generate the DIE for the compilation unit. */
12162 static dw_die_ref
12163 gen_compile_unit_die (const char *filename)
12165 dw_die_ref die;
12166 char producer[250];
12167 const char *language_string = lang_hooks.name;
12168 int language;
12170 die = new_die (DW_TAG_compile_unit, NULL, NULL);
12172 if (filename)
12174 add_name_attribute (die, filename);
12175 /* Don't add cwd for <built-in>. */
12176 if (filename[0] != DIR_SEPARATOR && filename[0] != '<')
12177 add_comp_dir_attribute (die);
12180 sprintf (producer, "%s %s", language_string, version_string);
12182 #ifdef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
12183 /* The MIPS/SGI compilers place the 'cc' command line options in the producer
12184 string. The SGI debugger looks for -g, -g1, -g2, or -g3; if they do
12185 not appear in the producer string, the debugger reaches the conclusion
12186 that the object file is stripped and has no debugging information.
12187 To get the MIPS/SGI debugger to believe that there is debugging
12188 information in the object file, we add a -g to the producer string. */
12189 if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
12190 strcat (producer, " -g");
12191 #endif
12193 add_AT_string (die, DW_AT_producer, producer);
12195 if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU C++") == 0)
12196 language = DW_LANG_C_plus_plus;
12197 else if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU Ada") == 0)
12198 language = DW_LANG_Ada95;
12199 else if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU F77") == 0)
12200 language = DW_LANG_Fortran77;
12201 else if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU F95") == 0)
12202 language = DW_LANG_Fortran95;
12203 else if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU Pascal") == 0)
12204 language = DW_LANG_Pascal83;
12205 else if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU Java") == 0)
12206 language = DW_LANG_Java;
12207 else
12208 language = DW_LANG_C89;
12210 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_language, language);
12211 return die;
12214 /* Generate the DIE for a base class. */
12216 static void
12217 gen_inheritance_die (tree binfo, tree access, dw_die_ref context_die)
12219 dw_die_ref die = new_die (DW_TAG_inheritance, context_die, binfo);
12221 add_type_attribute (die, BINFO_TYPE (binfo), 0, 0, context_die);
12222 add_data_member_location_attribute (die, binfo);
12224 if (BINFO_VIRTUAL_P (binfo))
12225 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_virtuality, DW_VIRTUALITY_virtual);
12227 if (access == access_public_node)
12228 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_public);
12229 else if (access == access_protected_node)
12230 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_protected);
12233 /* Generate a DIE for a class member. */
12235 static void
12236 gen_member_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
12238 tree member;
12239 tree binfo = TYPE_BINFO (type);
12240 dw_die_ref child;
12242 /* If this is not an incomplete type, output descriptions of each of its
12243 members. Note that as we output the DIEs necessary to represent the
12244 members of this record or union type, we will also be trying to output
12245 DIEs to represent the *types* of those members. However the `type'
12246 function (above) will specifically avoid generating type DIEs for member
12247 types *within* the list of member DIEs for this (containing) type except
12248 for those types (of members) which are explicitly marked as also being
12249 members of this (containing) type themselves. The g++ front- end can
12250 force any given type to be treated as a member of some other (containing)
12251 type by setting the TYPE_CONTEXT of the given (member) type to point to
12252 the TREE node representing the appropriate (containing) type. */
12254 /* First output info about the base classes. */
12255 if (binfo)
12257 VEC(tree,gc) *accesses = BINFO_BASE_ACCESSES (binfo);
12258 int i;
12259 tree base;
12261 for (i = 0; BINFO_BASE_ITERATE (binfo, i, base); i++)
12262 gen_inheritance_die (base,
12263 (accesses ? VEC_index (tree, accesses, i)
12264 : access_public_node), context_die);
12267 /* Now output info about the data members and type members. */
12268 for (member = TYPE_FIELDS (type); member; member = TREE_CHAIN (member))
12270 /* If we thought we were generating minimal debug info for TYPE
12271 and then changed our minds, some of the member declarations
12272 may have already been defined. Don't define them again, but
12273 do put them in the right order. */
12275 child = lookup_decl_die (member);
12276 if (child)
12277 splice_child_die (context_die, child);
12278 else
12279 gen_decl_die (member, context_die);
12282 /* Now output info about the function members (if any). */
12283 for (member = TYPE_METHODS (type); member; member = TREE_CHAIN (member))
12285 /* Don't include clones in the member list. */
12286 if (DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (member))
12287 continue;
12289 child = lookup_decl_die (member);
12290 if (child)
12291 splice_child_die (context_die, child);
12292 else
12293 gen_decl_die (member, context_die);
12297 /* Generate a DIE for a structure or union type. If TYPE_DECL_SUPPRESS_DEBUG
12298 is set, we pretend that the type was never defined, so we only get the
12299 member DIEs needed by later specification DIEs. */
12301 static void
12302 gen_struct_or_union_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
12304 dw_die_ref type_die = lookup_type_die (type);
12305 dw_die_ref scope_die = 0;
12306 int nested = 0;
12307 int complete = (TYPE_SIZE (type)
12308 && (! TYPE_STUB_DECL (type)
12309 || ! TYPE_DECL_SUPPRESS_DEBUG (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type))));
12310 int ns_decl = (context_die && context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_namespace);
12312 if (type_die && ! complete)
12313 return;
12315 if (TYPE_CONTEXT (type) != NULL_TREE
12316 && (AGGREGATE_TYPE_P (TYPE_CONTEXT (type))
12317 || TREE_CODE (TYPE_CONTEXT (type)) == NAMESPACE_DECL))
12318 nested = 1;
12320 scope_die = scope_die_for (type, context_die);
12322 if (! type_die || (nested && scope_die == comp_unit_die))
12323 /* First occurrence of type or toplevel definition of nested class. */
12325 dw_die_ref old_die = type_die;
12327 type_die = new_die (TREE_CODE (type) == RECORD_TYPE
12328 ? DW_TAG_structure_type : DW_TAG_union_type,
12329 scope_die, type);
12330 equate_type_number_to_die (type, type_die);
12331 if (old_die)
12332 add_AT_specification (type_die, old_die);
12333 else
12334 add_name_attribute (type_die, type_tag (type));
12336 else
12337 remove_AT (type_die, DW_AT_declaration);
12339 /* If this type has been completed, then give it a byte_size attribute and
12340 then give a list of members. */
12341 if (complete && !ns_decl)
12343 /* Prevent infinite recursion in cases where the type of some member of
12344 this type is expressed in terms of this type itself. */
12345 TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) = 1;
12346 add_byte_size_attribute (type_die, type);
12347 if (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type) != NULL_TREE)
12348 add_src_coords_attributes (type_die, TYPE_STUB_DECL (type));
12350 /* If the first reference to this type was as the return type of an
12351 inline function, then it may not have a parent. Fix this now. */
12352 if (type_die->die_parent == NULL)
12353 add_child_die (scope_die, type_die);
12355 push_decl_scope (type);
12356 gen_member_die (type, type_die);
12357 pop_decl_scope ();
12359 /* GNU extension: Record what type our vtable lives in. */
12360 if (TYPE_VFIELD (type))
12362 tree vtype = DECL_FCONTEXT (TYPE_VFIELD (type));
12364 gen_type_die (vtype, context_die);
12365 add_AT_die_ref (type_die, DW_AT_containing_type,
12366 lookup_type_die (vtype));
12369 else
12371 add_AT_flag (type_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
12373 /* We don't need to do this for function-local types. */
12374 if (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type)
12375 && ! decl_function_context (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type)))
12376 VEC_safe_push (tree, gc, incomplete_types, type);
12380 /* Generate a DIE for a subroutine _type_. */
12382 static void
12383 gen_subroutine_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
12385 tree return_type = TREE_TYPE (type);
12386 dw_die_ref subr_die
12387 = new_die (DW_TAG_subroutine_type,
12388 scope_die_for (type, context_die), type);
12390 equate_type_number_to_die (type, subr_die);
12391 add_prototyped_attribute (subr_die, type);
12392 add_type_attribute (subr_die, return_type, 0, 0, context_die);
12393 gen_formal_types_die (type, subr_die);
12396 /* Generate a DIE for a type definition. */
12398 static void
12399 gen_typedef_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref context_die)
12401 dw_die_ref type_die;
12402 tree origin;
12404 if (TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (decl))
12405 return;
12407 TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (decl) = 1;
12408 type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_typedef, context_die, decl);
12409 origin = decl_ultimate_origin (decl);
12410 if (origin != NULL)
12411 add_abstract_origin_attribute (type_die, origin);
12412 else
12414 tree type;
12416 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (type_die, decl);
12417 if (DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (decl))
12419 type = DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (decl);
12421 gcc_assert (type != TREE_TYPE (decl));
12422 equate_type_number_to_die (TREE_TYPE (decl), type_die);
12424 else
12425 type = TREE_TYPE (decl);
12427 add_type_attribute (type_die, type, TREE_READONLY (decl),
12428 TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (decl), context_die);
12431 if (DECL_ABSTRACT (decl))
12432 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, type_die);
12435 /* Generate a type description DIE. */
12437 static void
12438 gen_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
12440 int need_pop;
12442 if (type == NULL_TREE || type == error_mark_node)
12443 return;
12445 if (TYPE_NAME (type) && TREE_CODE (TYPE_NAME (type)) == TYPE_DECL
12446 && DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (TYPE_NAME (type)))
12448 if (TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type))
12449 return;
12451 /* Prevent broken recursion; we can't hand off to the same type. */
12452 gcc_assert (DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (TYPE_NAME (type)) != type);
12454 TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) = 1;
12455 gen_decl_die (TYPE_NAME (type), context_die);
12456 return;
12459 /* We are going to output a DIE to represent the unqualified version
12460 of this type (i.e. without any const or volatile qualifiers) so
12461 get the main variant (i.e. the unqualified version) of this type
12462 now. (Vectors are special because the debugging info is in the
12463 cloned type itself). */
12464 if (TREE_CODE (type) != VECTOR_TYPE)
12465 type = type_main_variant (type);
12467 if (TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type))
12468 return;
12470 switch (TREE_CODE (type))
12472 case ERROR_MARK:
12473 break;
12475 case POINTER_TYPE:
12476 case REFERENCE_TYPE:
12477 /* We must set TREE_ASM_WRITTEN in case this is a recursive type. This
12478 ensures that the gen_type_die recursion will terminate even if the
12479 type is recursive. Recursive types are possible in Ada. */
12480 /* ??? We could perhaps do this for all types before the switch
12481 statement. */
12482 TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) = 1;
12484 /* For these types, all that is required is that we output a DIE (or a
12485 set of DIEs) to represent the "basis" type. */
12486 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (type), context_die);
12487 break;
12489 case OFFSET_TYPE:
12490 /* This code is used for C++ pointer-to-data-member types.
12491 Output a description of the relevant class type. */
12492 gen_type_die (TYPE_OFFSET_BASETYPE (type), context_die);
12494 /* Output a description of the type of the object pointed to. */
12495 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (type), context_die);
12497 /* Now output a DIE to represent this pointer-to-data-member type
12498 itself. */
12499 gen_ptr_to_mbr_type_die (type, context_die);
12500 break;
12502 case FUNCTION_TYPE:
12503 /* Force out return type (in case it wasn't forced out already). */
12504 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (type), context_die);
12505 gen_subroutine_type_die (type, context_die);
12506 break;
12508 case METHOD_TYPE:
12509 /* Force out return type (in case it wasn't forced out already). */
12510 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (type), context_die);
12511 gen_subroutine_type_die (type, context_die);
12512 break;
12514 case ARRAY_TYPE:
12515 gen_array_type_die (type, context_die);
12516 break;
12518 case VECTOR_TYPE:
12519 gen_array_type_die (type, context_die);
12520 break;
12522 case ENUMERAL_TYPE:
12523 case RECORD_TYPE:
12524 case UNION_TYPE:
12525 case QUAL_UNION_TYPE:
12526 /* If this is a nested type whose containing class hasn't been written
12527 out yet, writing it out will cover this one, too. This does not apply
12528 to instantiations of member class templates; they need to be added to
12529 the containing class as they are generated. FIXME: This hurts the
12530 idea of combining type decls from multiple TUs, since we can't predict
12531 what set of template instantiations we'll get. */
12532 if (TYPE_CONTEXT (type)
12533 && AGGREGATE_TYPE_P (TYPE_CONTEXT (type))
12534 && ! TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (TYPE_CONTEXT (type)))
12536 gen_type_die (TYPE_CONTEXT (type), context_die);
12538 if (TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type))
12539 return;
12541 /* If that failed, attach ourselves to the stub. */
12542 push_decl_scope (TYPE_CONTEXT (type));
12543 context_die = lookup_type_die (TYPE_CONTEXT (type));
12544 need_pop = 1;
12546 else
12548 declare_in_namespace (type, context_die);
12549 need_pop = 0;
12552 if (TREE_CODE (type) == ENUMERAL_TYPE)
12553 gen_enumeration_type_die (type, context_die);
12554 else
12555 gen_struct_or_union_type_die (type, context_die);
12557 if (need_pop)
12558 pop_decl_scope ();
12560 /* Don't set TREE_ASM_WRITTEN on an incomplete struct; we want to fix
12561 it up if it is ever completed. gen_*_type_die will set it for us
12562 when appropriate. */
12563 return;
12565 case VOID_TYPE:
12566 case INTEGER_TYPE:
12567 case REAL_TYPE:
12568 case COMPLEX_TYPE:
12569 case BOOLEAN_TYPE:
12570 /* No DIEs needed for fundamental types. */
12571 break;
12573 case LANG_TYPE:
12574 /* No Dwarf representation currently defined. */
12575 break;
12577 default:
12578 gcc_unreachable ();
12581 TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) = 1;
12584 /* Generate a DIE for a tagged type instantiation. */
12586 static void
12587 gen_tagged_type_instantiation_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
12589 if (type == NULL_TREE || type == error_mark_node)
12590 return;
12592 /* We are going to output a DIE to represent the unqualified version of
12593 this type (i.e. without any const or volatile qualifiers) so make sure
12594 that we have the main variant (i.e. the unqualified version) of this
12595 type now. */
12596 gcc_assert (type == type_main_variant (type));
12598 /* Do not check TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) as it may not be set if this is
12599 an instance of an unresolved type. */
12601 switch (TREE_CODE (type))
12603 case ERROR_MARK:
12604 break;
12606 case ENUMERAL_TYPE:
12607 gen_inlined_enumeration_type_die (type, context_die);
12608 break;
12610 case RECORD_TYPE:
12611 gen_inlined_structure_type_die (type, context_die);
12612 break;
12614 case UNION_TYPE:
12615 case QUAL_UNION_TYPE:
12616 gen_inlined_union_type_die (type, context_die);
12617 break;
12619 default:
12620 gcc_unreachable ();
12624 /* Generate a DW_TAG_lexical_block DIE followed by DIEs to represent all of the
12625 things which are local to the given block. */
12627 static void
12628 gen_block_die (tree stmt, dw_die_ref context_die, int depth)
12630 int must_output_die = 0;
12631 tree origin;
12632 tree decl;
12633 enum tree_code origin_code;
12635 /* Ignore blocks that are NULL. */
12636 if (stmt == NULL_TREE)
12637 return;
12639 /* If the block is one fragment of a non-contiguous block, do not
12640 process the variables, since they will have been done by the
12641 origin block. Do process subblocks. */
12642 if (BLOCK_FRAGMENT_ORIGIN (stmt))
12644 tree sub;
12646 for (sub = BLOCK_SUBBLOCKS (stmt); sub; sub = BLOCK_CHAIN (sub))
12647 gen_block_die (sub, context_die, depth + 1);
12649 return;
12652 /* Determine the "ultimate origin" of this block. This block may be an
12653 inlined instance of an inlined instance of inline function, so we have
12654 to trace all of the way back through the origin chain to find out what
12655 sort of node actually served as the original seed for the creation of
12656 the current block. */
12657 origin = block_ultimate_origin (stmt);
12658 origin_code = (origin != NULL) ? TREE_CODE (origin) : ERROR_MARK;
12660 /* Determine if we need to output any Dwarf DIEs at all to represent this
12661 block. */
12662 if (origin_code == FUNCTION_DECL)
12663 /* The outer scopes for inlinings *must* always be represented. We
12664 generate DW_TAG_inlined_subroutine DIEs for them. (See below.) */
12665 must_output_die = 1;
12666 else
12668 /* In the case where the current block represents an inlining of the
12669 "body block" of an inline function, we must *NOT* output any DIE for
12670 this block because we have already output a DIE to represent the whole
12671 inlined function scope and the "body block" of any function doesn't
12672 really represent a different scope according to ANSI C rules. So we
12673 check here to make sure that this block does not represent a "body
12674 block inlining" before trying to set the MUST_OUTPUT_DIE flag. */
12675 if (! is_body_block (origin ? origin : stmt))
12677 /* Determine if this block directly contains any "significant"
12678 local declarations which we will need to output DIEs for. */
12679 if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
12680 /* We are not in terse mode so *any* local declaration counts
12681 as being a "significant" one. */
12682 must_output_die = (BLOCK_VARS (stmt) != NULL
12683 && (TREE_USED (stmt)
12684 || TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (stmt)
12685 || BLOCK_ABSTRACT (stmt)));
12686 else
12687 /* We are in terse mode, so only local (nested) function
12688 definitions count as "significant" local declarations. */
12689 for (decl = BLOCK_VARS (stmt);
12690 decl != NULL; decl = TREE_CHAIN (decl))
12691 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == FUNCTION_DECL
12692 && DECL_INITIAL (decl))
12694 must_output_die = 1;
12695 break;
12700 /* It would be a waste of space to generate a Dwarf DW_TAG_lexical_block
12701 DIE for any block which contains no significant local declarations at
12702 all. Rather, in such cases we just call `decls_for_scope' so that any
12703 needed Dwarf info for any sub-blocks will get properly generated. Note
12704 that in terse mode, our definition of what constitutes a "significant"
12705 local declaration gets restricted to include only inlined function
12706 instances and local (nested) function definitions. */
12707 if (must_output_die)
12709 if (origin_code == FUNCTION_DECL)
12710 gen_inlined_subroutine_die (stmt, context_die, depth);
12711 else
12712 gen_lexical_block_die (stmt, context_die, depth);
12714 else
12715 decls_for_scope (stmt, context_die, depth);
12718 /* Generate all of the decls declared within a given scope and (recursively)
12719 all of its sub-blocks. */
12721 static void
12722 decls_for_scope (tree stmt, dw_die_ref context_die, int depth)
12724 tree decl;
12725 tree subblocks;
12727 /* Ignore NULL blocks. */
12728 if (stmt == NULL_TREE)
12729 return;
12731 if (TREE_USED (stmt))
12733 /* Output the DIEs to represent all of the data objects and typedefs
12734 declared directly within this block but not within any nested
12735 sub-blocks. Also, nested function and tag DIEs have been
12736 generated with a parent of NULL; fix that up now. */
12737 for (decl = BLOCK_VARS (stmt); decl != NULL; decl = TREE_CHAIN (decl))
12739 dw_die_ref die;
12741 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == FUNCTION_DECL)
12742 die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
12743 else if (TREE_CODE (decl) == TYPE_DECL && TYPE_DECL_IS_STUB (decl))
12744 die = lookup_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl));
12745 else
12746 die = NULL;
12748 if (die != NULL && die->die_parent == NULL)
12749 add_child_die (context_die, die);
12750 /* Do not produce debug information for static variables since
12751 these might be optimized out. We are called for these later
12752 in cgraph_varpool_analyze_pending_decls. */
12753 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL && TREE_STATIC (decl))
12755 else
12756 gen_decl_die (decl, context_die);
12760 /* If we're at -g1, we're not interested in subblocks. */
12761 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
12762 return;
12764 /* Output the DIEs to represent all sub-blocks (and the items declared
12765 therein) of this block. */
12766 for (subblocks = BLOCK_SUBBLOCKS (stmt);
12767 subblocks != NULL;
12768 subblocks = BLOCK_CHAIN (subblocks))
12769 gen_block_die (subblocks, context_die, depth + 1);
12772 /* Is this a typedef we can avoid emitting? */
12774 static inline int
12775 is_redundant_typedef (tree decl)
12777 if (TYPE_DECL_IS_STUB (decl))
12778 return 1;
12780 if (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl)
12781 && DECL_CONTEXT (decl)
12782 && is_tagged_type (DECL_CONTEXT (decl))
12783 && TREE_CODE (TYPE_NAME (DECL_CONTEXT (decl))) == TYPE_DECL
12784 && DECL_NAME (decl) == DECL_NAME (TYPE_NAME (DECL_CONTEXT (decl))))
12785 /* Also ignore the artificial member typedef for the class name. */
12786 return 1;
12788 return 0;
12791 /* Returns the DIE for decl. A DIE will always be returned. */
12793 static dw_die_ref
12794 force_decl_die (tree decl)
12796 dw_die_ref decl_die;
12797 unsigned saved_external_flag;
12798 tree save_fn = NULL_TREE;
12799 decl_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
12800 if (!decl_die)
12802 dw_die_ref context_die;
12803 tree decl_context = DECL_CONTEXT (decl);
12804 if (decl_context)
12806 /* Find die that represents this context. */
12807 if (TYPE_P (decl_context))
12808 context_die = force_type_die (decl_context);
12809 else
12810 context_die = force_decl_die (decl_context);
12812 else
12813 context_die = comp_unit_die;
12815 decl_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
12816 if (decl_die)
12817 return decl_die;
12819 switch (TREE_CODE (decl))
12821 case FUNCTION_DECL:
12822 /* Clear current_function_decl, so that gen_subprogram_die thinks
12823 that this is a declaration. At this point, we just want to force
12824 declaration die. */
12825 save_fn = current_function_decl;
12826 current_function_decl = NULL_TREE;
12827 gen_subprogram_die (decl, context_die);
12828 current_function_decl = save_fn;
12829 break;
12831 case VAR_DECL:
12832 /* Set external flag to force declaration die. Restore it after
12833 gen_decl_die() call. */
12834 saved_external_flag = DECL_EXTERNAL (decl);
12835 DECL_EXTERNAL (decl) = 1;
12836 gen_decl_die (decl, context_die);
12837 DECL_EXTERNAL (decl) = saved_external_flag;
12838 break;
12840 case NAMESPACE_DECL:
12841 dwarf2out_decl (decl);
12842 break;
12844 default:
12845 gcc_unreachable ();
12848 /* We should be able to find the DIE now. */
12849 if (!decl_die)
12850 decl_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
12851 gcc_assert (decl_die);
12854 return decl_die;
12857 /* Returns the DIE for TYPE. A DIE is always returned. */
12859 static dw_die_ref
12860 force_type_die (tree type)
12862 dw_die_ref type_die;
12864 type_die = lookup_type_die (type);
12865 if (!type_die)
12867 dw_die_ref context_die;
12868 if (TYPE_CONTEXT (type))
12870 if (TYPE_P (TYPE_CONTEXT (type)))
12871 context_die = force_type_die (TYPE_CONTEXT (type));
12872 else
12873 context_die = force_decl_die (TYPE_CONTEXT (type));
12875 else
12876 context_die = comp_unit_die;
12878 type_die = lookup_type_die (type);
12879 if (type_die)
12880 return type_die;
12881 gen_type_die (type, context_die);
12882 type_die = lookup_type_die (type);
12883 gcc_assert (type_die);
12885 return type_die;
12888 /* Force out any required namespaces to be able to output DECL,
12889 and return the new context_die for it, if it's changed. */
12891 static dw_die_ref
12892 setup_namespace_context (tree thing, dw_die_ref context_die)
12894 tree context = (DECL_P (thing)
12895 ? DECL_CONTEXT (thing) : TYPE_CONTEXT (thing));
12896 if (context && TREE_CODE (context) == NAMESPACE_DECL)
12897 /* Force out the namespace. */
12898 context_die = force_decl_die (context);
12900 return context_die;
12903 /* Emit a declaration DIE for THING (which is either a DECL or a tagged
12904 type) within its namespace, if appropriate.
12906 For compatibility with older debuggers, namespace DIEs only contain
12907 declarations; all definitions are emitted at CU scope. */
12909 static void
12910 declare_in_namespace (tree thing, dw_die_ref context_die)
12912 dw_die_ref ns_context;
12914 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
12915 return;
12917 /* If this decl is from an inlined function, then don't try to emit it in its
12918 namespace, as we will get confused. It would have already been emitted
12919 when the abstract instance of the inline function was emitted anyways. */
12920 if (DECL_P (thing) && DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (thing))
12921 return;
12923 ns_context = setup_namespace_context (thing, context_die);
12925 if (ns_context != context_die)
12927 if (DECL_P (thing))
12928 gen_decl_die (thing, ns_context);
12929 else
12930 gen_type_die (thing, ns_context);
12934 /* Generate a DIE for a namespace or namespace alias. */
12936 static void
12937 gen_namespace_die (tree decl)
12939 dw_die_ref context_die = setup_namespace_context (decl, comp_unit_die);
12941 /* Namespace aliases have a DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN of the namespace
12942 they are an alias of. */
12943 if (DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl) == NULL)
12945 /* Output a real namespace. */
12946 dw_die_ref namespace_die
12947 = new_die (DW_TAG_namespace, context_die, decl);
12948 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (namespace_die, decl);
12949 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, namespace_die);
12951 else
12953 /* Output a namespace alias. */
12955 /* Force out the namespace we are an alias of, if necessary. */
12956 dw_die_ref origin_die
12957 = force_decl_die (DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl));
12959 /* Now create the namespace alias DIE. */
12960 dw_die_ref namespace_die
12961 = new_die (DW_TAG_imported_declaration, context_die, decl);
12962 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (namespace_die, decl);
12963 add_AT_die_ref (namespace_die, DW_AT_import, origin_die);
12964 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, namespace_die);
12968 /* Generate Dwarf debug information for a decl described by DECL. */
12970 static void
12971 gen_decl_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref context_die)
12973 tree origin;
12975 if (DECL_P (decl) && DECL_IGNORED_P (decl))
12976 return;
12978 switch (TREE_CODE (decl))
12980 case ERROR_MARK:
12981 break;
12983 case CONST_DECL:
12984 /* The individual enumerators of an enum type get output when we output
12985 the Dwarf representation of the relevant enum type itself. */
12986 break;
12988 case FUNCTION_DECL:
12989 /* Don't output any DIEs to represent mere function declarations,
12990 unless they are class members or explicit block externs. */
12991 if (DECL_INITIAL (decl) == NULL_TREE && DECL_CONTEXT (decl) == NULL_TREE
12992 && (current_function_decl == NULL_TREE || DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl)))
12993 break;
12995 #if 0
12996 /* FIXME */
12997 /* This doesn't work because the C frontend sets DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN
12998 on local redeclarations of global functions. That seems broken. */
12999 if (current_function_decl != decl)
13000 /* This is only a declaration. */;
13001 #endif
13003 /* If we're emitting a clone, emit info for the abstract instance. */
13004 if (DECL_ORIGIN (decl) != decl)
13005 dwarf2out_abstract_function (DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl));
13007 /* If we're emitting an out-of-line copy of an inline function,
13008 emit info for the abstract instance and set up to refer to it. */
13009 else if (cgraph_function_possibly_inlined_p (decl)
13010 && ! DECL_ABSTRACT (decl)
13011 && ! class_or_namespace_scope_p (context_die)
13012 /* dwarf2out_abstract_function won't emit a die if this is just
13013 a declaration. We must avoid setting DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN in
13014 that case, because that works only if we have a die. */
13015 && DECL_INITIAL (decl) != NULL_TREE)
13017 dwarf2out_abstract_function (decl);
13018 set_decl_origin_self (decl);
13021 /* Otherwise we're emitting the primary DIE for this decl. */
13022 else if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
13024 /* Before we describe the FUNCTION_DECL itself, make sure that we
13025 have described its return type. */
13026 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (decl)), context_die);
13028 /* And its virtual context. */
13029 if (DECL_VINDEX (decl) != NULL_TREE)
13030 gen_type_die (DECL_CONTEXT (decl), context_die);
13032 /* And its containing type. */
13033 origin = decl_class_context (decl);
13034 if (origin != NULL_TREE)
13035 gen_type_die_for_member (origin, decl, context_die);
13037 /* And its containing namespace. */
13038 declare_in_namespace (decl, context_die);
13041 /* Now output a DIE to represent the function itself. */
13042 gen_subprogram_die (decl, context_die);
13043 break;
13045 case TYPE_DECL:
13046 /* If we are in terse mode, don't generate any DIEs to represent any
13047 actual typedefs. */
13048 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
13049 break;
13051 /* In the special case of a TYPE_DECL node representing the declaration
13052 of some type tag, if the given TYPE_DECL is marked as having been
13053 instantiated from some other (original) TYPE_DECL node (e.g. one which
13054 was generated within the original definition of an inline function) we
13055 have to generate a special (abbreviated) DW_TAG_structure_type,
13056 DW_TAG_union_type, or DW_TAG_enumeration_type DIE here. */
13057 if (TYPE_DECL_IS_STUB (decl) && decl_ultimate_origin (decl) != NULL_TREE)
13059 gen_tagged_type_instantiation_die (TREE_TYPE (decl), context_die);
13060 break;
13063 if (is_redundant_typedef (decl))
13064 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl), context_die);
13065 else
13066 /* Output a DIE to represent the typedef itself. */
13067 gen_typedef_die (decl, context_die);
13068 break;
13070 case LABEL_DECL:
13071 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_NORMAL)
13072 gen_label_die (decl, context_die);
13073 break;
13075 case VAR_DECL:
13076 case RESULT_DECL:
13077 /* If we are in terse mode, don't generate any DIEs to represent any
13078 variable declarations or definitions. */
13079 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
13080 break;
13082 /* Output any DIEs that are needed to specify the type of this data
13083 object. */
13084 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl), context_die);
13086 /* And its containing type. */
13087 origin = decl_class_context (decl);
13088 if (origin != NULL_TREE)
13089 gen_type_die_for_member (origin, decl, context_die);
13091 /* And its containing namespace. */
13092 declare_in_namespace (decl, context_die);
13094 /* Now output the DIE to represent the data object itself. This gets
13095 complicated because of the possibility that the VAR_DECL really
13096 represents an inlined instance of a formal parameter for an inline
13097 function. */
13098 origin = decl_ultimate_origin (decl);
13099 if (origin != NULL_TREE && TREE_CODE (origin) == PARM_DECL)
13100 gen_formal_parameter_die (decl, context_die);
13101 else
13102 gen_variable_die (decl, context_die);
13103 break;
13105 case FIELD_DECL:
13106 /* Ignore the nameless fields that are used to skip bits but handle C++
13107 anonymous unions and structs. */
13108 if (DECL_NAME (decl) != NULL_TREE
13109 || TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)) == UNION_TYPE
13110 || TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)) == RECORD_TYPE)
13112 gen_type_die (member_declared_type (decl), context_die);
13113 gen_field_die (decl, context_die);
13115 break;
13117 case PARM_DECL:
13118 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl), context_die);
13119 gen_formal_parameter_die (decl, context_die);
13120 break;
13122 case NAMESPACE_DECL:
13123 gen_namespace_die (decl);
13124 break;
13126 default:
13127 /* Probably some frontend-internal decl. Assume we don't care. */
13128 gcc_assert ((int)TREE_CODE (decl) > NUM_TREE_CODES);
13129 break;
13133 /* Output debug information for global decl DECL. Called from toplev.c after
13134 compilation proper has finished. */
13136 static void
13137 dwarf2out_global_decl (tree decl)
13139 /* Output DWARF2 information for file-scope tentative data object
13140 declarations, file-scope (extern) function declarations (which had no
13141 corresponding body) and file-scope tagged type declarations and
13142 definitions which have not yet been forced out. */
13143 if (TREE_CODE (decl) != FUNCTION_DECL || !DECL_INITIAL (decl))
13144 dwarf2out_decl (decl);
13147 /* Output debug information for type decl DECL. Called from toplev.c
13148 and from language front ends (to record built-in types). */
13149 static void
13150 dwarf2out_type_decl (tree decl, int local)
13152 if (!local)
13153 dwarf2out_decl (decl);
13156 /* Output debug information for imported module or decl. */
13158 static void
13159 dwarf2out_imported_module_or_decl (tree decl, tree context)
13161 dw_die_ref imported_die, at_import_die;
13162 dw_die_ref scope_die;
13163 unsigned file_index;
13164 expanded_location xloc;
13166 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
13167 return;
13169 gcc_assert (decl);
13171 /* To emit DW_TAG_imported_module or DW_TAG_imported_decl, we need two DIEs.
13172 We need decl DIE for reference and scope die. First, get DIE for the decl
13173 itself. */
13175 /* Get the scope die for decl context. Use comp_unit_die for global module
13176 or decl. If die is not found for non globals, force new die. */
13177 if (!context)
13178 scope_die = comp_unit_die;
13179 else if (TYPE_P (context))
13180 scope_die = force_type_die (context);
13181 else
13182 scope_die = force_decl_die (context);
13184 /* For TYPE_DECL or CONST_DECL, lookup TREE_TYPE. */
13185 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == TYPE_DECL || TREE_CODE (decl) == CONST_DECL)
13186 at_import_die = force_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl));
13187 else
13189 at_import_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
13190 if (!at_import_die)
13192 /* If we're trying to avoid duplicate debug info, we may not have
13193 emitted the member decl for this field. Emit it now. */
13194 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == FIELD_DECL)
13196 tree type = DECL_CONTEXT (decl);
13197 dw_die_ref type_context_die;
13199 if (TYPE_CONTEXT (type))
13200 if (TYPE_P (TYPE_CONTEXT (type)))
13201 type_context_die = force_type_die (TYPE_CONTEXT (type));
13202 else
13203 type_context_die = force_decl_die (TYPE_CONTEXT (type));
13204 else
13205 type_context_die = comp_unit_die;
13206 gen_type_die_for_member (type, decl, type_context_die);
13208 at_import_die = force_decl_die (decl);
13212 /* OK, now we have DIEs for decl as well as scope. Emit imported die. */
13213 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == NAMESPACE_DECL)
13214 imported_die = new_die (DW_TAG_imported_module, scope_die, context);
13215 else
13216 imported_die = new_die (DW_TAG_imported_declaration, scope_die, context);
13218 xloc = expand_location (input_location);
13219 file_index = lookup_filename (xloc.file);
13220 add_AT_unsigned (imported_die, DW_AT_decl_file, file_index);
13221 add_AT_unsigned (imported_die, DW_AT_decl_line, xloc.line);
13222 add_AT_die_ref (imported_die, DW_AT_import, at_import_die);
13225 /* Write the debugging output for DECL. */
13227 void
13228 dwarf2out_decl (tree decl)
13230 dw_die_ref context_die = comp_unit_die;
13232 switch (TREE_CODE (decl))
13234 case ERROR_MARK:
13235 return;
13237 case FUNCTION_DECL:
13238 /* What we would really like to do here is to filter out all mere
13239 file-scope declarations of file-scope functions which are never
13240 referenced later within this translation unit (and keep all of ones
13241 that *are* referenced later on) but we aren't clairvoyant, so we have
13242 no idea which functions will be referenced in the future (i.e. later
13243 on within the current translation unit). So here we just ignore all
13244 file-scope function declarations which are not also definitions. If
13245 and when the debugger needs to know something about these functions,
13246 it will have to hunt around and find the DWARF information associated
13247 with the definition of the function.
13249 We can't just check DECL_EXTERNAL to find out which FUNCTION_DECL
13250 nodes represent definitions and which ones represent mere
13251 declarations. We have to check DECL_INITIAL instead. That's because
13252 the C front-end supports some weird semantics for "extern inline"
13253 function definitions. These can get inlined within the current
13254 translation unit (and thus, we need to generate Dwarf info for their
13255 abstract instances so that the Dwarf info for the concrete inlined
13256 instances can have something to refer to) but the compiler never
13257 generates any out-of-lines instances of such things (despite the fact
13258 that they *are* definitions).
13260 The important point is that the C front-end marks these "extern
13261 inline" functions as DECL_EXTERNAL, but we need to generate DWARF for
13262 them anyway. Note that the C++ front-end also plays some similar games
13263 for inline function definitions appearing within include files which
13264 also contain `#pragma interface' pragmas. */
13265 if (DECL_INITIAL (decl) == NULL_TREE)
13266 return;
13268 /* If we're a nested function, initially use a parent of NULL; if we're
13269 a plain function, this will be fixed up in decls_for_scope. If
13270 we're a method, it will be ignored, since we already have a DIE. */
13271 if (decl_function_context (decl)
13272 /* But if we're in terse mode, we don't care about scope. */
13273 && debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
13274 context_die = NULL;
13275 break;
13277 case VAR_DECL:
13278 /* Ignore this VAR_DECL if it refers to a file-scope extern data object
13279 declaration and if the declaration was never even referenced from
13280 within this entire compilation unit. We suppress these DIEs in
13281 order to save space in the .debug section (by eliminating entries
13282 which are probably useless). Note that we must not suppress
13283 block-local extern declarations (whether used or not) because that
13284 would screw-up the debugger's name lookup mechanism and cause it to
13285 miss things which really ought to be in scope at a given point. */
13286 if (DECL_EXTERNAL (decl) && !TREE_USED (decl))
13287 return;
13289 /* For local statics lookup proper context die. */
13290 if (TREE_STATIC (decl) && decl_function_context (decl))
13291 context_die = lookup_decl_die (DECL_CONTEXT (decl));
13293 /* If we are in terse mode, don't generate any DIEs to represent any
13294 variable declarations or definitions. */
13295 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
13296 return;
13297 break;
13299 case NAMESPACE_DECL:
13300 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
13301 return;
13302 if (lookup_decl_die (decl) != NULL)
13303 return;
13304 break;
13306 case TYPE_DECL:
13307 /* Don't emit stubs for types unless they are needed by other DIEs. */
13308 if (TYPE_DECL_SUPPRESS_DEBUG (decl))
13309 return;
13311 /* Don't bother trying to generate any DIEs to represent any of the
13312 normal built-in types for the language we are compiling. */
13313 if (DECL_IS_BUILTIN (decl))
13315 /* OK, we need to generate one for `bool' so GDB knows what type
13316 comparisons have. */
13317 if ((get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_language)
13318 == DW_LANG_C_plus_plus)
13319 && TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)) == BOOLEAN_TYPE
13320 && ! DECL_IGNORED_P (decl))
13321 modified_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl), 0, 0, NULL);
13323 return;
13326 /* If we are in terse mode, don't generate any DIEs for types. */
13327 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
13328 return;
13330 /* If we're a function-scope tag, initially use a parent of NULL;
13331 this will be fixed up in decls_for_scope. */
13332 if (decl_function_context (decl))
13333 context_die = NULL;
13335 break;
13337 default:
13338 return;
13341 gen_decl_die (decl, context_die);
13344 /* Output a marker (i.e. a label) for the beginning of the generated code for
13345 a lexical block. */
13347 static void
13348 dwarf2out_begin_block (unsigned int line ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
13349 unsigned int blocknum)
13351 switch_to_section (current_function_section ());
13352 ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (asm_out_file, BLOCK_BEGIN_LABEL, blocknum);
13355 /* Output a marker (i.e. a label) for the end of the generated code for a
13356 lexical block. */
13358 static void
13359 dwarf2out_end_block (unsigned int line ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, unsigned int blocknum)
13361 switch_to_section (current_function_section ());
13362 ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (asm_out_file, BLOCK_END_LABEL, blocknum);
13365 /* Returns nonzero if it is appropriate not to emit any debugging
13366 information for BLOCK, because it doesn't contain any instructions.
13368 Don't allow this for blocks with nested functions or local classes
13369 as we would end up with orphans, and in the presence of scheduling
13370 we may end up calling them anyway. */
13372 static bool
13373 dwarf2out_ignore_block (tree block)
13375 tree decl;
13377 for (decl = BLOCK_VARS (block); decl; decl = TREE_CHAIN (decl))
13378 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == FUNCTION_DECL
13379 || (TREE_CODE (decl) == TYPE_DECL && TYPE_DECL_IS_STUB (decl)))
13380 return 0;
13382 return 1;
13385 /* Lookup FILE_NAME (in the list of filenames that we know about here in
13386 dwarf2out.c) and return its "index". The index of each (known) filename is
13387 just a unique number which is associated with only that one filename. We
13388 need such numbers for the sake of generating labels (in the .debug_sfnames
13389 section) and references to those files numbers (in the .debug_srcinfo
13390 and.debug_macinfo sections). If the filename given as an argument is not
13391 found in our current list, add it to the list and assign it the next
13392 available unique index number. In order to speed up searches, we remember
13393 the index of the filename was looked up last. This handles the majority of
13394 all searches. */
13396 static unsigned
13397 lookup_filename (const char *file_name)
13399 size_t i, n;
13400 char *save_file_name;
13402 /* Check to see if the file name that was searched on the previous
13403 call matches this file name. If so, return the index. */
13404 if (file_table_last_lookup_index != 0)
13406 const char *last
13407 = VARRAY_CHAR_PTR (file_table, file_table_last_lookup_index);
13408 if (strcmp (file_name, last) == 0)
13409 return file_table_last_lookup_index;
13412 /* Didn't match the previous lookup, search the table. */
13413 n = VARRAY_ACTIVE_SIZE (file_table);
13414 for (i = 1; i < n; i++)
13415 if (strcmp (file_name, VARRAY_CHAR_PTR (file_table, i)) == 0)
13417 file_table_last_lookup_index = i;
13418 return i;
13421 /* Add the new entry to the end of the filename table. */
13422 file_table_last_lookup_index = n;
13423 save_file_name = (char *) ggc_strdup (file_name);
13424 VARRAY_PUSH_CHAR_PTR (file_table, save_file_name);
13425 VARRAY_PUSH_UINT (file_table_emitted, 0);
13427 /* If the assembler is emitting the file table, and we aren't eliminating
13428 unused debug types, then we must emit .file here. If we are eliminating
13429 unused debug types, then this will be done by the maybe_emit_file call in
13430 prune_unused_types_walk_attribs. */
13432 if (DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO && ! flag_eliminate_unused_debug_types)
13433 return maybe_emit_file (i);
13435 return i;
13438 /* If the assembler will construct the file table, then translate the compiler
13439 internal file table number into the assembler file table number, and emit
13440 a .file directive if we haven't already emitted one yet. The file table
13441 numbers are different because we prune debug info for unused variables and
13442 types, which may include filenames. */
13444 static int
13445 maybe_emit_file (int fileno)
13447 if (DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO && fileno > 0)
13449 if (!VARRAY_UINT (file_table_emitted, fileno))
13451 VARRAY_UINT (file_table_emitted, fileno) = ++emitcount;
13452 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.file %u ",
13453 VARRAY_UINT (file_table_emitted, fileno));
13454 output_quoted_string (asm_out_file,
13455 VARRAY_CHAR_PTR (file_table, fileno));
13456 fputc ('\n', asm_out_file);
13458 return VARRAY_UINT (file_table_emitted, fileno);
13460 else
13461 return fileno;
13464 /* Initialize the compiler internal file table. */
13466 static void
13467 init_file_table (void)
13469 /* Allocate the initial hunk of the file_table. */
13470 VARRAY_CHAR_PTR_INIT (file_table, 64, "file_table");
13471 VARRAY_UINT_INIT (file_table_emitted, 64, "file_table_emitted");
13473 /* Skip the first entry - file numbers begin at 1. */
13474 VARRAY_PUSH_CHAR_PTR (file_table, NULL);
13475 VARRAY_PUSH_UINT (file_table_emitted, 0);
13476 file_table_last_lookup_index = 0;
13479 /* Called by the final INSN scan whenever we see a var location. We
13480 use it to drop labels in the right places, and throw the location in
13481 our lookup table. */
13483 static void
13484 dwarf2out_var_location (rtx loc_note)
13486 char loclabel[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
13487 struct var_loc_node *newloc;
13488 rtx prev_insn;
13489 static rtx last_insn;
13490 static const char *last_label;
13491 tree decl;
13493 if (!DECL_P (NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_DECL (loc_note)))
13494 return;
13495 prev_insn = PREV_INSN (loc_note);
13497 newloc = ggc_alloc_cleared (sizeof (struct var_loc_node));
13498 /* If the insn we processed last time is the previous insn
13499 and it is also a var location note, use the label we emitted
13500 last time. */
13501 if (last_insn != NULL_RTX
13502 && last_insn == prev_insn
13503 && NOTE_P (prev_insn)
13504 && NOTE_LINE_NUMBER (prev_insn) == NOTE_INSN_VAR_LOCATION)
13506 newloc->label = last_label;
13508 else
13510 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (loclabel, "LVL", loclabel_num);
13511 ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (asm_out_file, "LVL", loclabel_num);
13512 loclabel_num++;
13513 newloc->label = ggc_strdup (loclabel);
13515 newloc->var_loc_note = loc_note;
13516 newloc->next = NULL;
13518 if (cfun && in_cold_section_p)
13519 newloc->section_label = cfun->cold_section_label;
13520 else
13521 newloc->section_label = text_section_label;
13523 last_insn = loc_note;
13524 last_label = newloc->label;
13525 decl = NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_DECL (loc_note);
13526 if (DECL_DEBUG_EXPR_IS_FROM (decl) && DECL_DEBUG_EXPR (decl)
13527 && DECL_P (DECL_DEBUG_EXPR (decl)))
13528 decl = DECL_DEBUG_EXPR (decl);
13529 add_var_loc_to_decl (decl, newloc);
13532 /* We need to reset the locations at the beginning of each
13533 function. We can't do this in the end_function hook, because the
13534 declarations that use the locations won't have been output when
13535 that hook is called. Also compute have_multiple_function_sections here. */
13537 static void
13538 dwarf2out_begin_function (tree fun)
13540 htab_empty (decl_loc_table);
13542 if (function_section (fun) != text_section)
13543 have_multiple_function_sections = true;
13546 /* Output a label to mark the beginning of a source code line entry
13547 and record information relating to this source line, in
13548 'line_info_table' for later output of the .debug_line section. */
13550 static void
13551 dwarf2out_source_line (unsigned int line, const char *filename)
13553 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_NORMAL
13554 && line != 0)
13556 switch_to_section (current_function_section ());
13558 /* If requested, emit something human-readable. */
13559 if (flag_debug_asm)
13560 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t%s %s:%d\n", ASM_COMMENT_START,
13561 filename, line);
13563 if (DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO)
13565 unsigned file_num = lookup_filename (filename);
13567 file_num = maybe_emit_file (file_num);
13569 /* Emit the .loc directive understood by GNU as. */
13570 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.loc %d %d 0\n", file_num, line);
13572 /* Indicate that line number info exists. */
13573 line_info_table_in_use++;
13575 else if (function_section (current_function_decl) != text_section)
13577 dw_separate_line_info_ref line_info;
13578 targetm.asm_out.internal_label (asm_out_file, SEPARATE_LINE_CODE_LABEL,
13579 separate_line_info_table_in_use);
13581 /* Expand the line info table if necessary. */
13582 if (separate_line_info_table_in_use
13583 == separate_line_info_table_allocated)
13585 separate_line_info_table_allocated += LINE_INFO_TABLE_INCREMENT;
13586 separate_line_info_table
13587 = ggc_realloc (separate_line_info_table,
13588 separate_line_info_table_allocated
13589 * sizeof (dw_separate_line_info_entry));
13590 memset (separate_line_info_table
13591 + separate_line_info_table_in_use,
13593 (LINE_INFO_TABLE_INCREMENT
13594 * sizeof (dw_separate_line_info_entry)));
13597 /* Add the new entry at the end of the line_info_table. */
13598 line_info
13599 = &separate_line_info_table[separate_line_info_table_in_use++];
13600 line_info->dw_file_num = lookup_filename (filename);
13601 line_info->dw_line_num = line;
13602 line_info->function = current_function_funcdef_no;
13604 else
13606 dw_line_info_ref line_info;
13608 targetm.asm_out.internal_label (asm_out_file, LINE_CODE_LABEL,
13609 line_info_table_in_use);
13611 /* Expand the line info table if necessary. */
13612 if (line_info_table_in_use == line_info_table_allocated)
13614 line_info_table_allocated += LINE_INFO_TABLE_INCREMENT;
13615 line_info_table
13616 = ggc_realloc (line_info_table,
13617 (line_info_table_allocated
13618 * sizeof (dw_line_info_entry)));
13619 memset (line_info_table + line_info_table_in_use, 0,
13620 LINE_INFO_TABLE_INCREMENT * sizeof (dw_line_info_entry));
13623 /* Add the new entry at the end of the line_info_table. */
13624 line_info = &line_info_table[line_info_table_in_use++];
13625 line_info->dw_file_num = lookup_filename (filename);
13626 line_info->dw_line_num = line;
13631 /* Record the beginning of a new source file. */
13633 static void
13634 dwarf2out_start_source_file (unsigned int lineno, const char *filename)
13636 if (flag_eliminate_dwarf2_dups)
13638 /* Record the beginning of the file for break_out_includes. */
13639 dw_die_ref bincl_die;
13641 bincl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_GNU_BINCL, comp_unit_die, NULL);
13642 add_AT_string (bincl_die, DW_AT_name, filename);
13645 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
13647 int fileno;
13649 switch_to_section (debug_macinfo_section);
13650 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_MACINFO_start_file, "Start new file");
13651 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (lineno, "Included from line number %d",
13652 lineno);
13654 fileno = maybe_emit_file (lookup_filename (filename));
13655 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (fileno, "Filename we just started");
13659 /* Record the end of a source file. */
13661 static void
13662 dwarf2out_end_source_file (unsigned int lineno ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
13664 if (flag_eliminate_dwarf2_dups)
13665 /* Record the end of the file for break_out_includes. */
13666 new_die (DW_TAG_GNU_EINCL, comp_unit_die, NULL);
13668 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
13670 switch_to_section (debug_macinfo_section);
13671 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_MACINFO_end_file, "End file");
13675 /* Called from debug_define in toplev.c. The `buffer' parameter contains
13676 the tail part of the directive line, i.e. the part which is past the
13677 initial whitespace, #, whitespace, directive-name, whitespace part. */
13679 static void
13680 dwarf2out_define (unsigned int lineno ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
13681 const char *buffer ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
13683 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
13685 switch_to_section (debug_macinfo_section);
13686 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_MACINFO_define, "Define macro");
13687 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (lineno, "At line number %d", lineno);
13688 dw2_asm_output_nstring (buffer, -1, "The macro");
13692 /* Called from debug_undef in toplev.c. The `buffer' parameter contains
13693 the tail part of the directive line, i.e. the part which is past the
13694 initial whitespace, #, whitespace, directive-name, whitespace part. */
13696 static void
13697 dwarf2out_undef (unsigned int lineno ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
13698 const char *buffer ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
13700 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
13702 switch_to_section (debug_macinfo_section);
13703 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_MACINFO_undef, "Undefine macro");
13704 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (lineno, "At line number %d", lineno);
13705 dw2_asm_output_nstring (buffer, -1, "The macro");
13709 /* Set up for Dwarf output at the start of compilation. */
13711 static void
13712 dwarf2out_init (const char *filename ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
13714 init_file_table ();
13716 /* Allocate the decl_die_table. */
13717 decl_die_table = htab_create_ggc (10, decl_die_table_hash,
13718 decl_die_table_eq, NULL);
13720 /* Allocate the decl_loc_table. */
13721 decl_loc_table = htab_create_ggc (10, decl_loc_table_hash,
13722 decl_loc_table_eq, NULL);
13724 /* Allocate the initial hunk of the decl_scope_table. */
13725 decl_scope_table = VEC_alloc (tree, gc, 256);
13727 /* Allocate the initial hunk of the abbrev_die_table. */
13728 abbrev_die_table = ggc_alloc_cleared (ABBREV_DIE_TABLE_INCREMENT
13729 * sizeof (dw_die_ref));
13730 abbrev_die_table_allocated = ABBREV_DIE_TABLE_INCREMENT;
13731 /* Zero-th entry is allocated, but unused. */
13732 abbrev_die_table_in_use = 1;
13734 /* Allocate the initial hunk of the line_info_table. */
13735 line_info_table = ggc_alloc_cleared (LINE_INFO_TABLE_INCREMENT
13736 * sizeof (dw_line_info_entry));
13737 line_info_table_allocated = LINE_INFO_TABLE_INCREMENT;
13739 /* Zero-th entry is allocated, but unused. */
13740 line_info_table_in_use = 1;
13742 /* Generate the initial DIE for the .debug section. Note that the (string)
13743 value given in the DW_AT_name attribute of the DW_TAG_compile_unit DIE
13744 will (typically) be a relative pathname and that this pathname should be
13745 taken as being relative to the directory from which the compiler was
13746 invoked when the given (base) source file was compiled. We will fill
13747 in this value in dwarf2out_finish. */
13748 comp_unit_die = gen_compile_unit_die (NULL);
13750 incomplete_types = VEC_alloc (tree, gc, 64);
13752 used_rtx_array = VEC_alloc (rtx, gc, 32);
13754 debug_info_section = get_section (DEBUG_INFO_SECTION,
13755 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
13756 debug_abbrev_section = get_section (DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION,
13757 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
13758 debug_aranges_section = get_section (DEBUG_ARANGES_SECTION,
13759 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
13760 debug_macinfo_section = get_section (DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION,
13761 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
13762 debug_line_section = get_section (DEBUG_LINE_SECTION,
13763 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
13764 debug_loc_section = get_section (DEBUG_LOC_SECTION,
13765 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
13766 debug_pubnames_section = get_section (DEBUG_PUBNAMES_SECTION,
13767 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
13768 debug_str_section = get_section (DEBUG_STR_SECTION,
13769 DEBUG_STR_SECTION_FLAGS, NULL);
13770 debug_ranges_section = get_section (DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION,
13771 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
13772 debug_frame_section = get_section (DEBUG_FRAME_SECTION,
13773 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
13775 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (text_end_label, TEXT_END_LABEL, 0);
13776 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (abbrev_section_label,
13777 DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
13778 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (text_section_label, TEXT_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
13779 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (cold_text_section_label,
13780 COLD_TEXT_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
13781 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (cold_end_label, COLD_END_LABEL, 0);
13783 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (debug_info_section_label,
13784 DEBUG_INFO_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
13785 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (debug_line_section_label,
13786 DEBUG_LINE_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
13787 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (ranges_section_label,
13788 DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
13789 switch_to_section (debug_abbrev_section);
13790 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, abbrev_section_label);
13791 switch_to_section (debug_info_section);
13792 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, debug_info_section_label);
13793 switch_to_section (debug_line_section);
13794 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, debug_line_section_label);
13796 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
13798 switch_to_section (debug_macinfo_section);
13799 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (macinfo_section_label,
13800 DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
13801 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, macinfo_section_label);
13804 switch_to_section (text_section);
13805 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, text_section_label);
13806 if (flag_reorder_blocks_and_partition)
13808 switch_to_section (unlikely_text_section ());
13809 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, cold_text_section_label);
13813 /* A helper function for dwarf2out_finish called through
13814 ht_forall. Emit one queued .debug_str string. */
13816 static int
13817 output_indirect_string (void **h, void *v ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
13819 struct indirect_string_node *node = (struct indirect_string_node *) *h;
13821 if (node->form == DW_FORM_strp)
13823 switch_to_section (debug_str_section);
13824 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, node->label);
13825 assemble_string (node->str, strlen (node->str) + 1);
13828 return 1;
13833 /* Clear the marks for a die and its children.
13834 Be cool if the mark isn't set. */
13836 static void
13837 prune_unmark_dies (dw_die_ref die)
13839 dw_die_ref c;
13840 die->die_mark = 0;
13841 for (c = die->die_child; c; c = c->die_sib)
13842 prune_unmark_dies (c);
13846 /* Given DIE that we're marking as used, find any other dies
13847 it references as attributes and mark them as used. */
13849 static void
13850 prune_unused_types_walk_attribs (dw_die_ref die)
13852 dw_attr_ref a;
13854 for (a = die->die_attr; a != NULL; a = a->dw_attr_next)
13856 if (a->dw_attr_val.val_class == dw_val_class_die_ref)
13858 /* A reference to another DIE.
13859 Make sure that it will get emitted. */
13860 prune_unused_types_mark (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.die, 1);
13862 else if (a->dw_attr == DW_AT_decl_file || a->dw_attr == DW_AT_call_file)
13864 /* A reference to a file. Make sure the file name is emitted. */
13865 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_unsigned =
13866 maybe_emit_file (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_unsigned);
13872 /* Mark DIE as being used. If DOKIDS is true, then walk down
13873 to DIE's children. */
13875 static void
13876 prune_unused_types_mark (dw_die_ref die, int dokids)
13878 dw_die_ref c;
13880 if (die->die_mark == 0)
13882 /* We haven't done this node yet. Mark it as used. */
13883 die->die_mark = 1;
13885 /* We also have to mark its parents as used.
13886 (But we don't want to mark our parents' kids due to this.) */
13887 if (die->die_parent)
13888 prune_unused_types_mark (die->die_parent, 0);
13890 /* Mark any referenced nodes. */
13891 prune_unused_types_walk_attribs (die);
13893 /* If this node is a specification,
13894 also mark the definition, if it exists. */
13895 if (get_AT_flag (die, DW_AT_declaration) && die->die_definition)
13896 prune_unused_types_mark (die->die_definition, 1);
13899 if (dokids && die->die_mark != 2)
13901 /* We need to walk the children, but haven't done so yet.
13902 Remember that we've walked the kids. */
13903 die->die_mark = 2;
13905 /* Walk them. */
13906 for (c = die->die_child; c; c = c->die_sib)
13908 /* If this is an array type, we need to make sure our
13909 kids get marked, even if they're types. */
13910 if (die->die_tag == DW_TAG_array_type)
13911 prune_unused_types_mark (c, 1);
13912 else
13913 prune_unused_types_walk (c);
13919 /* Walk the tree DIE and mark types that we actually use. */
13921 static void
13922 prune_unused_types_walk (dw_die_ref die)
13924 dw_die_ref c;
13926 /* Don't do anything if this node is already marked. */
13927 if (die->die_mark)
13928 return;
13930 switch (die->die_tag) {
13931 case DW_TAG_const_type:
13932 case DW_TAG_packed_type:
13933 case DW_TAG_pointer_type:
13934 case DW_TAG_reference_type:
13935 case DW_TAG_volatile_type:
13936 case DW_TAG_typedef:
13937 case DW_TAG_array_type:
13938 case DW_TAG_structure_type:
13939 case DW_TAG_union_type:
13940 case DW_TAG_class_type:
13941 case DW_TAG_friend:
13942 case DW_TAG_variant_part:
13943 case DW_TAG_enumeration_type:
13944 case DW_TAG_subroutine_type:
13945 case DW_TAG_string_type:
13946 case DW_TAG_set_type:
13947 case DW_TAG_subrange_type:
13948 case DW_TAG_ptr_to_member_type:
13949 case DW_TAG_file_type:
13950 /* It's a type node --- don't mark it. */
13951 return;
13953 default:
13954 /* Mark everything else. */
13955 break;
13958 die->die_mark = 1;
13960 /* Now, mark any dies referenced from here. */
13961 prune_unused_types_walk_attribs (die);
13963 /* Mark children. */
13964 for (c = die->die_child; c; c = c->die_sib)
13965 prune_unused_types_walk (c);
13969 /* Remove from the tree DIE any dies that aren't marked. */
13971 static void
13972 prune_unused_types_prune (dw_die_ref die)
13974 dw_die_ref c, p, n;
13976 gcc_assert (die->die_mark);
13978 p = NULL;
13979 for (c = die->die_child; c; c = n)
13981 n = c->die_sib;
13982 if (c->die_mark)
13984 prune_unused_types_prune (c);
13985 p = c;
13987 else
13989 if (p)
13990 p->die_sib = n;
13991 else
13992 die->die_child = n;
13993 free_die (c);
13999 /* Remove dies representing declarations that we never use. */
14001 static void
14002 prune_unused_types (void)
14004 unsigned int i;
14005 limbo_die_node *node;
14007 /* Clear all the marks. */
14008 prune_unmark_dies (comp_unit_die);
14009 for (node = limbo_die_list; node; node = node->next)
14010 prune_unmark_dies (node->die);
14012 /* Set the mark on nodes that are actually used. */
14013 prune_unused_types_walk (comp_unit_die);
14014 for (node = limbo_die_list; node; node = node->next)
14015 prune_unused_types_walk (node->die);
14017 /* Also set the mark on nodes referenced from the
14018 pubname_table or arange_table. */
14019 for (i = 0; i < pubname_table_in_use; i++)
14020 prune_unused_types_mark (pubname_table[i].die, 1);
14021 for (i = 0; i < arange_table_in_use; i++)
14022 prune_unused_types_mark (arange_table[i], 1);
14024 /* Get rid of nodes that aren't marked. */
14025 prune_unused_types_prune (comp_unit_die);
14026 for (node = limbo_die_list; node; node = node->next)
14027 prune_unused_types_prune (node->die);
14029 /* Leave the marks clear. */
14030 prune_unmark_dies (comp_unit_die);
14031 for (node = limbo_die_list; node; node = node->next)
14032 prune_unmark_dies (node->die);
14035 /* Output stuff that dwarf requires at the end of every file,
14036 and generate the DWARF-2 debugging info. */
14038 static void
14039 dwarf2out_finish (const char *filename)
14041 limbo_die_node *node, *next_node;
14042 dw_die_ref die = 0;
14044 /* Add the name for the main input file now. We delayed this from
14045 dwarf2out_init to avoid complications with PCH. */
14046 add_name_attribute (comp_unit_die, filename);
14047 if (filename[0] != DIR_SEPARATOR)
14048 add_comp_dir_attribute (comp_unit_die);
14049 else if (get_AT (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_comp_dir) == NULL)
14051 size_t i;
14052 for (i = 1; i < VARRAY_ACTIVE_SIZE (file_table); i++)
14053 if (VARRAY_CHAR_PTR (file_table, i)[0] != DIR_SEPARATOR
14054 /* Don't add cwd for <built-in>. */
14055 && VARRAY_CHAR_PTR (file_table, i)[0] != '<')
14057 add_comp_dir_attribute (comp_unit_die);
14058 break;
14062 /* Traverse the limbo die list, and add parent/child links. The only
14063 dies without parents that should be here are concrete instances of
14064 inline functions, and the comp_unit_die. We can ignore the comp_unit_die.
14065 For concrete instances, we can get the parent die from the abstract
14066 instance. */
14067 for (node = limbo_die_list; node; node = next_node)
14069 next_node = node->next;
14070 die = node->die;
14072 if (die->die_parent == NULL)
14074 dw_die_ref origin = get_AT_ref (die, DW_AT_abstract_origin);
14076 if (origin)
14077 add_child_die (origin->die_parent, die);
14078 else if (die == comp_unit_die)
14080 else if (errorcount > 0 || sorrycount > 0)
14081 /* It's OK to be confused by errors in the input. */
14082 add_child_die (comp_unit_die, die);
14083 else
14085 /* In certain situations, the lexical block containing a
14086 nested function can be optimized away, which results
14087 in the nested function die being orphaned. Likewise
14088 with the return type of that nested function. Force
14089 this to be a child of the containing function.
14091 It may happen that even the containing function got fully
14092 inlined and optimized out. In that case we are lost and
14093 assign the empty child. This should not be big issue as
14094 the function is likely unreachable too. */
14095 tree context = NULL_TREE;
14097 gcc_assert (node->created_for);
14099 if (DECL_P (node->created_for))
14100 context = DECL_CONTEXT (node->created_for);
14101 else if (TYPE_P (node->created_for))
14102 context = TYPE_CONTEXT (node->created_for);
14104 gcc_assert (context && TREE_CODE (context) == FUNCTION_DECL);
14106 origin = lookup_decl_die (context);
14107 if (origin)
14108 add_child_die (origin, die);
14109 else
14110 add_child_die (comp_unit_die, die);
14115 limbo_die_list = NULL;
14117 /* Walk through the list of incomplete types again, trying once more to
14118 emit full debugging info for them. */
14119 retry_incomplete_types ();
14121 /* We need to reverse all the dies before break_out_includes, or
14122 we'll see the end of an include file before the beginning. */
14123 reverse_all_dies (comp_unit_die);
14125 if (flag_eliminate_unused_debug_types)
14126 prune_unused_types ();
14128 /* Generate separate CUs for each of the include files we've seen.
14129 They will go into limbo_die_list. */
14130 if (flag_eliminate_dwarf2_dups)
14131 break_out_includes (comp_unit_die);
14133 /* Traverse the DIE's and add add sibling attributes to those DIE's
14134 that have children. */
14135 add_sibling_attributes (comp_unit_die);
14136 for (node = limbo_die_list; node; node = node->next)
14137 add_sibling_attributes (node->die);
14139 /* Output a terminator label for the .text section. */
14140 switch_to_section (text_section);
14141 targetm.asm_out.internal_label (asm_out_file, TEXT_END_LABEL, 0);
14142 if (flag_reorder_blocks_and_partition)
14144 switch_to_section (unlikely_text_section ());
14145 targetm.asm_out.internal_label (asm_out_file, COLD_END_LABEL, 0);
14148 /* Output the source line correspondence table. We must do this
14149 even if there is no line information. Otherwise, on an empty
14150 translation unit, we will generate a present, but empty,
14151 .debug_info section. IRIX 6.5 `nm' will then complain when
14152 examining the file. */
14153 if (! DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO)
14155 switch_to_section (debug_line_section);
14156 output_line_info ();
14159 /* We can only use the low/high_pc attributes if all of the code was
14160 in .text. */
14161 if (!have_multiple_function_sections)
14163 add_AT_lbl_id (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_low_pc, text_section_label);
14164 add_AT_lbl_id (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_high_pc, text_end_label);
14167 /* If it wasn't, we need to give .debug_loc and .debug_ranges an appropriate
14168 "base address". Use zero so that these addresses become absolute. */
14169 else if (have_location_lists || ranges_table_in_use)
14170 add_AT_addr (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_entry_pc, const0_rtx);
14172 /* Output location list section if necessary. */
14173 if (have_location_lists)
14175 /* Output the location lists info. */
14176 switch_to_section (debug_loc_section);
14177 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (loc_section_label,
14178 DEBUG_LOC_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
14179 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, loc_section_label);
14180 output_location_lists (die);
14183 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_NORMAL)
14184 add_AT_lineptr (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_stmt_list,
14185 debug_line_section_label);
14187 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
14188 add_AT_macptr (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_macro_info, macinfo_section_label);
14190 /* Output all of the compilation units. We put the main one last so that
14191 the offsets are available to output_pubnames. */
14192 for (node = limbo_die_list; node; node = node->next)
14193 output_comp_unit (node->die, 0);
14195 output_comp_unit (comp_unit_die, 0);
14197 /* Output the abbreviation table. */
14198 switch_to_section (debug_abbrev_section);
14199 output_abbrev_section ();
14201 /* Output public names table if necessary. */
14202 if (pubname_table_in_use)
14204 switch_to_section (debug_pubnames_section);
14205 output_pubnames ();
14208 /* Output the address range information. We only put functions in the arange
14209 table, so don't write it out if we don't have any. */
14210 if (fde_table_in_use)
14212 switch_to_section (debug_aranges_section);
14213 output_aranges ();
14216 /* Output ranges section if necessary. */
14217 if (ranges_table_in_use)
14219 switch_to_section (debug_ranges_section);
14220 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, ranges_section_label);
14221 output_ranges ();
14224 /* Have to end the macro section. */
14225 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
14227 switch_to_section (debug_macinfo_section);
14228 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "End compilation unit");
14231 /* If we emitted any DW_FORM_strp form attribute, output the string
14232 table too. */
14233 if (debug_str_hash)
14234 htab_traverse (debug_str_hash, output_indirect_string, NULL);
14236 #else
14238 /* This should never be used, but its address is needed for comparisons. */
14239 const struct gcc_debug_hooks dwarf2_debug_hooks;
14241 #endif /* DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO */
14243 #include "gt-dwarf2out.h"